Toshiba Fax Machine DP120F User Manual

PLAIN PAPER FACSIMILE  
OPERATOR’S MANUAL  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NOTICE TO USERS  
Please read through this manual before using the machine. After reading it, be certain to keep it so that you may refer to it whenever necessary.  
U. S. A.  
for repair/warranty information. If the trouble is causing harm to the telephone network,  
the telephone company may request you remove the equipment from the network,  
until the problem is resolved.  
WARNING  
FCC Notice: Part 15  
This terminal has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital  
device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide  
reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment is operated in  
a commercial environment. This equipment generates, and can radiate radio fre-  
quency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with this guide, may cause  
harmful interference to radio communications. Operation of this terminal in a residen-  
tial area is likely to cause harmful interferences in which case the user will be required  
to correct the interference at his/her own expense.  
The equipment may not used on coin service provided by the telephone network,  
connection to Party Line Service is subject to state tariffs. (Contact the state public  
utility commission, or corporation commission for information.)  
This device is equipped with a USOC RJ11C connector.  
THE TELEPHONE CONSUMER PROTECTION ACT: The Telephone Consumer Pro-  
tection Act of 1991 makes it unlawful for any person to use a computer or other  
electronic device to send any message via a telephone fax machine unless such a  
message clearly contains in a margin at the top or bottom of each transmitted page or  
on the first page of the transmission, the date and time it is sent and an identification  
of the business or other entity, or other individual sending the message and the  
telephone number of the sending machine or such business, other entity, or individual.  
WARNING  
FCC Notice: Part 68  
This equipment complies with Part 68 of the FCC Rules. On the rear of this equipment  
is a label that contains, among other information, the FCC Registration Number and  
ringer equivalence number (REN) for this equipment. If requested, this information  
must be provided to the telephone company.  
The REN is used to determine the quantity of devices that may be connected to the  
telephone line. Excessive REN’s on the telephone line may result in the devices not  
ringing in response to an incoming call. In most, but not all areas, the sum of the  
REN’s should not exceed five (5.0). To be certain of the number of devices that may  
be connected to the line, as determined by the total REN’s contact the telephone  
company to determine the maximum REN for the calling area.  
In order to program this information into your fax machine, you should complete the  
setup procedures listed for station ID number and name on pages 42 and 43 in this  
manual.  
This equipment is hearing aid compatible.  
If your facsimile machine causes harm to the telephone network, the telephone com-  
pany will notify you in advance that temporary discontinuance of service may be  
required. But if advance notice is not practical, you will be notified as soon as pos-  
sible, also, you will be advised of your right to file a complaint with the FCC if you  
believe it is necessary.  
The telephone company may make changes in its facilities, equipment, operations, or  
procedures that could affect the operation of the equipment. If this happens, the  
telephone company will provide advance notice in order for you to make the neces-  
sary modifications in order to maintain uninterrupted service.  
If you experience trouble with this facsimile machine, please contact  
TOSHIBA AMERICA BUSINESS SOLUTIONS, INC.  
Electronic Imaging Division  
2 Musick, Irvine, CA 92618-1631  
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NOTICE TO USERS  
Canada  
AVIS: L’étiquette d’lndustrie Canada identifie le marériel homologué. Cette étiquette  
certifie que le matériel est conforme aux normes de protection, d’exploitation et de  
sécurité des réseaux de télécommunications, comme le prescrivent les documents  
concernant les exigences techniques relatives au matériel terminal. Le Ministére  
n’assure toutefois pas que le matériel fonctionnera à la satisfaction de l’utilisateur.  
NOTICE:  
The Industry Canada label identifies certified equipment. This certifi-  
cation means that the equipment meets telecommunications network protective, op-  
erational and safety requirements as prescribed in the appropriate Terminal Equip-  
ment Technical Requirements document(s). The Department does not guarantee the  
equipment will operate to the user's satisfaction.  
Avant d’installer ce matériel, l’utilisateur doit s’assurer qu’il est permis de le raccorder  
aux installations de l’entreprise locale de télécommunication. Le matériel doit  
également être installé en suivant une méthode acceptée de raccordement. L’abonné  
ne doit pas oublier qu’il est possible que la conformité aux conditions énoncées ci-  
dessus n’empêche pas la dégradation du service dans certaines situations.  
Before installing this equipment, users should ensure that it is permissible to connect  
a facsimile to the facilities of their local telecommunications company. The equipment  
must also be installed using an acceptable method of connection. The customer  
should be aware that compliance with the above conditions may not prevent degrada-  
tion of service in some situations.  
Les réparations de matériel homologué doivent être coordonnées par un représentant  
désigné par le fournisseur. L’entreprise de télécommunications peut demander à  
l’utilisateur de débrancher un appareil à la suite de réparations ou de modifications  
effectuées par l’utilisateur ou à cause de mauvais fonctionnement.  
Repairs to certified equipment should be coordinated by a representative designated  
by the supplier. Any repairs or alterations made by the user to this equipment, or  
equipment malfunctions, may give the telecommunications company cause to request  
the user to disconnect the equipment.  
Pour sa propre protection, l’utilisateur doit s’assurer que tous les fils de mise à la terre  
de la source d’énergie électrique, des lignes téléphoniques et des canalisations d’eau  
Users should ensure for their own protection that the electrical ground connections of  
the power utility, telephone lines and internal metallic water pipe system, if present,  
are connected together. This precaution may be particularly important in rural areas.  
métalliques, s’il  
y
en a, sont raccordés ensemble. Cette précaution est  
particulièrement importante dans les régions rerales.  
Avertissement: L’utilisateur ne doit pas tenter de faire ces raccordements luimême; il  
doit avoir recours à un service d’inspection des installations électriques, ou à un  
électricien, selon le cas.  
CAUTION:  
Users should not attempt to make such connections themselves, but  
should contact the appropriate electric inspection authority, or electrician, as appropri-  
ate.  
L’indice d’equivalence de la sonnerie de ce matériel 0.3  
The Ringer Equivalence Number of your facsimile is 0.3  
AVIS: L’indice d’équivalence de la sonnerie (IES) assigné à chaque dispositif terminal  
indique le nombre maximal de terminaux qui peuvent être raccordés à une interface.  
La terminaison d’une interface téléphonique peut consister en une combinaison de  
quelques dispositifs, à la seule condition que la somme d’indices d’équivalence de la  
sonnerie de tous les dispositifs n’excède pas 5.  
NOTICE:  
The Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) assigned to each terminal  
device provides an indication of the maximum number of terminals allowed to be  
connected to a telephone interface. The termination on an interface may consist of  
any combination of devices subject only to the requirement that the sum of the Ringer  
Equivalence Numbers of all the devices does not exceed 5.  
TOSHIBA OF CANADA LIMITED  
Office Product Group  
191 McNABB STREET  
MARKHAM, ONTARIO L3R 8H2  
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OZONE SAFETY INFORMATION  
The ozone filter (used with this machine) complies with Environmental Protection  
Agency regulations for ozone emissions in an office environment. This means that this  
facsimile does not produce hazardous ozone emissions greater than 0.1 ppm.  
Replace the ozone filter:  
An ozone filter has been provided with this unit and is to be replaced at the same  
interval as the drum unit. See page 32.  
LASER SAFETY INFORMATION  
This facsimile is certified as a Class I laser product under the U.S. Department of  
Health and Human Services (DHHS) Radiation Performance Standard according to  
the Radiation Control for Health and Safety Act of 1968. This means that this facsimile  
does not produce hazardous laser radiation.  
All laser light emitted inside the facsimile is completely confined within protective  
housings when any part of the facsimile is opened. This means that the facsimile is  
safe to use during normal operation and maintenance. Adjustment or performance of  
procedures other than those specified herein may result in hazardous laser exposure.  
The Center for Devices and Radiological Health (CDRH) of the U.S. Food and Drug  
Administration implemented regulations for laser products. These regulations apply to  
laser products manufactured from August 1, 1976. Compliance is mandatory for prod-  
ucts marketed in the United States. The sample label shown below indicates compli-  
ance with these CDRH regulations and is attached to all laser facsimiles marketed in  
the United States.  
001  
WARNING  
Use of controls, adjustments or performance of procedures other  
than those specified in this manual may result in hazardous radia-  
tion exposure.  
Only trained and qualified personnel may open covers or remove  
parts that are not explicitly shown and described in the Operator’s  
Manual as being accessible to the Operator.  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTENTS  
Character Entry .....................................................................................36  
Keys Used in Character Entry ..........................................................36  
Special Character Table ....................................................................36  
Character Correction ........................................................................37  
INITIAL SETUP ......................................................................38  
Initial Setting Summary..........................................................................38  
Language Selection ...............................................................................39  
Date and Time Setting ...........................................................................40  
Terminal ID Setting ................................................................................42  
Dial Type Setting ....................................................................................44  
DEVICE CONFIGURATION....................................................45  
Configuration Summary.........................................................................45  
Bell Ringer Volume Adjustment..............................................................47  
Alarm Tone Volume Adjustment .............................................................48  
Key TouchTone Volume Adjustment.......................................................49  
MonitorVolume Adjustment ...................................................................50  
Power Saver Operation..........................................................................51  
Setting Separator Page .........................................................................53  
Department Code Setting ......................................................................55  
Department Code Maintenance.............................................................57  
Account Codes ......................................................................................58  
Print Density Setting ..............................................................................59  
Document Length Setting ......................................................................60  
Line Monitor...........................................................................................61  
Receive Interval Setting.........................................................................62  
ECM Default Setting ..............................................................................63  
Default Setting for Document Mode (Resolution and Contrast)..............64  
Collate Copy Setting ..............................................................................65  
Letter Head Paper Setting .....................................................................66  
Setting Redial (Interval and Counter).....................................................67  
Auto Receive Mode ...............................................................................68  
Line-2 Operation....................................................................................69  
NOTICE TO USERS ................................................................1  
NOTICE TO USERS ................................................................2  
OZONE SAFETY INFORMATION ..........................................3  
LASER SAFETY INFORMATION ...........................................3  
FEATURES .............................................................................8  
CARE AND MAINTENANCE..................................................9  
INTRODUCTION.......................................................... 10  
FACSIMILE UNIT DESCRIPTIONS ........................................10  
Front View..............................................................................................10  
Rear View ..............................................................................................11  
When Optional Recording Paper Trays are Installed ..............................12  
OPERATION PANEL.................................................... 13  
SETUP ......................................................................... 16  
UNPACKING ...........................................................................16  
FACSIMILE MACHINE INSTALLATION .................................18  
ConnectingYour TOSHIBA Facsimile.....................................................18  
Recording Paper Exit Tray .....................................................................19  
Document Exit Tray................................................................................19  
Charger Cleaner, Mylar Scraper ............................................................19  
INITIAL PRINTING SUPPLIES INSTALLATION ....................20  
Recording Paper Installation ..................................................................20  
Recording Paper Size Adjustment .........................................................22  
Bypass Tray Installation .........................................................................23  
Developer Assembly and Drum Unit Installation ....................................25  
Fuser Cleaner Installation......................................................................27  
PRINTING SUPPLIES REPLACEMENT ................................28  
Toner Cartridge Replacement................................................................28  
Drum Unit Replacement ........................................................................31  
QUICK START ........................................................................34  
Terminal ID ............................................................................................34  
Transmitting ...........................................................................................34  
Receiving ..............................................................................................34  
USER INTERFACE OPERATION ...........................................35  
Menu Operation.....................................................................................35  
Keys Used in Menu Operation ..........................................................35  
BASIC FUNCTIONS .................................................... 70  
AUTOMATICTELEPHONE DIALING .....................................70  
Abbreviated Dialer Registration .............................................................70  
One Touch Dialer Registration ...............................................................77  
Group Number Registration ...................................................................83  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reception Multicopy Setting ..................................................................116  
TELEPHONE HANDSET OPERATION (Optional) ................117  
On-hook Dialing.....................................................................................117  
Tone Output ...........................................................................................118  
Redialing ...............................................................................................118  
COMMUNICATION STATUS...................................................119  
Current Job Status ................................................................................119  
Display & Print Transmission Report......................................................120  
Communication Journal .........................................................................120  
CANCELLING A COMMUNICATION JOB.............................121  
Cancelling a Direct Transmission ...........................................................121  
Cancelling a Job Reservation ................................................................121  
TRANSMIT CONFIGURATION...............................................87  
Document Specifications .......................................................................87  
Document Loading ................................................................................88  
Scan Resolution Setting ........................................................................89  
Contrast Setting.....................................................................................90  
Default Setting for Memory Transmission...............................................91  
Send After Scan Default Setting ............................................................92  
Default Setting for Security Transmission ...............................................93  
COPYING ............................................................................... 94  
Paper Size for Copying ..........................................................................94  
Copying Procedure ................................................................................95  
DIALING METHODS ..............................................................97  
One Touch Key Dialing...........................................................................97  
Abbreviated Dialing................................................................................98  
Alphabet Dialing ....................................................................................99  
Keypad Dialing ......................................................................................100  
TRANSMITTING .....................................................................101  
MemoryTransmission............................................................................101  
Memory Transmission Procedure .....................................................102  
DirectTransmission ...............................................................................103  
Direct Transmission as Default Setting..............................................103  
Temporary Direct Transmission.........................................................105  
On-hook Transmission (Monitor Speaker Dialing) .............................106  
Off-hook Transmission (Optional Handset Dialing) ...........................107  
External Off-hook Transmission  
(Transmission Using an External Telephone) ....................................109  
Redialing ...............................................................................................110  
Automatic Redialing..........................................................................110  
Manual Redialing Direct Transmission ..............................................110  
Manual Redialing Jobs in Memory....................................................111  
RECEIVING ............................................................................112  
Automatic Receiving Mode ....................................................................112  
Manual Receiving Mode ........................................................................112  
Selecting the Receiving Mode ...............................................................112  
Recording Paper Size ............................................................................113  
Reception Reduction Setting .................................................................113  
Reception Discard Setting .....................................................................114  
Reverse Order Printing Setting ..............................................................115  
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS ........................................... 123  
MULTI-ADDRESSTRANSMISSION (BROADCASTING) ...... 123  
Group Broadcast Transmission ..............................................................123  
Multi-Key Quick Broadcast Transmission ...............................................124  
RELAYTRANSMISSION ........................................................ 126  
Relay Transmission, Relay-Relay Transmission Overview .....................126  
Setting Up a Relay Box..........................................................................127  
Deleting a Relay Box .............................................................................132  
Relay Transmission to a Remote Hub ....................................................134  
POLLING & MAILBOX COMMUNICATIONS .........................136  
Polling & Mailbox Overview....................................................................136  
Polling Reservation...........................................................................136  
Polling Reception..............................................................................136  
Open Mailbox (ITU-T Compatible) ....................................................137  
Simple & Security Polling Reservation ...................................................138  
Public Mailbox Polling Reservation ........................................................140  
Simple & Secure Polling ........................................................................141  
Multi Address Polling .............................................................................143  
Continuous Polling .................................................................................145  
Turnaround Polling .................................................................................147  
MAILBOX (ITU-T Compatible)............................................... 149  
Setting Up a Mailbox..............................................................................149  
Deleting a Mailbox .................................................................................151  
Sending a Document to a Mailbox (Remote Hub) ..................................153  
Reserving a Document to a Mailbox (Local Hub)...................................155  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Retrieving (Polling) a Document from a Mailbox (Remote Hub) .............157  
Printing a Document from a Mailbox (Local Hub) ..................................159  
Cancelling Documents in a Mailbox (Local Hub)....................................161  
ADVANCEDTRANSMISSION FUNCTIONS ..........................163  
Department Code Access .....................................................................163  
Account Code Entry ..............................................................................164  
Cover Sheet Registration.......................................................................165  
Chain Dialing .........................................................................................166  
TTI (Transmit Terminal ID) Print .............................................................167  
Setting Recovery Transmission..............................................................168  
Sending Recovery Transmission............................................................169  
PIN Mask...............................................................................................171  
Disabling ECM Temporarily....................................................................172  
ADVANCED RECEPTION FUNCTIONS ................................173  
Privileged Reception..............................................................................173  
RTI (Remote Terminal ID) Print..............................................................174  
Display the RTI Menu ............................................................................174  
Select the RTI Print Option ....................................................................174  
Memory Reception Setting ....................................................................175  
Secure Reception Access Code Setting ................................................176  
Secure RX Activation Period Setting......................................................177  
Secure RX Manual Activation ................................................................179  
Secure RX Print.....................................................................................180  
TRANSMISSION OPTIONS ...................................................181  
Delayed Communication (Time Designation) .........................................181  
Communication Report Print .................................................................182  
PriorityTransmission .............................................................................183  
Low Speed Transmission .......................................................................184  
Dialing with Sub-Address ......................................................................185  
Attaching or Printing a Cover Sheet.......................................................187  
Line Selection ........................................................................................189  
Enabling or Disabling Send After Scan Temporarily ...............................190  
Setting the Page Count..........................................................................192  
Line Monitor...........................................................................................193  
SecurityTransmission ............................................................................194  
Direct Transmission Report Setting........................................................197  
Memory Transmission Report Setting ....................................................198  
Multi-Address Transmission Report Setting ..........................................199  
Multi-Polling Report Setting ...................................................................200  
Relay Originator Report Setting .............................................................201  
Relay Station Transmission Report Setting ............................................202  
Relay Destination Report Setting...........................................................203  
Reception List Settings ..........................................................................204  
LIST AND REPORT PRINT FORMAT AND  
PRINTING PROCEDURE .......................................................205  
Transmission/Reception Journal (Communication Journal) ...................205  
Transmission Report..............................................................................207  
Memory Transmission Report ................................................................208  
Reservation List.....................................................................................209  
Multi-Address Transmission Report .......................................................210  
Multi-Polling Report ...............................................................................211  
Relay Transmission Originator Report ...................................................212  
Relay Transmission Relay Station Report ..............................................213  
Relay Transmission End Terminal Report ..............................................214  
Relay Reception List..............................................................................215  
Mailbox/Relay Box (ITU-T Compatible F-code Communication) List......216  
Department Control List ........................................................................217  
Preset Dialing Number Lists ..................................................................218  
All of Lists .........................................................................................218  
Alphabetical Sort List........................................................................219  
Abbreviated Dial Number List ...........................................................220  
Group Number List ...........................................................................221  
One Touch Number List ....................................................................222  
Function List ..........................................................................................223  
Menu List...............................................................................................224  
Power Failure List ..................................................................................225  
TROUBLESHOOTING ................................................. 226  
Error Messages .....................................................................226  
Paper Jam Error Codes .........................................................................228  
Error Codes Printed on Reports ............................................................229  
Transmission Problems..........................................................................230  
Reception Problems ..............................................................................231  
Clearing a Document Jam .....................................................................232  
LISTS AND REPORTS ................................................ 195  
LIST AND REPORT OPTIONS SETTING ..............................195  
Reception Journal Settings....................................................................195  
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing a Recording Paper Jam ...........................................................233  
When the Recorded Image is not Clear... ..............................................235  
Document Scanner Cleaning Procedure ..........................................235  
Recording Unit Cleaning Procedure .................................................237  
USER TEST MODE..................................................... 240  
AUTOMATICTEST MODE ...................................................... 240  
AUTO TEST...........................................................................................240  
INDIVIDUALTEST MODE ...................................................... 241  
INDIVIDUAL TEST Summary ................................................................241  
ADF TEST .............................................................................................242  
KEY TEST .............................................................................................244  
LED TEST .............................................................................................245  
LCD TEST .............................................................................................246  
SPEAKER TEST ...................................................................................247  
SWITCH TEST ......................................................................................248  
TEST PRINT .........................................................................................251  
TEST RESULT ........................................................................252  
PRINTING a TEST RESULT..................................................................252  
REMOTE SERVICE ..................................................... 253  
RDC (Remote Diagnosis Configuration) Service ...............253  
AUTOMATIC SUPPLIES ORDER........................................... 254  
Automatic Supplies Order Setting ..........................................................254  
SPECIFICATIONS ....................................................... 255  
SUPPLIES ................................................................... 256  
HARDWARE OPTIONS ............................................... 256  
TOSHIBA Viewer ......................................................... 257  
INDEX .......................................................................... 287  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FEATURES  
Super G3 High-speed Communications  
Substitute Memory Reception  
Provides state-of-the-art V.34 modem technology for worldwide compatibility at  
speeds up to 33,600 bits per second.  
When the recording paper or supplies have been depleted or in the event of a  
recording paper jam, your receptions will be safely stored in memory until the  
problem is corrected.  
High Resolution, 256 Level Halftone  
With a maximum resolution of 16 dots/mm x 15.4 lines/mm (406 DPI x 391 LPI)  
and 256 level halftone, precision drawings, small-size characters, photographs,  
etc. are copied, sent, and received with exceptional clarity.  
Memory Release  
Minimizes the potential for memory overflows when connected with a remote loca-  
tion. After each page has been successfully transmitted it is released from memory  
to make room for subsequent pages.  
Open Network Mailbox Systems  
TOSHIBA Viewer  
Your new TOSHIBA provides ITU-T F-code communication for Open Mailbox op-  
eration.  
Installing the TOSHIBA Viewer software that comes with the machine enables  
following functions (see page 255).  
Hyper Scan Document Scanning  
• 600 dpi plain paper laser printer  
PC print jobs are printed on plain paper at a crisp 600 dpi print resolution.  
Allows letter sized originals to be scanned into memory in as little as 1.2 seconds  
per page.  
• Setting and programming the machine from a PC  
You can set up and program the machine from a PC.  
73 Programmable One Touch Autodialer Keys  
Allows remote locations to be quickly dialed at the touch of a key saving time and  
eliminating mis-dialed phone numbers.  
• PC Scanner function  
The machine can be used as a Twain compatible B/W image scanner (16 dots/  
mm x 15.4 dots/mm max.).  
300 Abbreviated Autodial Locations  
In addition to the 73 One Touch Autodialer Keys, 300 abbreviated locations can  
also be programmed with other frequently called locations. These locations can  
then be easily accessed using abbreviated codes ranging from 001 to 999.  
User Test Mode  
The user test mode can help you to find the cause of a machine problem should a  
failure occur.  
22 Function Keys  
Twenty two frequently used functions are assigned to the keys located on the One  
Touch Index Panel. These keys allow direct access to frequently used function  
settings and operations.  
PCL Printing (Option)  
By installing the optional PCL Print Kit (GA-1020), the machine can be used as a  
PCL printer. Adding the optional NIC Kit (GF-1010) enables to use the machine as  
a network PCL printer.  
Multi-address (Broadcast Transmission)  
This feature allows the transmission of a document to multiple remote units with  
one operation sequence. Locations may be selected using the autodialer or infre-  
quently dialed locations that have not been preregistered.  
Internet Fax Function (Option)  
You can send a facsimile message via the internet by having the optional Internet  
Fax Kit (GD-1040) and NIC Kit (GF-1010) installed in the machine.  
Multi-Memory Access Operation  
Allows up to 5 operations such as transmission or reception on either line 1 or line  
2 (if so equipped), printing, scanning, and programming to be performed at the  
same time.  
Super Power Saver Mode  
Reduces power consumption to approx. 2W by turning all unnecessary functions  
off in the standby mode.  
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CARE AND MAINTENANCE  
Do not Place the Unit in the Following Environments  
About Power for the Unit  
This unit requires 120 V AC, 60Hz electric power. This unit should not be used in  
countries that do not conform to domestic power provisions.  
Do not place this facsimile unit in the environments described below.  
Where temperature is excessively high, such as places close to heaters, radiators,  
direct sunlight, etc.  
Insert the power cord plug firmly to the wall outlet, then insert the other end of the  
cord into the receptacle on the machine. If it is not firmly connected, the unit will  
not operate normally. When unplugging the unit, grasp by the plug and not the  
cord.  
Where the temperature can become excessively low.  
Where water or any chemicals may come in contact with the unit.  
Where the humidity is too high.  
Do not share one outlet with too many electric appliances. This may create a fire  
hazard.  
Where dust, dirt, metal filings, or hazardous gases may exist.  
When the possibility of lightning arises, unplug the power cord from the wall outlet.  
Also, unplug the phone cord from the facsimile unit. This prevents possible dam-  
age from lightning striking power or phone lines.  
Near equipment with strong magnetic fields, such as a radio’s, TV’s, audio  
amplifier’s, speaker’s, or other electric appliances.  
Where condensation may easily result, i.e., an environment subject to sudden  
temperature changes, such as places close to an air-conditioner or heater.  
Avoid sharing the electrical wall outlet with other equipment that may cause power  
surges (air-conditioners, large copiers, etc.). Power surges may cause the unit to  
malfunction.  
Where vibrations frequently occur. (Provide a space of 4 inches or more between  
the rear side of the unit and the wall.)  
Do not step on the power cord, and do not place anything on it.  
Other Remarks  
When a Power Failure Occurs  
In the event of a power failure, neither facsimile nor telephone functions of the unit  
are available.  
Do not disassemble or modify the facsimile unit. This may result in electric shock,  
hazard or machine malfunction.  
In the event a power failure occurs (or the power to the unit has been discon-  
nected), functions and unit operation will not be possible. Any document data  
stored in memory will be retained for a period of approximately 10 hours (if the  
internal battery is fully charged). This period may be shortened if optional memory  
has been installed. On exceeding that time limit, the following items will be erased:  
Keep fire sources away from the facsimile unit. This may create a fire hazard.  
Keep paper clips and staples away from the unit. If metal objects fall in the unit, it  
may damage the machine.  
Avoid opening the unit while it is scanning or printing. The operation will stop and it  
may cause a malfunction and/or damage.  
Document data stored in memory for Transmission, Substitute Memory Recep-  
tions, etc.  
Do not drop, hit, or apply excessive shocks to the unit, as this may result in  
damage to the unit.  
The address and designated time of each Timer Transmission, Timer Polling  
Reception, etc.  
When using international or discount communications services, communication  
reliability may be impaired.  
Programmed data such as the clock, Auto Dial Numbers and user configurations  
will not be erased. This data is supported by second battery with a maximum five  
year life (from time of manufacture).  
Use of non authorized parts or supplies may result in damage to the unit and could  
result in termination of the service or warranty agreement.  
In the event that document data has been erased  
If any abnormal conditions occur, such as emitting of smoke or burning odor,  
immediately disconnect power to the unit and contact your authorized Toshiba  
dealer for service.  
MAY-17-00 WED09:43  
POWER FAILURE  
due to a power failure, the message “POWER  
FAILURE” is displayed on the LCD as shown to  
the right and a Power Failure Report is issued  
once the power is restored (see page 225).  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INTRODUCTION - FACSIMILE UNIT DESCRIPTIONS  
Front View  
Document Guides  
Document Exit Tray  
Adjust the guides to the edges of  
Stacks the original  
documents after scanning.  
the document to help ensure proper  
document alignment and smooth  
feeding. (See page 88.)  
Scanner Cover Release Button  
Document Exit Tray Extension  
Provides access to the document  
scanner area for periodic cleaning or  
clearing jammed originals.  
Supports long original documents  
after scanning.  
(See page 232.)  
(See page 19.)  
Document Tray  
Place documents face down on  
this tray to transmit or copy.  
Recording Paper  
Exit Tray  
Stacks recording paper  
after printing.  
Centronics PC Interface  
(See page 19.)  
This interface is used for connection to  
personal computers for Scanning,  
Printing and programming various  
settings from a PC.  
Operation Panel  
Top Cover Release Lever  
Used to perform programming  
and operation of the facsimile  
machine.  
(See page 13.)  
Provides access to printer section to  
replace supplies or to clear paper  
jams. (See page 233.)  
Paper Tray  
Holds up to 550 sheets of  
recording paper.  
(See page 22.)  
Bypass Tray Cover  
Remove this cover when you  
install the Bypass Tray.  
Right Side Cover  
Provides access to the  
recording paper feed path.  
002  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Rear View  
External Telephone Connector  
Connection for an External  
Telephone set. (See page 18.)  
Line 1 Connector  
Connection for the telephone  
line cord from wall or PSTN  
system. (See page 18.)  
Handset Connector  
Connection for the optional  
Handset unit. (See page 18.)  
Centronics PC Interface  
Line 2 Connector  
Connection for the 2nd telephone line  
cord from wall or PSTN system.  
DP125F: Standard  
DP120F: Option  
AC Inlet  
003  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When Optional Recording Paper Trays are Installed  
With two recording paper trays installed  
With three recording paper trays installed  
Handset  
Handset  
(optional)  
(optional)  
Upper Recording  
Paper Tray  
Upper Recording  
Paper Tray  
107  
004  
Middle Recording  
Paper Tray  
Lower Recording  
Paper Tray  
(optional)  
(optional)  
Bypass Tray  
Bypass Tray  
(DP125F: standard)  
(DP120F: optional)  
(DP125F: standard)  
(DP120F: optional)  
Lower Recording  
Paper Tray  
(optional)  
NOTE:  
Optimal height console stands are available for one or two paper tray configurations. These stands maximize operational access, LCD view angle and  
provide rugged roller casters for easy cleaning.  
12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- OPERATION PANEL  
1. Error Lamps  
2.  
3.  
LINE 1 Lamp  
Blinks when communicating using Line 1.  
In the event an error occurs in the facsimile, the corresponding lamp will be  
illuminated:  
LINE 2 Lamp  
Blinks when communicating using Line 2.  
.... PAPER JAM Lamp:  
Blinks when an original document or recording paper jam occurs (see page  
233).  
4.  
5.  
PC COMM Lamp  
..... RECORDING PAPER Lamp:  
Blinks when communicating between the facsimile unit and a personal computer.  
Blinks when the recording paper supply has been depleted (see page 20).  
SUPER POWER SAVER key and SUPER POWER SAVER Lamp  
..... TONER Lamp:  
Press this key to select the Super Power Saver Mode.  
Illuminated when the facsimile is in the Super Power Saver Mode.  
Blinks when the toner is nearly or entirely exhausted (see page 28).  
..... DRUM Lamp:  
6. LCD Display  
Displays machine status and configuration information for operator viewing and  
inter-action.  
Blinks when the Process Unit is at or near its end of life (see page 31).  
..... ALARM Lamp:  
7. INSERT Key  
Is blinks when any error other than those listed above occurs (see page  
226).  
This key is used to insert characters in CHARACTER ENTRY mode (see page 36).  
8. DELETE Key  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This key is used to delete characters in CHARACTER ENTRY mode (see page  
36).  
Selects the desired resolution for transmission or copying. When Standard mode is  
selected, none of the MODE lamps will be illuminated (see page 89).  
9. Dial Keypad  
Use these 12 keys just like a telephone keypad to dial telephone/facsimile num-  
bers (see page 35).  
19.Menu Keys (  
,
,
,
Keys)  
These keys are used to scroll and highlight desired LCD menu prompts (see page  
35).  
10.MULTI Key  
Performs Multi-address Transmissions (Broadcast) or a Multi-polling receptions  
(see page 124).  
The  
is also used as the [TONE] Key. The  
key is helpful to access  
11.SPEED DIAL Key  
various services requiring touch-tone dialing when you are connected to a Rotary  
line (see page 118).  
Used for accessing Abbreviated, Alphabet, or Group dialing telephone directories  
(see pages 98, 99 and 123).  
20.ENTER Key  
12.REDIAL/PAUSE Key  
Press this key to enter a selected menu item or select a menu entry.  
Press this key to redial a facsimile/telephone number if the number was busy on  
your first try (see page 110). Or, use this key to enter a pause between telephone  
digits when entering a remote facsimile number.  
21.JOB CANCEL Key  
Used to cancel a job reserved or being executed (see page 119).  
13.MONITOR Key  
22.E-MAIL ADDRESS Key  
Used to enable the speaker monitor, for monitoring call progress during non  
memory document feeder transmissions (see page 106).  
Used to program E-mail addresses when programming One Touch Key or Abbrevi-  
ated Numbers. By pressing this key prior to a transmission, an E-mail address can  
be entered for an Internet FAX transmission.  
14.START Key  
Press this key to start facsimile communication. This key is also used to complete  
programming.  
23.JOB STATUS Key  
Displays the communication status of reserved transmissions (see page 119).  
15.STOP Key  
24.One Touch Keys (1-49), One Touch Keys (50-73), Function Keys, and  
Keyboard.  
Used to stop an operation or cancel system programming. This key is also used to  
clear an error condition.  
View the One Touch Keys (1-49), One Touch Keys (50-73), Function Keys, and  
Keyboard by turning the Flip Panels (see page 15).  
16.COPY Key  
Press this key, with a document in the Document Tray, to copy a document (see  
page 95).  
17. TX REPORT Key  
Press this key to request or disable a Transmission Report for your current trans-  
mission job.  
18.MODE Key and FINE, U-FINE, HALFTONE Lamps  
14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Function Keys  
The Function Keys are located on the left of the Op-  
eration Panel and enable the following frequently  
used functions and settings by pressing the desired  
key.  
Function Keys  
CHAIN DIAL COMM  
PRIORITY TX  
RESERVATION LIST  
Prints a Job Reservation List (see page 209).  
Used to dial a remote party using Chain Dialing (see  
page 166).  
Sends pages set in the ADF ahead of all previously  
scheduled transmissions (see page 183).  
SECURE RX  
CHARGE CODE  
RECOVERY TX  
Enables or disables Secure RX (see page 179).  
Allows entry of a Charge Code at the time of dialing  
or during Abbreviated Dial and One Touch Dial pro-  
gramming (see page 171).  
Recovers from memory and sends incomplete trans-  
missions (see page 169).  
CHECK E-MAIL  
Used to receive an E-mail immediately. (Requires  
optional GD-1040 (Internet FAX Kit) and GF-1010  
(NIC Kit) be installed.)  
SEND AFTER SCAN  
DELAYED COMM  
Used to select whether the dialing starts while the  
machine is scanning the documents or after the ma-  
chine has scanned all documents to memory (see  
page 190).  
Schedules a delayed communication job to be per-  
formed at a designated time (see page 181).  
TEL LINE SELECT  
Designates a specific telephone line for the current  
transmission (see page 189).  
DIRECT TX  
Allows transmission direct from the document feeder POLLING  
TEL LIST ENTRY  
without the use of memory (see page 105).  
Designate polling communication (see page 138).  
Used to register Abbreviated, One Touch, Group,  
and Relay Group Dialing numbers (see pages 70, 77  
and 83).  
LOW SPEED TX  
SUB ADDRESS COMM  
Used to select a lower transmission speed to trans-  
mit a document when poor line conditions are ex-  
pected, such as when transmitting to a foreign coun-  
try that can only accept low speed data (see page  
184).  
Add sub-address digits to the remote facsimile num-  
ber for routing or security (see page 185).  
TEL LIST PRINT  
PCL PRINT  
Prints desired telephone/facsimile lists (see page  
218).  
Used to set the functions related to the PCL Board  
when the optional GA-1020 (PCL Print Kit) is in-  
stalled.  
CONTRAST  
ITU MAILBOX  
Selects the desired contrast level of transmit docu-  
ments (see page 90).  
Used for Mailbox Communications or Relay Trans-  
mission, with remote facsimiles that support the ITU-  
T F-code functions (see page 149).  
JOURNAL  
Used to print a communication journal (see page  
195).  
COVER SHEET  
PREV. TX RPT  
Used to attach a cover sheet to a document to be  
transmitted (see pages 165 and 187).  
Displays or prints the result of previous transmission  
jobs (see page 120).  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SETUP - UNPACKING  
1
2
Unpack the Carton  
Make sure All Items are Enclosed  
5
9
13  
12  
2
1
14  
6
7
3
4
10  
11  
17  
8
18  
Packing List  
This hardware has been designed to be installed by an  
authorized TOSHIBA service representative.  
1. Facsimile .................................................. 1  
2. Phone Line Cord (Modular Cord).............. 1  
3. Document Exit Tray .................................. 1  
4. Recording Paper Exit Tray ....................... 1  
5. Fuser Cleaner .......................................... 1  
6. Developer Assembly ................................ 1  
7. Drum Unit ................................................. 1  
8. Operator’s Manual .................................... 1  
9. Overlay..................................................... 1  
10. Warranty Card .......................................... 1  
11. AC Power Cord ........................................ 1  
12. Charger Cleaner ....................................... 1  
13. Mylar Scraper ........................................... 1  
14. Cotton Swab............................................. 1  
15. Unpacking Report..................................... 1  
16. Quick Reference Guide ............................ 1  
17. TOSHIBA Viewer CD-ROM ...................... 1  
18. Bypass Tray (DP125F only) ..................... 1  
Check the carton and report any damage to the delivery  
service. Save the carton and packing materials for future  
use.  
Check the items in the carton with the following packing  
list. If anything is missing, contact your dealer immedi-  
ately.  
16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3
Select a Desirable Location  
The unit should be installed:  
On a horizontal surface.  
Away from direct sunlight, dust, extreme heat and humidity, and vibration.  
Away from sources of strong electrical or magnetic fields, such as televisions or  
radios.  
Within reach of an electrical outlet. Use an outlet not shared with equipment that  
generates electrical noise or consumes large amounts of electricity, such as an air  
conditioner, or a copier.  
Within reach of a telephone connection. Use a dedicated, single-line telephone  
connection.  
Allow for adequate ventilation. The rear and sides of the unit need to be clear to  
allow proper air flow to the unit’s power supply.  
591 mm  
(23.3 inches)  
100 mm  
(3.9 inches)  
Height: 635 mm (25 inches)  
(Top Cover open)  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- FACSIMILE MACHINE INSTALLATION  
Connecting Your TOSHIBA Facsimile  
Make sure that the Power Switch is turned OFF.  
Plug in the power cord as in the figure below.  
Connect the telephone line cord (modular cord) to the “LINE1” connector.  
Connect the external telephone set (if desired) to the “PHONE” connector.  
Connect the optional Handset (if equipped) to the “HANDSET” connector.  
Power Switch  
OFF  
Power Cord  
023  
024  
WARNING  
Never install telephone wiring during a lightning storm.  
Never install telephone jacks in wet locations unless the jack is specifically designed for wet locations.  
Never touch uninsulated telephone wires or terminals unless the telephone line has been disconnected at the network interface.  
Use caution when installing or modifying the telephone lines.  
Avoid using a telephone (other than a cordless type) during an electrical storm. There may be a remote risk of electric shock from  
lightning.  
Do not use the telephone to report a gas leak in the vicinity of the leak.  
18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Charger Cleaner, Mylar Scraper  
Recording Paper Exit Tray  
Document Exit Tray  
Charger Cleaner and  
Mylar Scraper  
Installation  
Recording Paper Exit  
Tray Installation  
Document Exit Tray  
Installation  
Charger Cleaner  
Mylar  
Scraper  
025  
026  
028  
Place the hooks of the Record- Fit the tabs of the Document Open the top cover. Store the  
ing Paper Exit Tray into the slots Exit Tray into the slots on the Charger Cleaner and Mylar  
on the left side of the unit.  
left side of the unit.  
Scraper in the location provided  
in the rear inner cover of the  
facsimile as shown in the figure.  
Do not place heavy objects  
on the Document Exit Tray  
or apply strong force.  
Do not place heavy objects  
on the Recording Paper Exit  
Tray or apply strong force.  
NOTE:  
Extend the Document Exit  
Tray Extension for long doc-  
uments.  
The Charger Cleaner and  
Mylar Scraper are used  
when cleaning the Drum Unit  
and Developer Assembly.  
See pages 238 and 239.  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- INITIAL PRINTING SUPPLIES INSTALLATION  
Recording Paper Installation  
About Recording Paper:  
Pull Out the Paper  
Tray  
Attach the Recording  
Paper Size Label  
Press Down the  
Paper Pressure Plate  
Prepare the  
Recording Paper  
1
2
3
4
• Use only recommended paper  
brands to optimize your fac-  
simile performance. Contact  
your authorized TOSHIBA  
dealer for more information.  
Recording Paper  
Size Label  
• Remove the recording paper  
when storing or relocating  
your facsimile.  
• Avoid using damaged, folded  
or misaligned recording paper.  
Use of damaged paper could  
cause double feeding or paper  
jams.  
Paper  
Pressure Plate  
032  
031  
029  
030  
Pull the paper tray out using the If not already at the correct pa- Press the Paper Pressure Plate Prepare new recording paper  
handle located at the front of the per size, insert the Paper Size down until it clicks.  
sheets by holding both ends and  
flexing several times.  
tray.  
Label into the slot of the Paper  
Tray.  
• Use of damp recording paper  
will cause poor printing over  
all or part of the image area. If  
the paper is excessively moist,  
print quality may become un-  
even and voiding may occur.  
Replace the paper, should this  
condition exist.  
Pull the tray straight out toward  
you as illustrated above.  
This will separate the sheets  
and provide optimum feeding.  
See page 22 for information on  
changing the recording paper  
size.  
Align the stack so that all four  
corners are neatly aligned.  
CAUTION:  
Never place heavy objects  
on an open tray, nor apply a  
strong force.  
Be sure to load the recording  
paper in accordance with any  
paper manufacturer’s printing  
side instruction. Some papers  
have a preferred image side.  
This image side should be  
placed face down in the paper  
tray.  
20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording Paper Installation - continued  
Install the  
Recording Paper  
Close the Paper  
Tray  
5
6
033  
034  
Place the recording paper stack Push the paper tray all the way  
into the tray.  
into the machine.  
NOTE:  
NOTES:  
As the tray is closed, listen  
for the sound of the paper  
pressure plate moving up  
into position.  
Do not exceed the upper  
stack limit line as this may  
cause paper mis-feeds.  
Make sure that the paper  
is seated under the two  
separation claws on the  
right side of tray.  
Be careful not to damage  
the claws of the paper  
tray.  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording Paper Size Adjustment  
About Paper Sizes:  
Pull Out the Paper  
Tray  
Adjust the Paper  
Guide  
Attach the Recording  
Paper Size Label  
Close the Paper  
Tray  
1
2
3
4
Your TOSHIBA facsimile has  
been preset to accept letter  
size recording paper.  
Recording Paper  
Size Label  
In the event that you receive  
a legal-size (8.5”x14”) recep-  
tion, it will automatically be  
reduced to fit onto letter-size  
(8.5”x11”) paper.  
If you receive only Legal-  
size receptions and do not  
wish them to be automati-  
cally reduced: Adjust the re-  
cording paper tray to load  
the legal size paper.  
029  
036  
034  
030  
Pull the paper tray out and re- Remove the Paper Guide.  
Change the paper size label lo- Place the recording paper into  
cated in the front-right corner of the tray and push the tray into  
the paper tray to match the new the machine.  
paper size.  
move the recording paper.  
Install the Paper Guide in the  
correct position for the new pa-  
per size.  
If you receive a mixture of  
Letter and Legal-size re-  
ceptions, and you do not  
wish your legal receptions  
to be automatically re-  
duced: Add an optional re-  
cording paper tray to support  
both the letter and legal-size  
paper. With the second re-  
cording paper tray, your  
TOSHIBA facsimile will auto-  
matically select the appropri-  
ate paper size to match the  
pages you receive.  
Check to make sure that the  
LCD display has returned to  
the time and date standby  
mode and no alarm lamps  
are illuminated.  
Paper size indicators have been  
conveniently molded into the pa-  
per tray next to the paper post.  
Make a copy using the new  
recording paper to confirm  
proper operation.  
NOTE:  
Install the Paper Guide se-  
curely. If you fail, a PAPER  
EMPTY error will be dis-  
played even when the paper  
is loaded in the paper tray.  
Be sure to load the recording  
paper image side down.  
22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Bypass Tray Installation  
The Bypass Tray comes stan-  
dard with the DP125F. (The By-  
pass Tray is available as an op-  
tion for the DP120F.)  
Remove the Bypass  
Tray Cover  
Install the Bypass  
Tray  
Set the Paper Size  
Raise the Tray Lever  
1
2
3
4
You can select to print from the  
Bypass Tray for copy, PC print,  
and A5-size report. Letter, Le-  
gal, A4, and A5 size paper can  
be loaded into the Bypass Tray.  
The Bypass Tray can also ac-  
cept an envelope, transparency,  
120  
Tray Lever  
Bypass  
Tray  
or label. (Select “  
as the paper size.)  
: OTHERS”  
Bypass Tray Cover  
119  
Size Selector  
121  
118  
Remove the two screws holding Install the Bypass Tray.  
the Bypass Tray Cover.  
Set the paper size using the Raise the Tray Lever.  
size selector.  
NOTES:  
You can load up to 100  
sheets of Letter, Legal, A4 or  
A5 size paper (20 lbs.).  
Envelope, transparency or  
label stock should be loaded  
one sheet at a time.  
Place the paper in the center  
of the Bypass Tray when the  
paper size is set to  
: OTHERS.”  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Bypass Tray Installation - continued  
Pull up the Paper  
Support  
Set the Recording  
Paper  
Lower the Tray  
Lever  
5
6
7
Paper Guide  
Tray Lever  
Recording  
Paper  
Bypass Tray  
Paper Support  
122  
123  
124  
Pull up the Bypass Tray Paper Set the Recording Paper and Lower the Tray Lever.  
Support.  
adjust the Paper Guides to the  
correct paper size.  
24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Developer Assembly and Drum Unit Installation  
Attach the Drum Unit  
to the Developer  
Assembly  
Install the Developer  
Assembly with Drum  
Unit  
Open the Top Cover  
Shake the Developer  
Assembly  
Remove the  
Protective Strip  
1
2
3
4
5
Top Cover  
Release Lever  
Developer  
Assembly  
Drum Unit  
Developer  
Assembly  
Strip  
Developer  
Assembly  
Developer  
Assembly  
041  
042  
037  
040  
043  
Grasp the Top Cover Release  
Lever to open the Top Cover.  
Hold the Developer Assembly Holding the Developer Assem- Attach the Drum Unit to the De- Install the Developer Assembly  
with both hands and shake the bly with one hand, grasp the veloper Assembly. Position the (with Drum Unit attached) into  
cartridge back and forth several end of the protective strip under Drum Unit with the green Drum the machine.  
times.  
the Toner Cartridge. Pull the surface facing the Toner Roller  
strip firmly to completely remove on the Developer Assembly.  
Holding the Developer Assem-  
bly by the green handles, align  
the three shafts on the Devel-  
it from the Toner Cartridge.  
IMPORTANT:  
The sealing film will contain  
a small amount of toner on  
its surface.  
Never touch the photo- oper Assembly sides with the  
conductive drum (the slots in the machine frame.  
green surface) of the  
Carefully dispose of the film  
in an appropriate waste re-  
ceptacle to avoid soiling  
items it may come in contact  
with.  
Drum Unit. If the surface  
is scarred or scratched, it  
will cause print quality  
problems.  
Do not expose the photo-  
conductive drum of the  
Drum Unit to light for  
more than 3 minutes. If  
the Drum Unit is to be left  
anywhere outside the fac-  
simile, be certain to cover  
it with cloth, paper, etc.  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Developer Assembly and Drum Unit Installation - continued  
Press Down on the  
Drum Unit  
Close the Top Cover  
6
7
Drum Unit  
045  
044  
Press firmly down on the green  
squares on the Drum Unit until  
the Drum Unit clicks into place.  
Holding the Top Cover Release  
Lever, close the Top Cover,  
then release the Lever.  
26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuser Cleaner Installation  
Open the Top Cover  
Close the Top Cover  
Install the Fuser  
Cleaner  
1
3
2
Top Cover  
Release Lever  
Fuser Cleaner  
037  
047  
045  
Holding the Top Cover Release  
Lever, close the Top Cover,  
then release the Lever.  
Grasp the Top Cover Release Remove the new Fuser Cleaner  
Lever to open the Top Cover.  
from its plastic bag and install it  
positioning its white pad side  
down.  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- PRINTING SUPPLIES REPLACEMENT  
Toner Cartridge Replacement  
Replacement Toner Kits for your  
Remove the  
Open the Top Cover  
Separate the Drum  
Unit  
Remove the Toner  
Cartridge  
TOSHIBA facsimile include a  
Toner Cartridge and a Fuser  
Cleaner. Be sure to replace the  
Fuser Cleaner when replacing  
the Toner Cartridge.  
1
2
3
4
Developer Assembly  
with Drum Unit  
Top Cover  
Release Lever  
Developer  
Assembly  
Drum Unit  
Toner Cartridge  
Your TOSHIBA facsimile has  
been designed to display a two  
stage alert to replace Toner  
once it has been depleted.  
Developer  
Assembly  
The first stage is a “TONER  
LOW” warning that alerts you  
that the Toner is low and should  
be replaced at your earliest con-  
vince.  
037  
051  
052  
053  
Grasp the Top Cover Release Remove the Developer Assem- Separate the Drum Unit from the  
Press the green Button on the  
left of the Developer Assembly  
and slide the toner cartridge to  
the left to disengage it from the  
Developer Assembly.  
Lever and open the Top Cover.  
bly with the Drum Unit attached.  
Developer Assembly.  
The unit will continue to receive  
and print facsimile messages  
during this stage.  
IMPORTANT:  
NOTE:  
Never touch the photo-  
conductive drum (the  
green surface) of the  
Drum Unit. If the surface  
is scarred or scratched, it  
will cause print quality  
problems.  
Avoid touching the toner to  
your clothing since toner can  
not be removed easily.  
If the toner sticks to your  
clothing, immediately rinse  
out the toner with cold water.  
Lift the Toner Cartridge from the  
Developer Assembly. Dispose  
of the used toner cartridge prop-  
erly.  
The second stage is a “TONER  
EMPTY” notice. When this mes-  
sage is displayed, the machine  
can no longer print documents.  
Receptions will be stored in  
memory until the Toner has  
been replaced.  
Do not expose the photo-  
conductive drum of the  
Drum Unit to light for  
more than 3 minutes. If  
the Drum Unit is to be left  
anywhere outside the  
facsimile, be certain to  
cover it with cloth, paper,  
etc.  
It is recommended to replace  
the Toner Cartridge whenever  
the “TONER LOW” message is  
displayed using the following  
procedure.  
28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Toner Cartridge Replacement - continued  
Attach the Drum Unit  
to the Developer  
Assembly  
Install the Developer  
Assembly with Drum  
Unit  
Prepare a New  
Toner Cartridge  
Install the New  
Toner Cartridge  
Remove the Strip  
5
6
7
8
9
Developer  
Assembly  
New Toner  
Cartridge  
Drum Unit  
Developer  
Assembly  
Strip  
New Toner  
Cartridge  
Developer  
Assembly  
Developer  
Assembly  
054  
055  
041  
042  
043  
Remove the new Toner Car-  
tridge from its plastic bag and  
save the bag for the used Toner  
Cartridge.  
Align the four hooks on the new Holding the Developer Assem- Attach the Drum Unit to the De-  
Toner Cartridge with the slots bly with one hand, grasp the veloper Assembly. Position the  
on the Developer Assembly. end of the protective strip under Drum Unit with the green drum  
Slide the cartridge onto the as- the toner housing. Pull the Strip surface facing the black toner  
Holding the Developer Assem-  
bly by the green handles, align  
the three shafts on the Devel-  
oper Assembly sides with the  
slots in the machine frame.  
sembly.  
firmly to completely remove it roller on the Developer Assem-  
from the cartridge. bly.  
Mix the new toner by shaking  
the Toner Cartridge back and  
forth.  
Move the cartridge to the right  
until the button on the left of the  
Developer Assembly clicks into NOTES:  
place.  
Do not stand or turn the  
Developer Assembly up  
side down to avoid toner  
leaking out the cartridge  
after removing the strip.  
NOTE:  
Only use the specified  
TOSHIBA Toner Cartridge.  
Toner might stick to the  
strip. Avoid toner sticking  
to your clothes, furniture,  
or other items since the  
toner cannot be removed  
easily. Toner is not harm-  
ful to the human body. If  
any toner sticks to your  
clothes, wash away the  
toner immediately using  
cold water.  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Toner Cartridge Replacement - continued  
Replacing the Fuser Cleaner  
Press Down on the  
Drum Unit  
Remove the fuser  
Cleaner  
Install the New fuser  
Cleaner  
Close the Top Cover  
10  
11  
12  
13  
To maintain optimum print quali-  
ty, replace the Fuser Cleaner  
each time you replace the Toner  
Cartridge.  
Drum Unit  
Fuser Cleaner  
CAUTION:  
The fuser’s interior can be  
very hot. Be careful when re-  
placing the fuser cleaner.  
Do not touch any surfaces  
inside the printer except as  
indicated.  
047  
045  
044  
061  
Fuser Cleaner  
Press firmly down on the green  
squares on the Drum Unit until  
the Drum Unit clicks into place.  
Grasp the two green tabs the  
used fuser cleaner from the ma-  
chine.  
Remove the new Fuser Cleaner Holding the Top Cover Release  
from its plastic bag and install it Lever, close the Top Cover,  
positioning its white pad side then release the Lever.  
down.  
30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Drum Unit Replacement  
Replacement Drum Kits include  
an Ozone Filter and Drum unit.  
Be sure to replace the Ozone  
Filter when replacing the Drum  
Unit.  
STORAGE NOTES:  
Remove the  
Open the Top Cover  
Separate the Drum  
Unit  
1
2
3
Developer Assembly  
with Drum Unit  
The Drum Unit is a very im-  
portant part of this facsimile.  
Handle it with care as shown  
below.  
Top Cover  
Release Lever  
Developer  
Assembly  
Drum Unit  
Your TOSHIBA facsimile has  
been designed to display a two-  
stage alert to replace the Drum  
Unit once it has been depleted.  
Keep the Drum Unit within a  
temperature range of 0-35°C  
(32-95°F) and  
range of 20-80%RH (without  
condensation).  
a
humidity  
The first stage is a “DRUM UNIT  
WARNING” that alerts you that  
the Drum Unit is at or near its  
end of life and should be re-  
placed at your earliest convince.  
The unit will continue to receive  
and print facsimile messages  
during this stage.  
Developer  
Assembly  
Do not store or use the Drum  
Unit in an environment  
037  
051  
052  
where  
the  
temperature  
Grasp the Top Cover Release Remove the Developer Assem- Separate the Drum Unit from the  
changes excessively.  
Lever and open the Top Cover.  
bly with the Drum Unit attached.  
Developer Assembly.  
Do not touch the light sensi-  
tive drum because its sur-  
face will be easily damaged.  
IMPORTANT:  
Never touch the photo-  
conductive drum (the  
green surface) of the  
Drum Unit. If the surface  
is scarred or scratched, it  
will cause print quality  
problems.  
The second stage is “REPLACE  
DRUM UNIT.” When this mes-  
sage is displayed, the machine  
can no longer print documents.  
Receptions will be stored in  
memory until the Drum Unit has  
been replaced.  
Do not place the light sensi-  
tive drum in a location where  
it is exposed to direct sun-  
light or high intensity light  
(more than 200 lx) such as  
near a window.  
Do not expose the photo-  
conductive drum of the  
Drum Unit to light for  
more than 3 minutes. If  
the Drum Unit is to be left  
anywhere outside the fac-  
simile, be certain to cover  
it with cloth, paper, etc.  
For the purpose of determining  
Drum usage;  
Each legal-size sheet of paper  
counts as 1.3 letter-size sheets  
of paper.  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Drum Unit Replacement - continued  
Replacing the Ozone Filter  
Attach the new Drum  
Unit to the  
Developer Assembly  
Install the Developer  
Assembly with Drum  
Unit  
Press Down on the  
Drum Unit  
Replace the Ozone  
Filter  
4
5
6
7
The Ozone Filter should be re-  
placed every time the Drum Unit  
is replaced.  
Developer  
Assembly  
Drum Unit  
Ozone Filter  
Drum Unit  
A new Ozone Filter has been  
provided with the Drum Kit.  
Make sure the Ozone Filter is  
replaced.  
Developer  
Assembly  
042  
043  
044  
069  
Attach the new Drum Unit to the  
Developer Assembly. Position  
the new Drum Unit with the  
green drum surface facing the  
black toner roller on the Devel-  
oper Assembly.  
Holding the Developer Assem- Press firmly down on the green  
bly by the green handles, align squares on the Drum Unit until  
the three shafts on the Devel- the Drum Unit clicks into place.  
oper Assembly sides with the  
Remove the Ozone Filter from  
the inside of the machine.  
Then, place the new Ozone Fil-  
ter into the machine.  
slots in the machine frame.  
32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Drum Unit Replacement - continued  
Close the Top Cover  
8
045  
Holding the Top Cover Release  
Lever, close the Top Cover,  
then release the Lever.  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- QUICK START  
This section provides several  
quick start programming steps  
to prepare your new facsimile  
for immediate use.  
Terminal ID  
Receiving  
Receiving a  
Transmitting  
Setting the Terminal ID (Page 42)  
Sending a Facsimile  
1
3
2
Facsimile (Page 112)  
(Page 101)  
These procedures are a simple  
version of the detailed proce-  
dures listed in the manual. Next  
to each procedure heading is a  
convenient page number refer-  
ence for the detailed procedure.  
Should you have any difficulty  
with these simple procedures,  
refer to the pages listed for more  
information.  
Load your document face down Your TOSHIBA facsimile has  
SET TERMINAL ID  
Press:  
,
,
into the Document Tray.  
been preset from the factory to  
receive facsimile messages. No  
special setup is required to re-  
ceive facsimile messages.  
TEL NUMBER (MAX 20)  
SET TERMINAL ID  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
ID NAME =(MAX 40)  
Enter your facsimile’s telephone  
number, press:  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
Dial the remote facsimile using  
the Dial Keypad located on the  
Operation Panel. Remember to  
include any access numbers  
It is highly recommended that  
you take the time to read  
through this manual to get the  
most from your new TOSHIBA  
facsimile.  
Enter your user ID (company  
name) using the Keyboard (see  
page 36) and Numeric Keypad,  
press:  
If the Line-2 board is installed,  
set the international code and  
facsimile’s telephone number for  
line-2.  
such as 9 or press the  
af-  
ter the access number if you  
normally have to wait for a dial  
tone.  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
INT. CODE?  
1.ADD+  
2.NOT NEEDED  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
If you communicate internation-  
ally, select:  
1.LANGUAGE  
2.DATE & TIME  
3.TERMINAL ID  
4.DIAL TYPE  
Otherwise, select:  
After the remote facsimile num-  
ber has been entered using the  
keypad, press the green START  
key.  
Press:  
34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- USER INTERFACE OPERATION  
Menu Operation  
Various functions of this fac-  
Keys Used in Menu Operation  
simile can be used by selecting  
menu items with the menu  
screen displayed in the LCD  
window. Performing operations  
or settings by selecting menu  
items selected is called “Menu  
Operation.” The menus use a  
multi-layered structure.  
[
[
] Key  
Press this key to enter the Menu Operation or to scroll up the menu selection.  
] Key  
Press this key to use the TONE function (see page 118) or when in the Menu Operation, press this  
key to scroll down the menu selection.  
Starting Menu Operation:  
When the facsimile is in the  
[
[
] Key  
Standby Mode, press  
start Menu Operation.  
(In the Standby Mode, the dis-  
play shows the date and time on  
the first row and the residual  
memory % on the third row as  
shown below.  
to  
Press this key to display the preceding menu screen or to move the cursor to the left.  
] Key  
Press this key to display the sub-menu screen or to move the cursor to the right.  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
[ENTER] Key or [START] Key  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
or  
When the currently highlighted item has sub-items, pressing this key operates the same as the  
[
] Key.  
When the currently highlighted item is the end item, press this key to complete the item selection.  
Completing or Canceling  
Menu Operation:  
When you have reached the  
end of a programming step or  
wish to cancel a programming  
Dial Keypad ([1] to [0] Keys)  
Used to enter desired information or to select options.  
procedure, press  
to re-  
turn to the Standby Mode.  
[STOP] Key  
Used to exit the Menu Operation and return to the Standby Mode.  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Character Entry  
When programming and regis-  
tering the Autodialer numbers or  
names, you will need to enter al-  
phanumeric characters.  
Keys Used in Character Entry  
Special Character Table  
The Character Table lists special characters that can be entered  
when programming this facsimile.  
The table lists the alpha keys in the left column and the characters  
that correspond to each key in the right column.  
To enter the special characters entry mode, press the [ALTER-  
NATE] key on the keyboard.  
[INSERT] Key  
This section helps you under-  
stand how to easily enter the  
characters.  
Inserts characters before the selected  
(highlighted) character.  
[DELETE] Key  
Deletes the selected character.  
Pressing the alpha key displays the special characters you can en-  
ter.  
[
[
] Key  
Moves the cursor to the right. If pressed  
without entering a character, it inserts a  
space.  
Select your desired character by using the  
press  
or  
keys, and  
.
] Key  
Uppercase special characters can be selected by pressing the alpha  
key while holding down the [SHIFT] key after the [ALTERNATE] key  
is pressed.  
Moves the cursor to the left.  
Provides the user interface for entering  
numeric characters.  
Provides the user inferface for entering alpha and special  
characters.  
36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Character Entry - continued  
Character Correction  
Replacing Characters  
Inserting Characters  
Using  
/
, position the cursor over the point  
Using  
/
, position the cursor over the charac-  
ter to be corrected.  
NEW YRK  
NEW YRK  
NEW YORK  
NEW YOPK  
of insertion and press  
.
The message “[INSERT]” is displayed on the second  
row.  
Enter the desired character.  
[INSERT]  
NEW YORK  
Deleting Characters  
Enter the desired character(s) (“O” in this example).  
The character(s) will be inserted without deleting  
other characters in the line. Press  
your change.  
to save  
Using  
/
, position the cursor over the charac-  
ter to be deleted.  
NEWW YORK  
Delete the character by pressing  
to save your change.  
. Press  
NEW YORK  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- INITIAL SETUP  
Initial Setting Summary  
This facsimile has many user  
initial settings.  
Enter the  
Configuration Menu  
Select the Desired Initial Setting (1-4)  
1
2
For your convenience, a quick  
reference summary of all user  
initial settings are shown on the  
right.  
Press  
or  
until the desired Initial Setting is highlighted or enter the desired Initial Setting  
Press  
. The initial Menu  
1 through 4 from the list below. The detailed initial setting procedure for each setting is shown in  
parentheses after the initial setting.  
Screen displays.  
Each of these initial setting is  
discussed in detail throughout  
the remainder of this section.  
1.COMM. OPTIONS  
2.LISTS  
3.INITIAL SETUP  
4.DEFAULT SETTINGS  
1. LANGUAGE - (Page 39) - Selects ENGLISH*, FRENCH or SPANISH for displays and printing.  
Use the following procedures to  
access one or more of these ini-  
tial settings.  
2. DATE & TIME - (Page 40) - Sets the Month, Day, Year & Time for your machine. You may select to  
use the 4-digit or 2-digit format for the year and 24-hour or the 12-hour format for the time.  
3. TERMINAL ID - FCC MANDATORY - (Page 42) - Sets the Terminal ID (Company Name &  
Press  
to enter INITIAL  
Facsimile Number) for your machine.  
SETUP. The Installation sub-  
menu displays.  
4. DIAL TYPE - (Page 44) - Configures your machine for use with Touch Tone (MF)* or Rotary Dial  
(DP) telephone service.  
1.LANGUAGE  
2.DATE & TIME  
3.TERMINAL ID  
4.DIAL TIPE  
NOTE: * indicates the factory default setting.  
NOTE: Only 4 selections can  
be displayed at one  
time.  
38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Language Selection  
You can select the language  
used on the LCD display and all  
reports printed by your facsimile.  
English, French, and Spanish  
are available.  
Display the  
LANGUAGE Menu  
Select the Desired  
Language  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
1
2
3
Highlight  
1.LANGUAGE  
Select the desired language.  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other settings referring  
to their associated pages for in-  
structions, or press  
To display the SETUP menu,  
press:  
+
using  
or  
and  
(for ENGLISH)  
press:  
+
+
(for SPANISH)  
or  
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
+
1.LANGUAGE  
2.DATE & TIME  
3.TERMINAL ID  
4.DIAL TIPE  
(for FRENCH)  
LANGUAGE  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
01.ENGLISH  
02.ESPAÑOL  
03.FRANÇAIS  
NOTE: Only 4 selections can  
be displayed at one  
time.  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Date and Time Setting  
This facsimile displays the cur-  
Display the DATE &  
TIME Menu  
Select the Time  
Format  
Enter the Date Data  
Enter the Time Data  
rent date and time when in the  
Standby Mode. It also uses this  
time for maintaining internal list  
and reports. Follow the proce-  
dure to set the time and date.  
2
3
1
4
Highlight  
2.DATE & TIME  
Select the time format.  
Move the cursor to the desired  
position using the following  
keys.  
Move the cursor to the desired  
position using the following  
keys.  
To display the SETUP menu,  
press:  
or  
or  
using  
or  
and  
(for 24-hour format)  
press:  
Enter the date.  
Enter the time.  
+
(for 12-hour format) default  
or  
The date and time currently set  
are displayed on the bottom  
row.  
1.LANGUAGE  
SET TIME FORMAT  
1.24 HOURS  
2.12 HOURS  
2.DATE & TIME  
3.TERMINAL ID  
4.DIAL TIPE  
When “24-hour” is selected:  
Change the day-of-week desig-  
nation by pressing the following  
keys.  
When “12-hour” is selected,  
change the AM/PM designation  
by pressing the following keys,  
SET DATE & TIME  
NOTE: Only 4 selections can  
be displayed at one  
time.  
MD-DD-YYYY WWW  
XX-XX-XXXX XXX  
or  
or  
When the correct date is en- When the correct time is en-  
tered, press:  
tered, press:  
(Allows 00 to 23 as the hour  
value.)  
When “12-hour” is selected:  
SET DATE & TIME  
SET DATE & TIME  
HH:MM  
SET DATE MODE  
2.DD-MM-YYYY  
3.YYYY-MM-DD  
4.MM-DD-YY  
MD-DD-YYYY WWW  
XX-XX-XXXX XXX  
5.DD-MM-YY  
6.YY-MM-DD  
(Allows 01 to 12 as the hour  
value and designates AM or  
PM.)  
40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Date and Time Setting - continued  
Select the Date  
Format  
Select the Month  
Format  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
5
6
7
Select the date format for dis-  
play and print.  
Select the month format.  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other settings referring  
to their associated pages for in-  
structions, or press  
(for NUMERIC, such as 01, 02,  
03 ...)  
(for Month/Day/Year 4-digit)  
(for Day/Month/Year 4-digit)  
(for Year 4-digit/Month/Day)  
(for Month/Day/Year 2-digit)  
(for Day/Month/Year 2-digit)  
(for Year 2-digit/Month/Day)  
(for NAME, such as JAN, FEB,  
MAR ...)  
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
SET MONTH MODE  
1.NUMERIC  
2.NAME  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Terminal ID Setting  
In compliance with FCC regula-  
tions (see page 1), this facsimile  
places your company’s name,  
facsimile telephone number and  
date & time on the top of all  
transmitted documents. This  
feature enables remote parties  
to easily identify your docu-  
ments and the time of transmis-  
sion.  
Display the  
TERMINAL ID Menu  
Enter the User ID  
Select the  
International Code  
Enter Your  
Telephone Number  
1
2
3
4
Highlight  
3.TERMINAL ID  
Enter your user ID (company If you send documents over-  
name) using the Keyboard and seas, adding your International  
Numeric Keypad. You can use Code (country code) to your  
up to 40 characters.  
For more information on select- remote party to identify the  
ing characters, see page 34, country from which the docu-  
If you selected ADD+ in Step 3,  
enter the International Code for  
your country before entering  
your area code and telephone  
number.  
stored ID name will enable the  
using  
or  
and  
Example: United States = 1  
press:  
Character Entry.  
ment has been sent. The 1st  
digit(s) following the “+” sign is  
for the International Code.  
Then, enter the telephone num-  
ber that has been connected to  
the facsimile.  
To display the SETUP menu,  
press:  
When your ID name is displayed  
correctly on the LCD display,  
press:  
or  
If you send or receive docu-  
ments to and from overseas, se-  
lect ADD + by pressing:  
+
Your facsimile will prompt you  
for your telephone number’s in-  
ternational code.  
1.LANGUAGE  
SET TERMINAL ID  
ID NAME =(MAX40)  
2.DATE & TIME  
3.TERMINAL ID  
4.DIAL TIPE  
If all of your documents are sent  
INT. CODE ?  
1.ADD +  
domestically,  
select  
NOT  
NEEDED by pressing:  
2.NOT NEEDED  
NOTE: Only 4 selections can  
be displayed at one  
time.  
Check the LCD display to make  
sure your telephone number ap-  
pears correctly, then press:  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
If the terminal ID is already set,  
the current name is displayed on  
the last row.  
SET TERMINAL ID  
TEL NUMBER =(MAX20)  
+
If the Line-2 board is installed  
repeat Steps 3 and 4 for Line 2,  
then go to Step 5.  
ENTER NAME  
The “+” is displayed when ADD+  
is selected.  
ID NAME =(MAX40)  
INT. CODE ? LINE-2  
1.ADD +  
2.NOT NEEDED  
The new name will be displayed  
on the last row as it is entered.  
42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Terminal ID Setting - continued  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
5
Then press:  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other settings referring  
to their associated pages for in-  
structions, or press  
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dial Type Setting  
There are two types of dialing  
modes: DP [Dial Pulse (Rotary)]  
and MF [Multifrequency (touch  
tone)]. If your telephone emits  
tones when you are dialing, this  
usually indicates that you have  
a MF type line and no adjust-  
ment is required. Otherwise, you  
will have to select the appropri-  
ate setting.  
Display the DIAL  
TYPE Menu  
Select Your Dial  
Type  
Enter the Access  
Digits  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
1
2
3
4
Highlight  
4.DIAL TYPE  
Select your dial line type.  
Access Digits are PBX digits  
such as 9, pause, and 1 which  
need to be omitted when using  
chain dialing.  
If you do not require the use of a  
credit card when chain dialing,  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other settings referring  
to their associated pages for in-  
structions, or press  
using  
or  
and  
(for Multi-Frequency type)  
default  
press:  
press  
to skip this step.  
To display the SETUP menu,  
press:  
Otherwise, enter the number  
(max. 10 digits) from the Dial  
Keypad.  
or  
(for Dial Pulse type)  
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
+
If the Line-2 board has been in-  
stalled, repeat Step 2 for the  
2nd line.  
1.LANGUAGE  
DIAL TYPE  
1.MF  
2.DP  
DIAL TYPE  
1.MF  
2.DP  
LINE-2  
2.DATE & TIME  
3.TERMINAL ID  
4.DIAL TYPE  
NOTE: Only 4 selections can  
be displayed at one  
time.  
When the correct Access Digit is  
displayed, press:  
After selecting the dial type, the  
following will be displayed.  
DELETE ACCESS DIGIT  
ACCESS DIGIT=(MAX10)  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
Access digits are numbers  
which are required by PBX sys-  
tems to access the phone sys-  
tem “outside” the PBX. A com-  
mon access digit is “9.”  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- DEVICE CONFIGURATION  
Configuration Summary  
This facsimile has many user  
adjustable settings.  
Enter the Configuration Menu  
Select the Desired Configuration Setting (01-16)  
1
2
Each of these configuration set-  
tings is discussed in detail  
throughout the remainder of this  
section.  
Press  
or  
until the desired Configuration Setting is  
Press  
. The initial Menu  
Press  
to enter MACHINE  
highlighted or enter the desired Configuration Setting 01 through 16  
from the list below. The detailed configuration procedure for each  
setting is shown in parentheses after the configuration setting.  
Screen displays.  
SETTINGS. The Machine Set-  
tings sub-menu will now dis-  
plays.  
Use the following procedures to  
access one or more of these  
configuration settings.  
1.COMM. OPTIONS  
2.LISTS  
3.INITIAL SETUP  
4.DEFAULT SETTINGS ↓  
01. SPEAKER VOLUME - (Page 47) - Sets the Bell Ring, Alarm  
Tone, Key Touch Tone and Monitor volume (0-7) (4*) for the  
machine.  
01.SPEAKER VOLUME  
02.POWER SAVER  
03.SEPARATOR PAGE  
04.DEPARTMENT CODE ↓  
02. POWER SAVER - (Page 51) - Configures the machine’s Super  
Power Saver function for Automatic/Manual* or Off operation.  
05.ACCOUNT CODE  
06.PRINT DENSITY  
07.DOCUMENT LENGTH  
08.LINE MONITOR  
09.RECEIVE INTERVAL  
10.ECM  
03. SEPARATOR PAGE - (Page 53) - Enables or Disables* a  
FAX Separator Page, Copy Separator Page, and PC Separator  
Page.  
Press  
to enter DEFAULT  
SETTING. The Default Setting  
sub-menu displays.  
04. DEPARTMENT CODE - (Page 55) - Enables, Disables* and  
11.DOCUMENT MODE  
12.COLLATE COPY  
13.LETTER HEAD PAPER  
14.REDIAL MODE  
15.AUTO RECEIVE MODE  
16.LINE-2 MODE  
Configures up to 99 Department Codes.  
1.MACHINE SETTINGS  
2.TX SETTINGS  
3.RX SETTINGS  
05. ACCOUNT CODE - (Page 58) - Enables or Disables* a 4-digit  
Account Code entry.  
4.REPORTS & LIST  
06. PRINT DENSITY - (Page 59) - Sets the Print Density (-2-+2)  
(0*) for the machine.  
07. DOCUMENT LENGTH - (Page 60) - Enables* or Disables the  
NOTE: Only 4 selections can  
be displayed at one  
time.  
sending of documents longer than 1 Meter (39.4").  
08. LINE MONITOR - (Page 61) - Enables or Disables* the Line  
Monitor function.  
09. RECEIVE INTERVAL - (Page 62) - Sets the interval (0-15  
min.) the machine will wait after making four consecutive  
dialings.  
NOTE: * indicates the factory default setting.  
10. ECM - (Page 63) - Enables or Disables* the ECM function.  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Configuration Summary - continued  
Select the Desired Configuration Setting (01-16)  
- continued  
2
11. DOCUMENT MODE - (Page 64) - Selects the default setting  
for the Resolution (Standard, Fine, U-Fine) and Contrast (Nor-  
mal, Darker, Lighter) for document scanning.  
12. COLLATE COPY - (Page 65) - Enables or Disables* the Col-  
late Copy function.  
13. LETTER HEAD PAPER - (Page 66) - Enables or Disables*  
the Letter Head Paper function at during PC printing.  
14. REDIAL MODE - (Page 67) - Sets the number of redials (01-  
14) (05*) and redial interval (01min.-15min.) (03*min.).  
15. AUTO RECEIVE MODE - (Page 68) - Configures Auto* and  
Manual receive modes. As well as the Ring Delay (01*-15)  
within auto receive mode.  
16. LINE-2 MODE - (Page 69) - Configures the 2nd Facsimile Line  
for TX & RX*, RX ONLY, or RX ONLY TIME PERIOD.  
NOTE: * indicates the factory default setting.  
46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Bell Ringer Volume Adjustment  
The telephone bell ringer vol-  
ume can be adjusted using the  
following procedure.  
Display the RINGER  
VOLUME Menu  
Enter the Desired  
Volume Value  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
1
2
3
Press:  
Enter the desired volume value  
(0 to 7; 0 for minimum, 7 for  
maximum).  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other volume settings  
referring to their associated  
pages for instructions, or press  
+
+
+
+
+
+
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
or  
Move the cursor to the desired  
position, using the following  
keys.  
or  
When the desired value is dis-  
played on the LCD display,  
press:  
The current setting is highlight-  
ed on the bottom row.  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
SET RINGER VOLUME  
VOLUME =(0-7)  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Alarm Tone Volume Adjustment  
The alarm tone volume can be  
adjusted using the following pro-  
cedure.  
Display the ALARM  
VOLUME Menu  
Enter the Desired  
Volume Value  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
1
2
3
Press:  
Enter the desired volume value  
(0 to 7; 0 for minimum, 7 for  
maximum).  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other volume settings  
referring to their associated  
pages for instructions, or press  
+
+
+
+
+
+
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
or  
Move the cursor to the desired  
position, using the following  
keys.  
or  
When the desired value is dis-  
played on the LCD display,  
press:  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
The current setting is highlight-  
ed on the bottom row.  
SET ALARM VOLUME  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
VOLUME =(0-7)  
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Key Touch Tone Volume Adjustment  
The key touch tone volume can  
Display the KEY  
Enter the Desired  
Volume Value  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
be adjusted using the following  
1
2
3
TOUCH VOLUME  
procedure.  
Menu  
Press:  
Enter the desired volume value  
(0 to 7; 0 for minimum, 7 for  
maximum).  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other volume settings  
referring to their associated  
pages for instructions, or press  
+
+
+
+
+
+
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
or  
Move the cursor to the desired  
position, using the following  
keys.  
or  
When the desired value is dis-  
played on the LCD display,  
press:  
The current setting is highlight-  
ed on the bottom row.  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
SET KEY TOUCH VOLUME  
VOLUME =(0-7)  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Monitor Volume Adjustment  
The line monitor volume can be  
adjusted using the following pro-  
cedure.  
Display the MONITOR  
VOLUME Menu  
Enter the Desired  
Volume Value  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
1
2
3
Press:  
Enter the desired volume value  
(0 to 7; 0 for minimum, 7 for  
maximum).  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other volume settings  
referring to their associated  
pages for instructions, or press  
+
+
+
+
+
+
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
or  
Move the cursor to the desired  
position, using the following  
keys.  
or  
When the desired value is dis-  
played on the LCD display,  
press:  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
The current setting is highlight-  
ed on the bottom row.  
SET MONITOR VOLUME  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
VOLUME =(0-7)  
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power Saver Operation  
This function allows you to mini-  
Display the POWER  
SAVER Menu  
Select the Power  
Saver Mode  
Select the Super  
Power Saver Option  
Enter the Start Time  
Period  
mize power consumption by  
turning power off to portions of  
the machine (as selected). If  
the Power Saver function is ON,  
a warm up period is needed be-  
fore printing occurs. This fac-  
simile has two Power Saver  
modes, Super Power Saver and  
Printer Power Saver.  
Super Power Saver turns virtual-  
ly all power off to minimize pow-  
er consumption. Select one of  
three modes, Automatic, Manual  
or OFF.  
2
1
3
4
Press:  
Select the desired Super Power  
Saver Option.  
Enter the time period (in min-  
utes) for standby operation prior  
to entering the Super Power  
Saver mode.  
Select the desired Power Saver  
Mode.  
+
+
+
+
+
(to select Automatic mode)  
Go to Step 4.  
(to select Super Power  
Saver mode)  
Go to Step 3.  
START TIME  
SUPER POWER SAVER  
1.AUTOMATIC  
2.MANUAL  
TIME  
(01-60)MIN  
03  
Printer Power Saver turns only  
the fuser section off during the  
time period selected.  
3.OFF  
START TIME  
NOTE:  
When the machine is in the  
Super Power Saver mode, it  
will exit from the Super  
Power Saver mode when  
any of the following occurs.  
(to select Manual mode)  
+
TIME  
(01-60)MIN  
03  
In manual mode, you can acti-  
vate Super Power Saver using a  
key on the Control Panel.  
(to select Printer Power  
Saver mode)  
When the correct time period is  
displayed, press:  
Go to Step 5.  
-
The machine receives a  
facsimile,  
01.SUPER P.S.  
02.PRINTER P.S.  
PRINTER POWER SAVER  
(to select OFF)  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
-
Option handset or exter-  
nal telephone handset is  
lifted,  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
-
Document is loaded into  
the document tray,  
-
-
is pressed, or  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
PC has accessed the ma-  
chine.  
The display returns to Step 1.  
Go to Step 7.  
The display returns to Step 1.  
Go to Step 7.  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power Saver Operation - continued  
Select the Printer Power Saver Function  
Enter the Start Time  
and End Time  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
5
6
7
Enable or Disable the Printer  
Power Saver function.  
Move the cursor to the desired  
position, using the following  
keys.  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, press  
PRINTER POWER SAVER  
TIME PERIOD =  
12:00AM-12:00AM  
or  
(to set Printer Power Saver ON)  
(Example if the 12-hour format  
option is selected in DATE &  
TIME setting)  
Enter the time period.  
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
When “OFF” is selected, the  
(to set Printer Power Saver OFF)  
“OPERATION  
COMPLETED”  
message is displayed as shown  
at the bottom in Step 6. Returns  
to Step 1.  
If “ON” is selected, the currently  
set time period is displayed be-  
low. The time on the left is the  
Printer Power Saver start time  
(or time that the printer unit will  
power down). The time on the  
right is the Printer Power Saver  
end time.  
Change the AM/PM designation  
if selected by pressing the fol-  
lowing keys.  
PRINTER POWER SAVER  
or  
TIME PERIOD =  
00:00 - 00:00  
When the correct time period is  
displayed, press:  
(Example if the 24-hour format  
option is selected in DATE &  
TIME setting)  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
The display returns to Step 1.  
52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Separator Page  
A Separator Page is a sheet automatically inserted between each  
received fax, copy, and/or PC print. This feature makes it easier to  
distinguish between individual receptions, copies and PC prints.  
Select the Facsimile  
Separator Page  
Option  
Select the Copy  
Separator Page  
Option  
Display the  
SEPARATOR PAGE  
Menu  
1
2
3
NOTE: If you have already selected a Paper Tray for the Letter  
Press:  
To turn ON Copy Separator  
Page, press:  
To turn ON Facsimile Separator  
Page, press:  
Head Paper setting, this function is not available.  
+
+
+
+
To turn OFF Copy Separator  
Page, press:  
To turn OFF Facsimile Separa-  
tor Page, press:  
B
B
A
A
A
Separator Page  
FAX SEPARATOR PAGE  
COPY SEPARATOR PAGE  
PC SEPARATOR PAGE  
1.ON  
1.ON  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
2.OFF  
2.OFF  
Separator Page  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Separator Page - continued  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
Select the PC Print Separator Page Option  
Select the Tray  
Option  
6
4
5
To turn ON PC Print Separator  
Page, press:  
To print the Separator Page  
from the Lower Recording Paper  
Tray, press:  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other settings referring  
to their associated pages for in-  
structions, or press  
If any of FAX Separator Page,  
Copy Separator Page, or PC  
Separator Page is set to ON  
and an Optional Recording Pa-  
per Tray is installed, following  
screen is displayed.  
To turn OFF PC Print Separator  
Page, press:  
To print the Separator Page  
from a Paper Tray selected au-  
tomatically, press:  
TRAY SELECTION  
1.LOWER TRAY  
2.AUTO SELECT  
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
If no Optional Recording Paper  
Tray is installed, following  
screen is displayed.  
NOTE:  
NOTE:  
When the two Optional Re-  
cording Paper Trays are in-  
stalled, the same screen is  
displayed.  
In case “AUTO” is selected,  
separator page is printed on  
Letter size paper. If Letter  
size is empty, Legal size pa-  
per is selected.  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
Go to Step 5.  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
Go to Step 6.  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Department Code Setting  
Department Code operation is  
Display the  
DEPARTMENT CODE  
Menu  
Enable/Disable the Department Code Function  
Enter the Master  
Department Name  
used to monitor the facsimile’s  
activity when shared between  
multiple users or workgroups.  
1
2
3
Press:  
Enable or Disable the Depart- If the Department Code function  
Department Code NBR. 01 is  
fixed as the Master Department  
Code. Enter the Master Depart-  
ment Name. See page 36 if you  
need help selecting characters.  
This feature is especially useful  
when billing departments based  
on machine usage.  
ment Code function.  
has ever been set before, the  
following screen is displayed.  
To recover the Department  
+
+
+
+
When Department Code opera-  
tion is enabled, access to the  
facsimile is restricted to 99 valid  
department code passwords.  
DEPT CODE ENTRY  
1.RECOVER OLD DATA  
2.NEW  
(for YES-Enable)  
When the name is correctly dis-  
played on the LCD display,  
press:  
Each department code will be  
assigned a 5-digit department  
code password. These pass-  
words must be entered each  
time a user wishes to send a  
facsimile, make copy, print a de-  
partment journal, etc.  
(for NO-Disable)  
Code data previously set, press:  
The entered name is displayed  
on the bottom row.  
If “YES” is selected, the follow-  
ing Master Code Entry screen is  
displayed.  
To set new Department codes,  
press:  
There are two types of Depart-  
ment Codes, Master and Indi-  
vidual. The Master Code is used  
as a supervisor level code to  
add, delete and modify Indi-  
vidual Codes.  
MASTER CODE ENTRY  
DEPT NBR=  
DEPT NAME=(MAX20)  
MASTER CODE ENTRY  
DEPT NBR=  
01  
01  
ABC Master  
nDept.  
After 2 seconds:  
After 2 seconds:  
The Master Code is also used to  
print the Department Code List  
and Master Journals that con-  
tain all machine activity.  
ENTER NAME  
MASTER CODE ENTRY  
DEPT NBR=  
MASTER CODE=  
DEPT CODE ENTRY  
1.YES  
2.NO  
01  
DEPT NAME=(MAX20)  
The Individual Codes are used  
to gain an access to basic ma-  
chine functions and operations.  
The Department Code can be  
used to print Journals which  
only show the activity under that  
code.  
The screen to enter the Master  
Department Name is displayed.  
The data on the top row indi-  
cates that it is in the Character  
Entry mode. Continue to the fi-  
nal step.  
If “NO” is selected, “OPERA-  
TION COMPLETED” will be dis-  
played.  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Department Code Setting - continued  
Enter the Master  
Department Code  
Password  
Enter the Individual  
Department Code  
Address  
Enter the Individual  
Department Code  
Name  
Enter the Department  
Code Password  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
4
5
6
7
8
Department Codes NBR. 02  
through 99 are used as Indi-  
vidual Department Codes. Enter  
the Individual Department Code  
name using the Keyboard. See  
page 36 if you need help select-  
ing characters.  
When the name is correctly  
displayed on the LCD display,  
press:  
Enter a 5-digit Master Depart-  
ment Code Password using the  
Dial Keypad. This password will  
be required to gain supervisor  
access to the machine.  
After entering the Master De-  
partment Code password, the  
facsimile will prompt for an Indi-  
vidual Department Code ad-  
dress.  
Enter  
a
5-digit Department  
If you want to continue entering  
the Department Codes, repeat  
Steps 5 through 7.  
Code Password using the Dial  
Keypad. This password will be  
required to gain user/depart-  
ment access to the machine.  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other settings referring  
to their associated pages for in-  
structions, or press  
Select an Individual Department  
Code address from 02 to 99.  
Important: Record this pass-  
word in a safe location so that it  
can be retrieved if it is lost or  
forgotten.  
Important: Record this pass-  
word in a safe location so that it  
can be retrieved if it is lost or  
forgotten.  
The entered name is displayed  
on the bottom row.  
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
After selecting the Individual De-  
partment Code address, press:  
When the password is correctly  
entered, press:  
When the password is correctly  
entered, press:  
MASTER CODE ENTRY  
DEPT CODE ENTRY  
DEPT CODE ENTRY  
DEPT CODE ENTRY  
DEPT NBR=  
01  
DEPT NBR=  
02  
DEPT NBR=  
02  
DEPT NBR=  
02  
DEPT NAME=(MAX20)  
REGISTERED  
Sales Dept.  
REGISTERED  
After 2 seconds:  
After 2 seconds:  
After 2 seconds:  
After 2 seconds:  
DEPT CODE ENTRY  
ENTER NAME  
DEPT CODE ENTRY  
DEPT NBR=  
DEPT CODE ENTRY  
02  
DEPT NUMBER=(1-99)  
DEPT NAME=(MAX20)  
DEPT CODE=  
DEPT NUMBER=(1-99)  
The Department Code Name  
entry menu is displayed.  
56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Department Code Maintenance  
The Department Code Mainte-  
nance is used to cancel or  
change the Master or Individual  
Department Code.  
Display the  
Enable/Disable the  
Department Code  
Select the Desired  
Option  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
1
2
3
4
DEPARTMENT  
CODE Menu  
Press:  
Enable or Disable the Depart-  
ment Code function.  
Select the desired option.  
Press:  
If you wish to continue, repeat  
Steps 2 and 3.  
This procedure can only be per-  
formed by a supervisor who  
possesses the Master Depart-  
ment Code Password. Enter this  
password before proceeding.  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other settings referring  
to their associated pages for in-  
structions, or press  
+
+
+
+
(for YES-Enable)  
To cancel or delete the previ-  
ously displayed Department  
Code and return to the Depart-  
ment Code Address Entry menu  
in Step 5 of Department Code  
Setting. (See page 56.)  
(for NO-Disable)  
If “YES” is selected, the follow-  
ing Department Code Menu is  
displayed.  
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
DEPT CODE ENTRY  
To change the previously dis-  
played Department Code and  
return to Step 6 of Department  
Code Setting. (See page 56.)  
DEPT NUMBER=(1-99)  
DEPT CODE ENTRY  
1.YES  
2.NO  
Enter the code number of the  
desired department and press:  
To retain the previously dis-  
played Department Code with-  
out modification and return to  
the Department Code Address  
Entry menu in Step 5 of Depart-  
ment Code Setting. (See page  
56.)  
DEPT CODE ENTRY  
ALREADY ASSIGNED  
DEPT NBR=  
01  
Supervisor  
After 2 seconds:  
DEPT CODE ENTRY  
1.CANCEL  
2.MODIFY  
3.RETAIN  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Account Codes  
This feature provides valuable  
Account Code tracking informa-  
tion for each facsimile transmis-  
sion sent from the unit.  
Display the  
ACCOUNT CODE  
Menu  
Select the Function  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
1
2
3
Press:  
Enable or Disable Account  
Codes.  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other settings referring  
to their associated pages for in-  
structions, or press  
When a facsimile is transmitted,  
the account code number will  
be recorded on the Transmis-  
sion Journal.  
+
+
+
+
Select ON to enable Account  
Code prompting and printing on  
the Transmission Journal.  
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
Or, select OFF to disable Ac-  
count Codes from being prompt-  
ed and printed on the Transmis-  
sion Journal.  
ACCOUNT CODE  
1.ON  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
2.OFF  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Print Density Setting  
The print density for reception,  
copy, PC printing, and report  
printing can be set. Five density  
levels are available from -2  
(lighter print) to +2 (darker print).  
Display the  
Enter the Desired  
Print Density Value  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
1
2
3
SET PRINT DENSITY  
Menu  
Move the cursor to the desired  
position, using the following  
keys (-2 to +2; -2 for lighter  
print, +2 for darker print).  
Press:  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other settings referring  
to their associated pages for in-  
structions, or press  
+
+
+
+
or  
When the desired value is dis-  
played on the LCD display,  
press:  
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
SET PRINT DENSITY  
DENSITY(-2 TO +2)=  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
LIGHTER  
DARKER  
-2 -1 0 +1 +2  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Document Length Setting  
This setting enables or disables  
Display the  
Select the Document  
Length Option  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
the DP120F/DP125F sending  
documents longer than 1 Meter  
(39.4”). The default setting en-  
ables a 1 Meter (39.4”) limit.  
1
2
3
DOCUMENT LENGTH  
Menu  
Press:  
Select the Document Length op-  
tion.  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other settings referring  
to their associated pages for in-  
structions, or press  
To select 1m, press:  
+
+
To select UNLIMITED, press:  
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
+
+
OPERATION COMPLETED  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
DOCUMENT LENGTH  
1.1m  
2.UNLIMITED  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Line Monitor  
This function is used to set the  
speaker ON in order to monitor  
the dialing and connection por-  
tion of every transmission.  
This function is mainly used to  
confirm dialing and phone line  
status.  
Display the LINE  
MONITOR Menu  
Select the Line  
Monitor Option  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
1
2
3
Press:  
To turn ON the monitor speaker, After completing this Configura-  
press:  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other settings referring  
to their associated pages for in-  
structions, or press  
+
+
+
+
When two phone lines are si-  
multaneously used for sending,  
the job initiated last will be  
monitored.  
To turn OFF the monitor  
speaker, press:  
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
LINE MONITOR  
1.ALWAYS  
2.OFF  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Receive Interval Setting  
This function insures there will  
be a period of time set aside to  
Display the RECEIVE  
INTERVAL Menu  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
Enter the Receive  
Interval  
1
3
2
receive incoming facsimiles dur-  
ing periods of heavy outgoing  
transmission activity. After ev-  
ery fourth consecutive transmis-  
sion, this machine will wait 0 to  
15 minutes to allow incoming  
facsimiles to be received (de-  
fault is 3 minutes).  
Press:  
Enter the interval value (0 to 15)  
in minutes.  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other settings referring  
to their associated pages for in-  
structions, or press  
+
+
+
+
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
Then press:  
RECEIVE INTERVAL  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
INTERVAL=(0-15MIN)  
3
Displayed for 2 seconds  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ECM Default Setting  
ECM (Error Correction Mode) is  
an internationally-recognized er-  
ror correction system. It enables  
error free communications by  
automatically re-sending any  
portion of the document affected  
by phone line noise or distor-  
tion.  
Display the SET  
ECM Menu  
Select the ECM  
Option  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
1
2
3
Press:  
Select the desired ECM option.  
The LCD screen shown below is  
displayed for 2 seconds.  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other settings referring  
to their associated pages for in-  
structions, or press  
+
+
To turn ECM to ON, press:  
To turn ECM to OFF, press:  
NOTES:  
Default ECM setting is  
ON.  
Both the sender and the  
receiver must have the  
ECM feature to perform  
ECM communications.  
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
+
+
This setting cannot be  
changed if a document is  
stored in memory. Re-  
sidual memory must be  
100%.  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
ECM is required for Su-  
per G3 (33,600 bps) op-  
erations. If ECM is dis-  
abled, Super G3 opera-  
tions are, also, disabled.  
SET ECM  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Default Setting for Document Mode (Resolution and Contrast)  
This setting will select the de-  
Display the  
Select the  
Resolution  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
Select the Contrast  
fault setting whenever a docu-  
ment is set in the facsimile for  
transmission. Manual settings (if  
selected for a particular docu-  
ment) will take precedence over  
default settings.  
1
2
4
3
DOCUMENT MODE  
Menu  
Select the desired resolution  
setting by pressing one of the  
following keys.  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other settings referring  
to their associated pages for in-  
structions, or press  
Press:  
Select the default contrast level  
by pressing one of the following  
keys.  
Select STANDARD mode for  
sending normal text and graph-  
ics by pressing:  
Select NORMAL for normal  
documents by pressing:  
+
+
+
+
Select DARKER to darken light  
originals (i.e., for documents  
with light or faint print) by press-  
ing:  
Select FINE mode for sending  
normal text and graphics with  
extra clarity by pressing:  
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
Select U-FINE (Ultra-Fine) for  
sending fine text and graphics  
with extra clarity by pressing:  
Select LIGHTER to lighten dark  
originals (i.e., for documents  
with dark print) by pressing:  
SET CONTRAST  
1.NORMAL  
2.DARKER  
SET RESOLUTION  
1.STANDARD  
2.FINE  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
3.LIGHTER  
3.U-FINE  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Collate Copy Setting  
When copying documents, the COLLATE function may be selected.  
This function will sort multiple page copies into sets of correct-order  
pages.  
Display the  
COLLATE COPY  
Menu  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
Select the Desired  
Option  
3
1
2
This setting establishes the default for the Collate Copy function.  
Collate Copy may, also, be set manually at the time the copy opera-  
tion is performed.  
Select the desired option.  
Press:  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other settings referring  
to their associated pages for in-  
structions, or press  
To set COLLATE COPY to ON,  
press:  
Output Examples of Printed Copies  
+
+
With COLLATE Function ON  
With COLLATE Function  
OFF  
To set COLLATE COPY to OFF,  
press:  
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
Page 1  
Page 1  
Page 3  
Page 2  
+
+
Page 1  
Page 1  
Page 3  
Page 2  
Page 1  
Page 2  
Page 2  
Page 2  
Page 3  
Page 3  
Page 3  
Page 3  
Page 2  
Page 1  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
NOTES:  
NOTES:  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
The pages are automati-  
cally collated.  
Collating is the responsi-  
COLLATE COPY DEFAULT  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
bility of the operator.  
Requires enough memo-  
ry for the entire multi-  
page document. If there  
is not enough memory  
(memory overflow), the  
copying procedure will be  
canceled.  
Memory requirements are  
limited to one page at a  
time.  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
Collation is slower than  
non-collation  
because  
the entire document must  
be scanned into memory  
first, then printing can oc-  
cur.  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Letter Head Paper Reservation Setting  
This function allows you to re-  
serve a particular Paper Tray for  
Display the LETTER  
HEAD PAPER Menu  
Select the Tray Option  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
1
2
3
use with PC printing or copying  
functions. Once selected, the  
paper in this tray cannot be  
used for facsimile receptions  
(even if the other paper tray(s)  
becomes empty).  
Press:  
When one Optional Recording  
Paper Tray is installed:  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other settings referring  
to their associated pages for in-  
structions, or press  
When two Optional Recording  
Paper Trays are installed:  
To select the Bypass Tray,  
press:  
To select the Bypass Tray,  
press:  
+
+
+
+
NOTE:  
This function is only avail-  
able when the Optional Re-  
cording Paper Tray(s) is at-  
tached to the machine.  
If you have already selected  
a Paper Tray for the Separa-  
tor Page function, this set-  
ting is not available.  
When the specified Paper  
Tray becomes empty, the  
paper will be supplied from  
another Paper Tray.  
To select the Upper Recording  
Paper Tray, press:  
To select the Upper Recording  
Paper Tray, press:  
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
To select the Lower Recording To select the Middle Recording  
Paper Tray, press:  
Paper Tray, press:  
LETTER HEAD PAPER  
1.OFF  
2.BYPASS  
3.UPPER TRAY  
To select the Lower Recording  
Paper Tray, press:  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
4.MIDDLE TRAY  
5.LOWER TRAY  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
If no Option Recording Paper  
Tray is installed, the following  
screen is displayed.  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
SORRY NOT POSSIBLE  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Redial (Interval and Counter)  
If the destination facsimile you  
Display the REDIAL  
MODE Menu  
Select the REDIAL  
Option  
Enter the Redial  
Interval  
Enter the Redial  
Counter  
called is busy, your facsimile will  
automatically redial the number  
up to the number of attempts set  
by this procedure. In addition,  
your DP120F/DP125F will try to  
redial every 1 minute by default.  
If desired, you may change  
these redial settings.  
1
2
3
4
Press:  
Select the desired REDIAL op- Enter the interval value (01 to  
Enter the redial counter value  
(00 to 14).  
tion.  
15) in minutes.  
To select the Redial Interval,  
press:  
+
+
+
Redial Counter  
The Redial Counter sets the  
number of redial attempts. The  
default setting is 5. You may  
change the number of redials  
from 0 to 14 attempts.  
REDIAL MODE  
INTERVAL= (01-15MIN)  
01  
+
+
Then press:  
Then press:  
Redial Interval  
Go to Step 3.  
The Redial Interval sets the  
length of time between redial at-  
tempts. The default redial inter-  
To select REDIAL COUNTER,  
press:  
The following screen is dis-  
played.  
The following screen is dis-  
played.  
val is  
1
minute. You may  
change the interval from 1 to 15  
minutes.  
+
OPERATION COMPLETED  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
REDIAL MODE  
01.INTERVAL  
02.COUNTER  
REDIAL MODE  
After 2 seconds, the display re-  
turns to Step 1. To complete the  
After 2 seconds, the display re-  
turns to Step 1. To complete the  
COUNTER  
=(00-14)  
05  
Go to Step 4.  
procedure, press  
.
procedure, press  
.
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Auto Receive Mode  
This setting allows you select  
Auto or Manual reception.  
When Auto is selected, your  
facsimile will automatically re-  
ceive the documents after a pre-  
set ring delay. When Manual is  
selected, you need to answer  
the call to receive the docu-  
ments.  
Display the AUTO  
RECEIVE Menu  
Select the Desired  
Receive Mode  
Enter the Ring Delay  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
1
2
3
4
Press:  
Enter the desired number of  
rings (01 to 10) before the fac-  
simile will answer the incoming  
call.  
After completing this Configura-  
tion Setting, you may continue  
to select other settings referring  
to their associated pages for in-  
structions, or press  
Select the desired Receive  
Mode.  
+
+
+
+
(for AUTO RECEIVE)  
(for MANUAL RECEIVE)  
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
If AUTO RECEIVE is selected,  
the following will be displayed.  
When the desired ring count is  
displayed on the LCD, press:  
AUTO RECEIVE  
RING DELAY =(01-10)  
01  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
If MANUAL RECEIVE is se-  
lected, the following will be dis-  
played for 2 seconds (continue  
to Step 4).  
AUTO RECEIVE MODE  
1.AUTO RECEIVE  
2.MANUAL RECEIVE  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Line-2 Operation  
If your facsimile is equipped  
with the Line-2 Board, you can  
configure its operation as fol-  
lows.  
Display the LINE-2  
MODE Menu  
Configure Line-2  
Operation  
Enter the Start Time  
and End Time  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
1
2
3
4
Press:  
Select “1.TX/RX” if the second  
line is used for both transmis-  
sion and reception by pressing:  
Enter the start time and end After completing this Configura-  
time of the time period in which tion Setting, you may continue  
the Line-2 will be used for re- to select other settings referring  
ception only.  
to their associated pages for in-  
structions, or press  
+
+
+
+
(Default)  
Select “2.RECEPTION ONLY” if  
the second line option is used  
for reception only by pressing:  
to exit the Configuration Setting  
mode and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
Select “3.TIMER” if the second  
line option is used for reception  
only during a specific time range  
set in Step 3.  
NOTES:  
For 24-hour format:  
00:00 to 23:59  
For 12-hour format:  
12:00 to 11:59, and the  
AM or PM designation  
LINE-2 MODE  
1.TX & RX  
2.RECEPTION ONLY  
3.TIMER  
When the correct time period is  
entered, press:  
When either 1 or 2 is selected,  
the “OPERATION COMPLET-  
ED” message is displayed. Con-  
tinue to the final step.  
When 3 is selected, the follow-  
ing screen is displayed to set  
the time period for reception. If  
any data is already set, it is dis-  
played on the bottom row.  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
RECEPTION ONLY  
Returns to display the SETUP  
menu screen.  
TIME PERIOD =  
00:00 -00:00  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BASIC FUNCTIONS - AUTOMATIC TELEPHONE DIALING  
Abbreviated Dialer Registration  
Once registered, 73 One Touch  
Display the TEL  
LIST ENTRY Menu  
Display the ABB.  
NUMBERS Menu  
Enter an ABB. Dial Number  
and 300 Abbreviated Dial Num-  
bers will allow you to send docu-  
ments or make telephone calls  
to 373 frequently called numbers  
without manually dialing the en-  
tire number.  
1
2
3
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
To select “ABB. NUMBERS,”  
press:  
Enter an Abbreviated Dial Num- If the ABB. Dial Number you en-  
ber from 1 to 999.  
tered has been previously regis-  
tered, continue to the next step.  
Abbreviated Dial Numbers  
This machine can store up to  
300 16-digit facsimile num-  
bers and associated 20-char-  
acter location ID names. This  
information is stored into Ab-  
breviated Dial Numbers la-  
beled from 001 to 999.  
Press:  
ABB. NBR=  
001  
ID NAME =(MAX20)  
ENTER ABB. NUMBER  
OR PRESS  
After 2 seconds:  
[BACK]:TO PREVIOUS  
[STOP]:TO COMPLETE  
TEL LIST ENTRY  
1.ABB. NUMBERS  
2.GROUP NUMBERS  
3.ONE TOUCH KEYS  
One Touch Numbers  
See page 77.  
ENTER NAME  
ID NAME =(MAX20)  
Upon entering  
the first number:  
Make sure the 3-digit number  
(001 to 999) appears correctly,  
then press:  
Alternate Numbers  
If one of the primary facsimile  
numbers is busy, and a 2nd  
facsimile is located at that  
same remote location, the  
2nd facsimile’s telephone  
number can be programmed  
as an Alternate Number.  
ABB. NUMBER ENTRY  
ABB. NUMBER =(1-999)  
X
NOTE:  
Any leading zero (0) can be  
omitted from the Abbreviated  
Dial Number.  
Important Note:  
If the ABB. Dial Number you en-  
tered has not been previously  
registered, the screen below will  
be displayed. Skip to Step 6.  
The total number of available  
locations will vary depending  
upon the amount of informa-  
tion stored in each location.  
70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Abbreviated Dialer Registration - continued  
When a Preset ABB.  
Dial Number is Active  
Change the ABB. Information  
4
5
If the selected Abbreviated Dial You can cancel, modify, or re-  
Number has been previously tain Abbreviated Dial Numbers  
registered, the following infor- registered in this facsimile.  
mation will be displayed on the  
5a  
5b  
5c  
Retain the Current  
Cancel the ABB. Dial  
Information  
Modify the ABB. Dial  
Information  
ABB. Dial Information  
CANCEL  
LCD display.  
To cancel (or delete) the con-  
tents stored in the Abbreviated  
Dial Number, press:  
To change the number or Loca-  
tion ID (remote facsimile name)  
currently assigned to an exist-  
ing Abbreviated Dial Number,  
press:  
If you do not wish to change the  
Abbreviated Dial Number infor-  
mation, press:  
Deletes  
the  
information  
stored in the selected Abbre-  
viated Dial Number. It will  
also remove the number  
from all associated Group Di-  
aling Directories.  
ABB. NUMBER ENTRY  
ALREADY ASSIGNED  
ABB. NUMBER =  
001  
NEW YORK OFFICE  
(to RETAIN)  
After 2 seconds:  
(to CANCEL)  
MODIFY  
Allows you to change the re-  
mote facsimile number and/  
or associated Location ID  
name. This selection is rec-  
ommended if the location is  
used in Group Dialing Direc-  
tories.  
(to MODIFY)  
ENTER ABB. NUMBER  
OR PRESS  
[BACK]:TO PREVIOUS  
[STOP]:TO COMPLETE  
ABB. NUMBER ENTRY  
ABB. NUMBER ENTRY  
The facsimile number currently  
assigned is displayed on the  
bottom row.  
1.CANCEL  
2.MODIFY  
3.RETAIN  
ABB. NUMBER =  
CANCELLED  
001  
After 2 seconds:  
ABB. NBR=  
001  
Return to Step 3 to select a dif-  
ferent Abbreviated Dial Number  
RETAIN  
Retains the selected Abbre-  
viated Dial Number informa-  
tion without modification.  
ENTER ABB. NUMBER  
OR PRESS  
[BACK]:TO PREVIOUS  
[STOP]:TO COMPLETE  
ID NAME =(MAX20)  
After 2 seconds:  
or press  
to return to the  
ENTER NAME  
Return to Step 3.  
Standby Mode.  
ID NAME =(MAX20)  
XXXXXX  
Skip to Step 6.  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Abbreviated Dialer Registration - continued  
Enter the Location  
ID Name  
Enter the Telephone Number  
Enter an Alternate  
Number (Optional)  
6
7
8
Enter the telephone number you  
want to store (up to 128 digits).  
Enter the Location ID name of  
the remote party to be assigned  
to the current Abbreviated Dial  
Number.  
played on the bottom row of the  
LCD display as you enter it.  
Confirm that the number is cor-  
rect.  
Alternate Numbers are optional.  
If the remote location does not  
have two or more facsimile units  
in the same area, you can leave  
this entry blank. (See page 70  
for more information.)  
See page 36 for more informa-  
tion on Character Entry.  
ABB. NBR = 001  
Enter the Alternate Facsimile  
Number.  
When the name is displayed  
correctly on the LCD display,  
press:  
TEL NUMBER=(MAX128)  
9583359  
Then press:  
NOTE:  
If your facsimile is connected  
to a PBX system, you may  
need to enter an access digit  
(9) and a pause so the sys-  
tem will connect you to an  
outside line. In such cases,  
ABB. NBR=  
001  
ABB. NBR=001  
2nd TEL NBR=(MAX128)  
TEL NUMBER=(MAX.128)  
Then press:  
press  
to enter a 3-sec-  
ond pause. This pause may  
be repeated if necessary and  
may be entered anywhere  
between digits. A pause en-  
try is indicated as a hyphen  
“–” on the LCD display.  
COMM. OPTION?  
1.YES  
2.NO  
The telephone number is dis-  
72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Abbreviated Dialer Registration - continued  
Select Communication Options (Advanced Setup)  
9
This setting will allow you to  
specify one or more of the fol-  
lowing Communication Options  
for the Abbreviated Dial Number  
you are registering.  
9c  
Delayed Communications  
9a  
9b  
Select the  
Communication  
Option  
Complete the Option  
Setup  
To select default settings, press:  
If you have completed the de-  
sired Communication Options  
setting for this Abbreviated Dial  
Number, select COMPLETE by  
pressing:  
To designate a specific time at  
which operations using this Ab-  
breviated Dial Number will be  
dialed, press:  
DELAYED COMM.  
TIME =23:30  
Delayed Communication  
Default=off  
Select to program a trans-  
mission start time.  
To skip the Communication Op-  
tions, press:  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
Transmission Report  
Default=off  
The display returns to the first  
screen in Step 9. Select the  
next Option.  
Enables or disables the  
printing of a TX Report.  
DELAYED COMM.  
ABB. NBR=  
PRESS ONE TOUCH KEY  
TO ENTER OR  
001  
When “1.YES” is selected, the  
COMM. OPTIONS screen ap-  
pears. Complete the following  
steps for each item selected.  
Line Monitor  
TIME =HH:MM  
:
Default=off  
Enables or disables the line  
monitor speaker during dial-  
ing.  
[ENTER]:TO SKIP  
Enter the desired transmission  
start time in either the 12-hour  
or 24-hour format depending on  
the machine setup. (example:  
23:30 in the 24-hour format).  
Skip to Step 10.  
Quality TX  
Default=off  
COMM. OPTIONS  
1.COMPLETE  
2.DELAYED COMM.  
3.TX REPORT  
Selects  
a
lower modem  
speed for poor communica-  
tion links.  
DELAYED COMM.  
4.LINE MONITOR  
5.QUALITY TX  
6.SUB ADDRESS  
7.TEL LINE SELECT  
Sub Address  
TIME =HH:MM  
23:30  
Default=none  
Specifies a Sub Address for  
the Abbreviated Dial Number  
being registered. The remote  
unit must support Sub-Ad-  
dress capabilities.  
These items are outside the  
LCD frame. To view them,  
use the [ ] scroll key.  
Then press:  
Tel Line Select  
Default=first available  
Specifies which tel line is se-  
lected when the 2nd Line is  
installed.  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Abbreviated Dialer Registration - continued  
Select Communication Options - continued  
9
9d  
9e  
9f  
9g  
Sub-Address  
Transmission Report  
Line Monitor Speaker  
Quality TX  
Communication  
To request a Transmission Re- To enable/disable the facsimi- To transmit documents to this  
port automatically after sending le’s Line Monitor Speaker when Abbreviated Dial Number at a  
documents using this Abbrevi- dialing this Abbreviated Dial lower speed for poor line condi-  
Sub-Address Communications  
allow a variety of specialized  
facsimile communications.  
QUALITY TX  
1.OFF  
2.14400BPS  
3. 9600BPS  
ated Dial Number, select:  
Number, press:  
tions, press:  
SUB  
4. 4800BPS  
Sub-Address Transmission  
Allows documents to be routed  
through remote LAN-Facsimile  
devices to specific users’ work-  
stations.  
These items are outside the  
LCD frame. To view them,  
use the [ ] scroll key.  
To cancel the QUALITY TX op-  
tion, press:  
SET TX REPORT  
1.ON  
LINE MONITOR  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
2.OFF  
Allows documents to be trans-  
mitted to specific Mailboxes in  
remote facsimile.  
The display returns to the first  
screen in Step 9. Select the next  
Option.  
To select 14400BPS, press:  
To select 9600BPS, press:  
To select 4800BPS, press:  
To enable a TX Report, press:  
To disable a TX Report, press:  
To enable the monitor speaker,  
press:  
SEP  
Selective Polling  
Allows documents to be re-  
trieved from specific Mailboxes  
in remote facsimiles.  
To disable the monitor speaker,  
press:  
PWD  
Password  
Allows secure communications  
to SUB and from SEP compat-  
ible devices.  
The display returns to the first  
screen in Step 9. Select the next  
Option.  
The display returns to the first  
screen in Step 9. Select the next  
Option.  
IMPORTANT:  
If you designate an incorrect  
sub-address, the communica-  
tion will result in an error. If you  
designate an unnecessary sub-  
address, the communication will  
result in error.  
74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Abbreviated Dialer Registration - continued  
Select Communication Options - continued  
9
9g  
Sub-Address Communication - continued  
9g-1  
9g-2  
9g-3  
9g-4  
9g-5  
Select the Sub  
Address Comm.  
Options  
Complete the  
Sub-Address Comm.  
Options Setup  
Select a SUB  
Sub-Address  
Communication  
Select a SEP  
Sub-Address  
Communication  
Select a PWD  
Sub-Address  
Communication  
If the remote party assigned to  
the Abbreviated Dial Number re-  
quires or provides a Sub Ad-  
dress to route or retrieve mes-  
sages, press:  
To complete Sub Address entry To enter a SUB type Sub Ad- To enter a SEP type Sub Ad- To enter a PWD type Sub Ad-  
or skip this option, press:  
dress, press:  
dress, press:  
dress, press:  
The display returns to the first  
screen in Step 9.  
SUB ADDRESS COMM.  
SUB =(MAX20)  
SUB ADDRESS COMM.  
SEP =(MAX20)  
SUB ADDRESS COMM.  
PWD =(MAX20)  
Returns to Step 8g-1.  
COMM. OPTIONS  
1.COMPLETE  
2.DELAYED COMM.  
3.TX REPORT  
SUB ADDRESS COMM.  
1.COMPLETE  
2.SUB  
Enter the required number (max. Enter the required number (max. Enter the required number (max.  
20 digits), then press:  
20 digits), then press:  
20 digits), then press:  
3.SEP  
4.PWD  
This item is outside the LCD  
frame. To view it, use the  
Returns to Step 9g-1.  
Returns to Step 9g-1.  
Returns to Step 9g-1.  
[
] scroll key.  
SUB ADDRESS COMM.  
1.COMPLETE  
2.SUB  
SUB ADDRESS COMM.  
1.COMPLETE  
2.SUB  
SUB ADDRESS COMM.  
1.COMPLETE  
2.SUB  
3.SEP  
3.SEP  
3.SEP  
4.PWD  
4.PWD  
4.PWD  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Abbreviated Dialer Registration - continued  
Select Communication Options - continued  
Assign the Abbreviated Dial Number to a One Touch Key  
9
10  
9h  
10a  
10b  
Use a Preassigned One Touch Key  
Select the Telephone Line  
Assign the  
One Touch Key  
If the desired One Touch Key  
has been previously linked to  
another Abbreviated Dial Num-  
ber or preset with a separate  
One Touch number, one of the  
following screens will be dis-  
played.  
If your facsimile is equipped with  
the Line 2 Board, you will be  
able to designate which phone  
line to use (Line 1 or Line 2) for  
this Abbreviated Dial Number by  
pressing:  
To assign this Abbreviated Dial  
Number to a One Touch Key,  
press the desired One Touch  
Key (Example: One Touch Key  
01).  
To CANCEL the existing link or  
One Touch assignment and re-  
turn to Step 10a, press:  
To allow the Line to be selected  
automatically, press:  
To designate Line 1, press:  
To desingnate Line 2, press:  
To RETAIN the existing link or  
One Touch assignment and re-  
turn to Step 10a, press:  
One Touch key has been as-  
signed to an Abbreviated Num-  
ber:  
ABB. NBR=  
001  
01  
ONE TOUCH=  
L.A. OFFICE  
REGISTERED  
TEL LINE SELECT  
1.FIRST AVAILABLE  
2.LINE #1  
ONE TOUCH=  
01  
ALREADY ASSIGNED  
ABB. NBR=  
After 2 seconds:  
003  
3.LINE #2  
SMITH’S OFFICE  
Returns to Step 10a.  
ENTER ABB. NUMBER  
OR PRESS  
[BACK]:TO PREVIOUS  
[STOP]:TO COMPLETE  
ABB. NBR=  
PRESS ONE TOUCH KEY  
TO ENTER OR  
001  
One Touch key has been as-  
signed with an Individual Phone  
Number:  
Returns to Step 9.  
[ENTER]:TO SKIP  
COMM. OPTIONS  
1.COMPLETE  
2.DELAYED COMM.  
3.TX REOIRT  
ONE TOUCH=  
ALREADY ASSIGNED  
ONE TOUCH=  
01  
01  
Returns to Step 2.  
WEST REGION CENTER  
After 2 seconds:  
Press  
to exit the Menu  
ONE TOUCH=  
CANCEL ?  
1.CANCEL  
2.RETAIN  
01  
Operation mode and return to  
the Standby Mode.  
76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
One Touch Dialer Registration  
This facsimile provides a total of  
Display the TEL  
LIST ENTRY Menu  
Display the ONE  
TOUCH KEYS Menu  
Select a One Touch  
Location  
When a Preset One  
Touch is Active  
73 One Touch Dial keys. Keys 1  
to 49 are accessible with the  
Flip Panel in the “01-49” view.  
Keys 50 to 73 are accessible  
with the Flip Panel in the “50-73”  
view.  
1
2
3
4
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50- To select “ONE TOUCH KEYS”,  
73” view to select the desired press:  
Function Key.  
Press the desired One Touch If the pressed One Touch key  
key.  
has already been registered  
with a telephone number, the  
following information appears on  
the LCD display.  
Example: One Touch key 03  
Press:  
Alternate Numbers  
If one of the primary fac-  
simile numbers is busy, and  
a 2nd facsimile is located at  
that same remote location,  
the 2nd facsimile’s telephone  
number can be programmed  
as an Alternate Number.  
If the One Touch key has not  
been previously used and the  
following menu is displayed,  
skip to Step 6.  
ONE TOUCH=  
03  
ALREADY ASSIGNED  
ABB. NUMBER =  
FRISCO OFFICE  
DIAL ENTRY  
PRESS ONE TOUCH KEY  
OR PRESS  
[BACK]:TO PREVIOUS  
[STOP]:TO COMPLETE  
012  
1.ABB. NUMBERS  
2.GROUP NUMBERS  
3.ONE TOUCH KEYS  
After 2 seconds:  
ONE TOUCH=  
03  
ONE TOUCH KEY ENTRY  
1.CANCEL  
2.MODIFY  
3.RETAIN  
ID NAME =(MAX20)  
After 2 seconds:  
ENTER NAME  
ID NAME =(MAX20)  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
One Touch Dialer Registration - continued  
Change One Touch Information  
Enter the Location  
ID Name  
5
6
You can cancel or retain the  
One Touch key once registered  
into the facsimile.  
Enter the Location ID name of  
the remote party to be assigned  
to the current One Touch key.  
5a  
5b  
5c  
Cancel the One Touch  
Assignment  
Modify the One Touch  
Assignment  
Retain the One Touch  
Assignment  
CANCEL  
Deletes  
See page 36 for more informa-  
tion on Character Entry.  
To cancel (or delete) the One To change the number or Loca-  
To retain the previous One  
Touch key assignment, press:  
the  
information  
Touch key assignment, press:  
tion ID (remote facsimile name)  
currently assigned to an existing  
One Touch key press:  
stored in the selected One  
Touch key. It will also re-  
move the number from all  
associated Group Dialing Di-  
rectories.  
When the name is displayed  
correctly on the LCD display,  
press:  
(to CANCEL)  
(to RETAIN)  
MODIFY  
(to MODIFY)  
Allows you to change the re-  
mote facsimile number and/  
or associated Location ID  
name. This selection is rec-  
ommended if the location is  
used in Group Dialing Direc-  
tories.  
ONE TOUCH KEY ENTRY  
ENTER ONE TOUCH KEY  
OR PRESS  
The facsimile number currently  
assigned is displayed on the  
bottom row.  
ONE TOUCH=  
CANCELLED  
03  
[BACK]:TO PREVIOUS  
[STOP]:TO COMPLETE  
ONE TOUCH=  
03  
TEL NUMBER=(MAX 128)  
After 2 seconds:  
Return to Step 3 to select a dif-  
ferent One Touch key or press  
ENTER ONE TOUCH KEY  
OR PRESS  
[BACK]:TO PREVIOUS  
[STOP]:TO COMPLETE  
ONE TOUCH=  
03  
RETAIN  
Retains the selected One  
Touch key information with-  
out modification.  
ID NAME =(MAX20)  
to return to the Standby  
Mode.  
After 2 seconds:  
Return to Step 3.  
ENTER NAME  
ID NAME =(MAX20)  
XXXXXX  
Return to Step 3.  
78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
One Touch Dialer Registration - continued  
Enter the Telephone Number  
Select Communication Options (Advanced Setup)  
Enter the Alternate  
Number (Optional)  
7
9
8
Enter the telephone number you number on the bottom row of Alternate Numbers are optional.  
This setting will allow you to  
specify one or more of the fol-  
lowing Communication Options  
for the One Touch key you are  
registering.  
9a  
Select the  
Communication Option  
want to store (up to 128 digits).  
the LCD display. If it is correct, If the remote location does not  
press:  
have two or more facsimiles in  
the same area, you can leave  
this entry blank. (See page 77  
for more information.)  
To select the most popular set-  
tings, skip this step (recom-  
mended) and return to Step 3 by  
pressing:  
Delayed Communication  
Default=off  
Enter the Alternate Facsimile  
Number:  
ONE TOUCH=  
03  
Select to program a trans-  
mission start time.  
2nd TEL NBR=(MAX128)  
Transmission Report  
Default=off  
To specify the Communication  
Options, press:  
NOTE:  
Enables or disables the  
printing of a TX Report.  
If your facsimile is connected  
to a PBX system, you may  
need to enter an access digit  
(9) and pause so the system  
will connect you to an out-  
side line. In such cases,  
Line Monitor  
Default=off  
Enables or disables the line  
monitor speaker during dial-  
ing.  
When “1.YES” is selected, the  
COMM. OPTIONS screen ap-  
pears. Follow the next steps for  
each item selection.  
Then press:  
press  
to enter a 3-sec-  
Quality TX  
Default=off  
ond pause. This pause may  
be repeated if necessary and  
may be entered anywhere  
between digits. A pause en-  
try is indicated as a hyphen  
“–” on the LCD display.  
Selects  
a
lower modem  
COMM. OPTION?  
1.YES  
2.NO  
COMM. OPTIONS  
1.COMPLETE  
2.DELAYED COMM.  
3.TX REPORT  
speed for poor communica-  
tion links.  
Sub Address  
Default=none  
4.LINE MONITOR  
5.QUALITY TX  
6.SUB ADDRESS  
7.TEL LINE SELECT  
Check the entered telephone  
Specifies a Sub Address for  
the One Touch key being  
registered. The remote unit  
must support Sub-Address  
capabilities.  
These items are outside the  
LCD frame. To view them,  
use the [ ] scroll key.  
Tel Line Select  
Default=first available  
Specifies which tel line is se-  
lected when the 2nd Line is  
installed.  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
One Touch Dialer Registration - continued  
Select Communication Options - continued  
9
9b  
9c  
9d  
9e  
9f  
Quality TX  
Complete the Option  
Setup  
Delayed  
Communications  
Transmission Report  
Line Monitor Speaker  
To transmit documents to this  
One Touch Dial Number at a  
lower speed for poor line condi-  
tions, press:  
To designate a specific time at  
which operations using this One  
Touch key will be dialed, press:  
If you have completed the de-  
sired Communication Options  
setting for this One Touch key,  
select COMPLETE by pressing:  
To request a Transmission Re- To enable/disable the facsimi-  
port automatically after sending le’s Line Monitor Speaker when  
document using this One Touch dialing with this One Touch key,  
key, select:  
press:  
To cancel the QUALITY TX op-  
tion, press:  
DELAYED COMM.  
Return to Step 3.  
SET TX REPORT  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
LINE MONITOR  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
TIME =HH:MM  
:
PRESS ONE TOUCH KEY  
OR PRESS  
[BACK]:TO PREVIOUS  
[STOP]:TO COMPLETE  
To select 14400BPS, press:  
To select 9600BPS, press:  
To select 4800BPS, press:  
Enter the transmission start time  
in either the 12-hour or 24-hour  
format depending on the ma-  
chine set up (example: 23:30 in  
the 24-hour format).  
To enable a TX Report, press:  
To disable a TX Report, press:  
To enable the monitor speaker,  
press:  
DELAYED COMM.  
TIME =HH:MM  
23:30  
To disable the monitor speaker,  
press:  
Press:  
QUALITY TX  
1.OFF  
2.14400BPS  
3. 9600BPS  
The display returns to the first The display returns to the first  
screen in Step 9. Select the next screen in Step 9. Select the next  
DELAYED COMM.  
TIME =23:30  
Option.  
Option.  
4. 4800BPS  
This item is outside the  
LCD frame. To view it, use  
the [ ] scroll key.  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
The display returns to the first  
screen in Step 9. Select the  
next Option.  
The display returns to the first  
screen in Step 9. Select the next  
Option.  
80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
One Touch Dialer Registration - continued  
Select Communication Options - continued  
9
9g  
Sub-Address Communication - continued  
Sub-Address Communications  
allow a variety of specialized  
facsimile communications.  
9g-1  
9g-2  
9g-3  
9g-4  
Select the Sub  
Address Comm.  
Options  
Complete the  
Sub-Address Comm.  
Options Setup  
Select a SUB  
Sub-Address  
Communication  
Select a SEP  
Sub-Address  
Communication  
SUB  
Sub-Address Transmission  
Allows documents to be routed  
through remote LAN-Fax de-  
vices to specific users’ worksta-  
tions.  
If the remote party assigned to  
this One Touch key requires or  
provides a Sub Address to  
route or retrieve messages,  
press:  
To complete Sub Address entry To enter a SUB type Sub Ad-  
To enter a SEP type Sub Ad-  
dress, press:  
or skip this option, press:  
dress, press:  
Allows documents to be trans-  
mitted to specific Mailboxes in  
remote facsimiles.  
The display returns to the first  
screen in Step 9.  
SUB ADDRESS COMM.  
SUB ADDRESS COMM.  
SEP =(MAX20)  
SUB =(MAX20)  
Returns to Step 8g-1.  
SEP  
Selective Polling  
SUB ADDRESS COMM.  
1.COMPLETE  
2.SUB  
COM OPTIONS  
1.COMPLETE  
2.DELAYED COMM.  
3.TX REPORT  
Enter the required number (max.  
20 digits), then press:  
Enter the required number (max.  
20 digits), then press:  
Allows documents to be re-  
trieved from specific Mailboxes  
residing in remote facsimiles.  
3.SEP  
PWD  
Password  
4.PWD  
Returns to Step 9g-1.  
Returns to Step 9g-1.  
Allows secure communications  
to SUB and from SEP compat-  
ible devices.  
This item is outside the LCD  
frame. To view it, use the  
SUB ADDRESS COMM.  
1.COMPLETE  
2.SUB  
SUB ADDRESS COMM.  
1.COMPLETE  
2.SUB  
[
] scroll key.  
IMPORTANT:  
If you designate an incorrect  
sub-address, the communica-  
tion will result in an error. If you  
designate an unnecessary sub-  
address, the communication will  
result in an error.  
3.SEP  
3.SEP  
4.PWD  
4.PWD  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
One Touch Dialer Registration - continued  
Select Communication Options - continued  
9
Sub-Address  
Communication  
- continued  
9g  
9h  
Select the Telephone  
Line  
If your facsimile is equipped with  
the 2nd Line Board, you will be  
able to designate which phone  
line to use (Line 1 or Line 2) for  
this One Touch key by pressing:  
9g-5  
Select a PWD  
Sub-Address  
Communication  
To enter a PWD type Sub Ad-  
dress, press:  
To allow the Line to be selected  
TEL LINE SELECT  
1.FIRST AVAILABLE  
2.LINE #1  
SUB ADDRESS COMM.  
PWD =(MAX20)  
3.LINE #2  
automatically, press:  
Enter the required number (max.  
20 digits), then press:  
To designate Line 1, press:  
Returns to Step 9g-1.  
To designate Line 2, press:  
Returns to Step 9.  
SUB ADDRESS COMM.  
1.COMPLETE  
2.SUB  
3.SEP  
4.PWD  
COMM. OPTIONS  
1.COMPLETE  
2.DELAYED COMM.  
3.TX REPORT  
82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Group Number Registration  
You can send a document to  
Display the TEL  
LIST ENTRY Menu  
Display the GROUP  
NUMBERS Menu  
Enter a Group Number  
multiple remote parties in a sin-  
gle operation. This is referred to  
as Group Dialing or Multi-ad-  
dress Transmission.  
1
2
3
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50- To select “GROUP NUMBERS,” Enter a Group Number (1 to If the number entered is already  
73” view to select the desired press:  
Function Key.  
1999).  
registered as a Group Number,  
you will receive an LCD prompt  
like the one below.  
It is useful to preset addresses,  
to which Multi-address Transmis-  
sions are often performed, in a  
group. To make a Multi-address  
Transmission easier, you can as-  
sign such a group to a One  
Touch key.  
Press:  
GROUP NBR ENTRY  
ALREADY ASSIGNED  
GROUP NBR=  
OREGON GRP  
0001  
The preset groups can also be  
used as groups for Multi-polling  
Receptions.  
TEL LIST ENTRY  
1.ABB. NUMBERS  
2.GROUP NUMBERS  
3.ONE TOUCH KEYS  
ENTER GROUP NUMBER  
OR PRESS  
[BACK]:TO PREVIOUS  
[STOP]:TO COMPLETE  
After 2 seconds:  
GROUP NBR ENTRY  
1.CANCEL  
Example: 1  
You can register up to 50 Broad-  
cast Groups using any combina-  
tion of Group Numbers from 1 to  
1999 (no duplications allowed).  
You may also assign each group  
an optional name of up to 20  
characters.  
Each group can contain any  
combination of the 300 Abbrevi-  
ated and/or 73 One Touch dial  
locations and can be assigned to  
a One Touch key.  
2.MODIFY  
3.RETAIN  
GROUP NBR ENTRY  
GROUP NBR =(1-1999)  
1
To select “1.CANCEL,” go to  
Step 4a.  
Then press:  
To select “2.MODIFY,” go to  
Step 4b.  
To select “3.RETAIN,” go to  
Step 4c.  
GROUP NBR=  
0001  
GROUP NAME =(MAX20)  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
The display changes to the fol-  
lowing for character entry (go to  
Step 5).  
ENTER NAME  
GROUP NAME =(MAX20)  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Group Number Registration - continued  
4a Cancel the Existing 4b Modify the Existing 4c Retain the Existing  
5
6
Enter the Group  
Name  
Enter a Remote  
Station  
Group  
Group  
Group  
Enter the addresses of the re-  
mote stations to be preset in  
the group.  
To cancel the existing Group,  
press:  
To change the existing Group,  
press:  
To retain the existing Group,  
press:  
Enter the Group Name (with up  
to 20 characters) associated  
with the Group Number.  
If a remote station is assigned  
to a One Touch key, press the  
One Touch key.  
See page 36 for more informa-  
tion on Character Entry.  
(to CANCEL)  
(to MODIFY)  
(to RETAIN)  
If a remote station is assigned  
to an Abbreviated Dial Number,  
enter the number then press  
.
(When no name is entered in  
this step, no name will be given  
to the Group Number.)  
Go to Step 5 for the Group  
Name entry.  
GROUP NBR ENTRY  
GROUP NBR=  
0001  
ENTER GROUP NUMBER  
OR PRESS  
[BACK]:TO PREVIOUS  
[STOP]:TO COMPLETE  
When the name is displayed  
correctly on the LCD display,  
press:  
GROUP NBR=  
CANCELLED  
0001  
GROUP NAME =(MAX20)  
Example:  
Abbreviated Dial Number  
118 (preset as DENVER  
OFFICE):  
After 2 seconds:  
After 2 seconds:  
Return to Step 3.  
ENTER NAME  
ENTER GROUP NUMBER  
OR PRESS  
GROUP NBR=  
0001  
+
+
+
GROUP NAME =(MAX20)  
COLORADO GRP  
[BACK]:TO PREVIOUS  
[STOP]:TO COMPLETE  
ENTER ABB. NBR OR OT  
[ENTER]:TO COMPLETE  
The current Group Name is dis-  
played.  
Return to Step 3.  
Skip to Step 5.  
GROUP NBR= 0001  
ABB. NBR=  
118  
DENVER OFFICE  
After 2 seconds:  
GROUP NBR=  
ABB. NBR=  
0001  
118  
ENTER ABB. NBR OR OT  
[ENTER] TO COMPLETE  
84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Group Number Registration - continued  
7a Cancel the Group 7b Retain the Group  
8
9
Enter a Remote  
Station - continued  
Complete Group  
Station Entries  
Assign a One Touch  
Key  
6
Number Setting  
Number Setting  
Repeat this step until all of the  
required remote station ad-  
dresses are entered. Then go to  
Step 8.  
To delete the existing remote To retain this remote station in  
When all the stations necessary To assign this group to a One  
for this group are entered in Touch key, press the desired  
station from this group, press:  
this group, press:  
Step 6, press:  
One Touch key.  
Example: One Touch key 35.  
(to CANCEL)  
(to RETAIN)  
GROUP NBR=  
NOTE:  
When the entered Abbrevi-  
ated Dial Number or One  
Touch key has not been pre-  
registered with a facsimile  
number, the display shows  
the message “NUMBER  
NOT LISTED.” Then returns  
to Step 5.  
GROUP NBR=  
0001  
118  
0001  
GROUP NBR=  
PRESS ONE TOUCH KEY  
TO ENTER OR  
0001  
GROUP NBR=  
0001  
35  
ONE TOUCH KEY=  
COLORADO GRP  
REGISTERED  
ABB. NBR=  
CANCELLED  
ENTER ABB. NBR OR OT  
[ENTER]:TO COMPLETE  
[ENTER]:TO SKIP  
After 2 seconds:  
After 2 seconds:  
Return to Step 6.  
GROUP NBR=  
0001  
ENTER GROUP NUMBER  
When the entered Abbrevi-  
ated Dial Number or One  
Touch key is already as-  
signed in this group, the dis-  
play shows the screens be-  
low.  
OR PRESS  
[BACK]:TO PREVIOUS  
[STOP]:TO COMPLETE  
ENTER ABB. NBR OR OT  
[ENTER]:TO COMPLETE  
Returns to Step 3.  
Return to Step 6.  
Press  
to display the pre-  
GROUP NBR=  
ALREADY ASSIGNED  
ABB. NBR=  
0001  
118  
ceding-level screen in Menu  
Screen mode.  
DENVER OFFICE  
Or,  
After 2 seconds:  
ABB. NBR=  
CANCEL ?  
1.CANCEL  
2.RETAIN  
118  
press  
to complete the  
Group Setting operation and re-  
turn to the Standby Mode.  
Go to Step 7a or Step 7b.  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Group Number Registration - continued  
Assign a One Touch Key - continued  
9
To skip assigning this group to a  
One Touch key, press:  
If the selected One Touch key To RETAIN, press:  
is already linked to or registered  
with any data, the following is  
displayed.  
ONE TOUCH=  
ALREADY ASSIGNED  
ABB. NBR=  
01  
GROUP NBR=  
PRESS ONE TOUCH KEY  
TO ENTER OR  
0001  
ENTER GROUP NUMBER  
OR PRESS  
[BACK]:TO PREVIOUS  
[STOP]:TO COMPLETE  
003  
SMITH’S OFFICE  
[ENTER]:TO SKIP  
After 2 seconds:  
Returns to Step 9.  
Return to Step 3.  
ONE TOUCH=  
CANCEL ?  
1.CANCEL  
2.RETAIN  
01  
Press  
to display the pre-  
ceding-level screen in Menu  
Screen mode.  
To select “1.CANCEL” (to can-  
cel the existing link or preset  
data of this One Touch key),  
press:  
Press  
to complete the  
Group Setting operation and re-  
turn to the Standby Mode.  
GROUP NBR=  
0001  
PRESS ONE TOUCH KEY  
TO ENTER OR  
[ENTER]:TO SKIP  
Returns to Step 9.  
86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- TRANSMIT CONFIGURATION  
Document Specifications  
Caution:  
If the documents are any of the following, they should be copied to plain paper  
before transmitting.  
The following table shows the specifications for original documents that can be used  
with the facsimile.  
Single Sheet  
Multiple Sheets  
Torn, wrinkled, or damp pages  
Folded pages or pages with holes  
Transparent pages or pages with a smooth, shiny finish  
Cloth or metal sheets  
216mm(W) x 1000mm(L)  
[8.5 in.(W) x 39.37 in.(L)]  
Max.  
Min.  
Document  
Size  
When using originals with the following specifications, use a carrier sheet to avoid  
document jams or misfeeds. When using carrier sheets, only one sheet can be  
sent at a time.  
148mm(W) x 100mm(L)  
[5.83 in.(W) x 3.94 in.(L)]  
Effective Scanning  
Width  
214mm  
[8.4 in.]  
Smaller than minimum size.  
With thickness less than 0.05 mm.  
To use a carrier sheet, lift the clear cover, place a single document sheet face-up  
on the paper sheet. Purchase carrier sheets from your TOSHIBA facsimile dealer  
or use a transparency with a paper backing attached at the lead edge.  
Max. Capacity of  
Document Tray  
Up to 20 sheets (Legal Size)  
Up to 50 sheets (Letter Size)  
Thickness of  
Document  
0.05 to 0.15 mm  
[0.002 to 0.0059 in.]  
0.06 to 0.12 mm  
[0.0025 to 0.0047 in.]  
Type of Paper  
Uncoated on both sides  
NOTES:  
Operator assistance may be required for pages longer than 420mm (16.5  
inches).  
For multiple sheets, the documents must be the same size and paper type.  
A small border region of each document is not imaged when each document is  
scanned. The effective scanning area is as shown in the figure below.  
216 mm (8.5 inches)  
Max. 4 mm (0.16 inches)  
Effective  
Scanning  
Area  
Letter/Legal Size  
Max. 2.5 mm (0.1 inches)  
214 mm (8.4 inches)  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Document Loading  
Remove Attached  
Items  
Place Document Pages on the Document Tray  
Adjust the Settings  
1
2
3
After the facsimile pulls the  
document into the scan position  
slightly and stops, you may  
change the resolution and con-  
trast settings. (It may also be  
changed before or during the  
document loading.)  
About 45°  
Document Face Side  
073  
074  
110  
To cancel a document already  
set and pulled in, press:  
Remove any staples, paper  
clips, or other items from your  
document before feeding it into  
the facsimile.  
Up to 50 sheets (Letter-size) Adjust the Document Guides to  
can be loaded and sent at a fit the width of the document.  
time.  
Load the document face down  
Stagger the leading edges of on the document tray. The first  
the sheets slightly and insert page of your document should  
When scanning Legal-size doc-  
uments, extend the Exit Docu-  
ment Tray Extension.  
them into the document feeder.  
be at the bottom of the Docu-  
ment Tray.  
If your document is extremely  
dark or light, or if it contains  
photographs, you may wish to  
adjust the contrast and resolu-  
tion settings. See the following  
pages.  
Gently insert the leading edge of  
the paper into the facsimile as  
shown. The facsimile waits 2  
seconds, then pulls the docu-  
ment into the scanning area and  
stops.  
When a Carrier Sheet is used,  
documents must be sent one  
page at a time (manually fed).  
When the document sheet is  
longer the Document Tray, as-  
sist it with your hand to insure  
proper feeding.  
88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scan Resolution Setting  
The scan resolution can be set  
to one of the following five  
modes based on the type of im-  
age you are scanning.  
Press  
until the required resolution mode is  
indicated by the appropriate LED.  
The scan resolution is normally  
set to the default setting. When  
you change the resolution, the  
facsimile will return to the de-  
fault setting after each transac-  
tion. To change the default reso-  
lution setting, see page 64.  
: illuminated  
: extinguished  
The mode changes as follows:  
(
)
FINE  
U-FINE  
HALFTONE  
Standard Mode (when all the lamps are extinguished)  
FINE  
STANDARD  
U-FINE  
HALFTONE  
Fine Mode  
For sending normal text and  
graphics.  
FINE  
FINE  
U-FINE  
HALFTONE  
Ultra-Fine Mode  
For sending normal text and  
graphics with extra clarity.  
Each corresponding  
lamp is illuminated.  
U-FINE (Ultra-Fine)  
FINE  
For sending fine text and  
graphics with extra clarity.  
U-FINE  
HALFTONE  
Fine Halftone Mode  
FINE HALFTONE  
FINE  
For detailed photos or docu-  
ments with colors or shading.  
U-FINE  
HALFTONE  
Ultra-Fine Halftone Mode  
U-FINE HALFTONE  
(Ultra-Fine Halftone)  
For very detailed photos or  
documents with colors or  
shading.  
*
When Ultra-Fine is selected, the DF120F/DP125F will scan all  
documents at 406 dots/inch horizontal x 391 lines/inch vertical.  
Depending on the capabilities of the remote facsimile receiving  
this document, the document may be transmitted by the DF120F/  
DP125F at Ultra-Fine resolution (406 dots/inch horizontal x 391  
lines/inche vertical) or it may be transmitted at Super Fine (203  
dots/inch horizontal x 391 lines/inch vertical).  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contrast Setting  
The Contrast Setting adjusts the  
print darkness of the document  
to be read.  
Display the SET  
CONTRAST Menu  
Select the Contrast  
1
2
The contrast can be set to one  
of the following settings. The  
facsimile will return to the de-  
fault setting after each transac-  
tion.  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50- Select the desired Contrast  
73” view to select the desired level.  
Function Key.  
To select NORMAL, press:  
Press:  
To change the default contrast  
setting, see page 64.  
NORMAL  
To select DARKER, press:  
For standard originals.  
SET CONTRAST  
1.NORMAL  
2.DARKER  
DARKER  
To darken light originals (i.e.,  
for documents with light or  
faint print).  
3.LIGHTER  
To select LIGHTER, press:  
LIGHTER  
To lighten the dark originals  
(i.e., for documents with dark  
print or shaded areas).  
Your contrast setting is now set.  
You may continue with your di-  
aling sequence to send the  
document.  
COMM. RESERVATION  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Default Setting for Memory Transmission  
Memory Transmission allows  
your facsimile to quickly scan  
documents to memory and re-  
Display the Default  
Setting Menu  
Display the  
MEMORY TX Menu  
Select the Transmis-  
sion Mode  
1
2
3
turn them to you. You do not  
have to wait for the transmission  
Press:  
Press:  
Select the desired transmission  
mode.  
to be completed. This increases  
productivity as others do not  
have to wait in line to send a  
facsimile. Each time you send a  
facsimile with memory transmis-  
sion, the amount of residual  
memory will be reduced.  
To set Memory Transmission to  
ON, press:  
+
+
+
To set Memory Transmission to  
OFF, press:  
Additionally, each time you send  
a memory transmission, a com-  
munication reservation or File  
Number is assigned.  
When Memory Transmission is  
not selected, the Direct Docu-  
ment Transmission (tray) mode  
is active by default setting. This  
allows your facsimile to function  
without the use of document  
memory.  
01.MEMORY TX  
SET MEMORY TX  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
02.SECURITY TX  
03.COVER SHEET  
04.RECOVERY TX  
05.TTI  
06.SEND AFTER SCAN  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Send After Scan Default Setting  
This feature enables you to de-  
Display the SEND  
AFTER SCAN Menu  
Select the Send  
After Scan Option  
Select the Memory  
Full Option  
Select Another  
SETUP Item, or ...  
termine whether dialing starts  
while the machine is scanning  
the documents or after the ma-  
chine has scanned all docu-  
ments in the Memory Send  
mode.  
If dialing after scanning is se-  
lected, you can select to delete  
or send the scanned pages  
should the memory become full  
during scanning.  
1
2
3
4
Press:  
Select the desired Send After Select the desired Memory Full After completing this Setting,  
Scan Option.  
Option.  
you may continue to select other  
settings referring to their associ-  
To disable Send After Scan, To delete the pages being ated pages for instructions, or  
press:  
+
+
+
+
scanned, press:  
press  
The following is displayed for 2 To send the pages scanned to  
seconds.  
memory, press:  
to exit the Setting mode and re-  
turn to the Standby Mode.  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
Go to Step 4.  
To enable Send After Scan,  
press:  
SEND AFTER SCAN  
1.DIAL DURING SCAN  
2.DIAL AFTER SCAN  
Go to Step 3.  
WHEN MEMORY FULL  
1.DELETE SCAN PAGES  
2.SEND SCAN PAGES  
92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Default Setting for Security Transmission  
This function allows transmis-  
sions only when the number you  
Display the Default  
Setting Menu  
Display the  
SECURITY TX Menu  
Select the Desired  
Option  
1
2
3
dial matches the number pro-  
grammed in the remote facsimi-  
le. If the numbers do not match,  
Security Transmission prevents  
your facsimile from sending by  
indicating a transmission error.  
Press:  
Press:  
Select the desired option.  
To set Security Transmission to  
ON, press:  
+
+
+
To set Security Transmission to  
OFF, press:  
01.MEMORY TX  
SET SECURITY TX  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
02.SECURITY TX  
03.COVER SHEET  
04.RECOVERY TX  
05.TTI  
06.SEND AFTER SCAN  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- COPYING  
Paper Size for Copying  
You can utilize the DP120F/DP125F as a convenient copier to make collated copies of  
original documents. The following are key points when making copies.  
At the time of copying, the COLLATE function may be selected. This function will sort  
multiple page copies into sets of correct-order pages.  
Recording Paper Size  
Output Examples of Printed Copies  
The paper sizes usable with your fax unit are limited to Letter or Legal size. The  
received document is recorded (printed) within the Effective Recording Area of the  
paper.  
With COLLATE Function ON  
With COLLATE Function OFF  
Paper Size  
Letter: mm  
A
B
C
D
Effective  
Recording  
Area  
216 209 273 279  
Page 1  
Page 1  
Page 1  
Page 2  
Page 2  
Page 2  
Page 3  
Page 3  
Page 3  
Page 3  
Page 2  
Page 1  
Page 3  
Page 2  
Page 1  
Page 3  
Page 2  
Page 1  
C D  
inches 8.5 8.2 10.7 11.0  
Legal: mm 216 209 350 356  
inches  
8.2 13.8 14.0  
B
A
8.5  
NOTES:  
When AUTO is selected as the Paper Tray setting, you cannot select AUTO for  
Reduction setting.  
When AUTO is selected as the Paper Tray setting, the paper is not supplied  
from the tray specified for Letter Head Paper or Separator Page. However, you  
can select a tray manually by selecting the Paper Tray.  
NOTES:  
NOTES:  
The pages are automatically col-  
lated.  
Collating is the responsibility of  
the operator.  
The following copy resolutions are available:  
FINE  
U-FINE  
FINE+HALFTONE  
U-FINE+HALFTONE  
Requires enough memory for the  
entire multi-page document. If  
there is not enough memory  
(memory overflow), the copying  
procedure will be canceled.  
Memory requirements are limited  
to one page at a time.  
Collation is slower than non-colla-  
tion because the entire document  
must be scanned into memory  
first, then printing can occur.  
94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copying Procedure  
Load the Document  
Press the COPY Key  
Enter the Number of  
Copies  
Select the Paper Tray and Paper Size  
1
2
3
4
Load the document face down  
in the Document Tray (see page  
88).  
Display the COPY menu by Select the number of copies  
Use the Following keys to move If you select the Bypass Tray,  
to the second row to select the following is displayed.  
paper tray.  
pressing:  
(max. 99).  
THICK PAPER  
ON  
OFF  
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
or  
AUTO  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
1st Row:  
TRAY 1 :LT  
TRAY 2 :LT  
TRAY 3 :LG  
Enter the number of copies  
If the thick paper is loaded in the  
Bypass Tray, select ON by  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
required. If no entry is made,  
the number of copies will au-  
tomatically be set to “1.”  
or  
, and then  
Bypass :A4  
2nd Row  
To not select the Copy Options,  
go to Step 7.  
Selectable Paper Trays and  
their paper size are displayed.  
You may select the paper tray  
and paper size of your copies  
using the following keys.  
press  
.
NOTES:  
Displays the Recording Pa-  
per Tray to supply the paper  
for the copy function.  
When AUTO is selected  
as the Paper Tray setting,  
you cannot select AUTO  
for Reduction setting.  
Example:  
To select the Copy Options, go  
to Step 4.  
Tray 1:LT is selected.  
3rd Row  
Displays the reduction ratio  
for copying.  
COPIES=(1-99)  
1
When AUTO is selected  
as the Paper Tray setting,  
the paper is not supplied  
from the tray specified for  
Letter Head Paper or  
Separator Page. How-  
ever, you can select a  
tray manually by select-  
ing the Paper Tray.  
or  
PAPER  
REDUCT 100%  
COLLATE ON OFF  
TRAY 1 :LT  
4th  
NOTE:  
Collate function (see page  
94).  
The Bypass Tray is dis-  
played only when it is set for  
LT, LG, or A4 size.  
Then press:  
COPIES=(1-99)  
PAPER AUTO  
1
REDUCT 100%  
COLLATE ON  
OFF  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copying Procedure - continued  
Select the Reduction  
Option  
Select the Collating  
Option  
Press the START  
Key  
5
6
7
Use the following keys to move  
to the third row to select the Re-  
duction option.  
Use the following keys to select When all settings are complete,  
the Collate option ON or OFF.  
press:  
or  
or  
Example:  
100%  
AUTO  
86 %  
75 %  
COLLATE ON is selected.  
NOTE:  
If the Collate option is se-  
lected, the document will be  
scanned into memory first.  
COPIES=(1-99)  
1
PAPER  
TRAY 1 :LT  
50 %  
REDUCT 86 %  
COLLATE ON  
Use the following keys to select  
the desired Reduction option,  
100%, AUTO, 86%, 75% or  
50%.  
OFF  
COPYING  
PAPER  
REDUCT 86 %  
COPIES PAGES 01  
TRAY 1 :LT  
or  
NOTE:  
If AUTO is selected for Pa-  
per Tray in Step 2, you can-  
not select AUTO for Reduc-  
tion.  
Then press:  
Example:  
86% reduction is selected.  
COPIES=(1-99)  
1
PAPER  
TRAY 1 :LT  
REDUCT 86 %  
COLLATE ON  
OFF  
96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- DIALING METHODS  
Your TOSHIBA facsimile pro-  
vides various dialing methods.  
One Touch Key Dialing  
If you have programmed a re-  
mote party’s facsimile number  
to a One Touch key, you can  
dial that number by pressing the  
corresponding One Touch key.  
One Touch Dialing  
One Touch Key Dialing  
1
Dials remote locations with  
the touch of a single key.  
See page 77 for program-  
ming.  
Select the desired One Touch  
key from 01 to 73 (see page 77  
for programming).  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 99%  
The document must be loaded  
and the resolution and contrast  
settings set before a transmis-  
sion using One Touch Key dial-  
ing.  
Abbreviated Dialing  
Dials remote locations using  
an abbreviated dial number  
from 001 to 999. See page  
70 for programming.  
Example: One Touch key 01  
During transmission  
NOTES:  
Alphabet Dialing  
If a One Touch key is not  
programmed, the mes-  
sage “NUMBER NOT  
LISTED” is displayed for  
The One Touch key number and  
the name of the party appear on  
the LCD display for about 2 sec-  
onds.  
Allows location selection us-  
ing an alphabetic index  
search of the Location IDs  
programmed into One Touch  
and Abbreviated Dialing Di-  
rectories.  
2
seconds, an alarm  
buzzer sounds and the  
display returns to the pre-  
vious status screen.  
Your facsimile will automatically  
start scanning the document  
into memory (if enabled). While  
scanning, the facsimile dials,  
connects, and starts transmis-  
sion.  
Keypad Dialing  
Accepts unregistered tele-  
phone number entry directly  
from the operation panel.  
COMM. RESERVATION  
ONE TOUCH=  
NUMBER NOT LISTED  
01  
COMM. RESERVATION  
See other dialing related func-  
tions on the following pages:  
ONE TOUCH=  
L.A. OFFICE  
01  
When an incorrect One  
Touch key has been se-  
Multi-Key Dialing page 124  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
Chain Dialing  
Redialing  
page 166  
page 110  
lected, press  
im-  
SCANNING TO MEMORY  
Monitor &  
Handset Dialing  
pages 106  
and 107  
FILE NBR =  
089  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 99%  
mediately to cancel the  
transmission.  
Setting Redial  
Interval & Counter  
page 67  
During scan to memory  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Abbreviated Dialing  
Once an Abbreviated Dial Num-  
ber is programmed with a valid  
remote facsimile location, that  
location can be accessed by re-  
calling the corresponding Abbre-  
viated Dial Number.  
Press the SPEED  
DIAL Key  
Enter the  
Abbreviated Number  
Press the START Key Tray  
1
2
3
Press:  
When the correct number is dis-  
played, press:  
Enter the Abbreviated Dial  
Number (1 to 999) assigned to  
the desired party.  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 99%  
The document must be loaded  
and the resolution and contrast  
set before a transmission using  
Abbreviated Dialing (see page  
89).  
+
During transmission  
The One Touch key or Abbrevi-  
ated Dial Number and the name  
of the party will appear on the  
LCD display for about 2 sec-  
onds.  
NOTE:  
When the number entered  
(within the range of 1 through  
999) is not preprogrammed  
with a specific party’s fac-  
simile or telephone number,  
the message “NUMBER NOT  
LISTED” is displayed for 2  
seconds and then the fac-  
simile returns to the screen in  
Step 1.  
NOTE:  
Your facsimile will automatically  
start scanning the document into  
memory (if enabled). While  
scanning, the facsimile dials,  
connects, and starts the trans-  
mission.  
ABB. NUMBER =(1-999)  
When an incorrect number is  
entered, use  
to delete  
preceding digits, or press  
once to start over  
ABB. NBR=  
LONDON OFFICE  
10  
ABB. NBR=  
NUMBER NOT LISTED  
10  
from the beginning.  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
Displayed for 2 second  
Example of Abbreviated Dial  
Number, 10:  
COMM. RESERVATION  
SCANNING TO MEMORY  
FILE NBR =  
091  
ABB. NUMBER =(1-999)  
10  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 99%  
During scan to memory  
98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Alphabet Dialing  
“Alphabet Dialing” is used to dial  
the desired party by searching  
for the name of the registered  
Location ID name in the Abbre-  
viated Dial, One Touch Dial and  
Group Dial List.  
Press the START  
Key  
Press the SPEED  
DIAL Key  
3
1
2 Display the Name of the Desired Remote  
Party  
Once the desired name is dis-  
played, press:  
Select the “keyboard” view on  
the Flip Panel.  
Press:  
Use the following keys to select  
the “LONDON OFFICE.”  
The document must be loaded  
and the resolution and contrast  
set before a transmission using  
Alphabet Dialing (see page 89).  
Press the key on the keyboard  
which corresponds to the first  
letter of the name.  
or  
+
ENTER SEARCH NAME:  
LONDON OFFICE  
The One Touch key or Abbrevi-  
ated Dial Number and the name  
of the party appear on the LCD  
display for about 2 seconds.  
Example:To find the location  
named  
“LONDON  
ENTER SEARCH NAME:  
NAME=(MAX20)  
[]  
00003/00003  
OFFICE”:  
Press  
Your facsimile will automatically  
start scanning the document  
into memory (if enabled). While  
scanning, the facsimile dials,  
connects, and starts transmis-  
sion.  
or  
+
Then, press  
to display  
ABB. NBR=  
LONDON OFFICE  
002  
the screen for names beginning  
with “L.”  
Displayed for 2 seconds  
ENTER SEARCH NAME:  
L.A. OFFICE  
SCANNING TO MEMORY  
FILE NBR = 091  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 99%  
SCANNING PAGE : XXX  
[]  
00001/00003  
NOTE:  
During scan to memory  
More than one character can  
be entered for search.  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 99%  
During transmission  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keypad Dialing  
If you have not preset the tele-  
phone number of the destination  
facsimile to an Abbreviated Dial  
Number or One Touch key, you  
can dial your destination by en-  
tering the number from the Dial  
Keypad.  
Enter the Facsimile  
Number  
Press the START  
Key  
1
2
Enter the facsimile number of  
the desired party.  
When the correct number is dis-  
played, press:  
The document must be loaded  
and the resolution and contrast  
set before a transmission using  
Keypad Dialing. (See page 89.)  
Your facsimile will automatically  
start scanning the document  
into memory (if enabled). While  
scanning, the facsimile will dials,  
connects, and starts transmis-  
sion.  
NOTE:  
When an incorrect number is  
SCANNING TO MEMORY  
FILE NBR =  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 99%  
093  
entered, use  
to delete  
preceding digits, or press  
During scan to memory  
once to start over  
from the beginning.  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 99%  
Example with 012345678 en-  
tered:  
During transmission  
COMM. RESERVATION  
TEL NUMBER =(MAX128)  
012345678  
100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- TRANSMITTING  
Memory Transmission  
A Memory Transmission first scans and stores the document into memory prior to a  
transmission to a remote facsimile(s).  
File Number and Residual Memory  
FILE NUMBERS  
The facsimile assigns a File Number to each transmission or polling-reception  
job for internal control of reserved communications.  
Memory Transmission is automatically initiated with any of the following dialing meth-  
ods.  
This File Number is very useful should it become necessary to cancel  
a
• One Touch Dialing  
• Abbreviated Dialing  
• Alphabet Dialing  
• Keypad Dialing  
(See page 97)  
(See page 98)  
(See page 99)  
(See page 100)  
memory operation. It is also useful when tracking communication activities  
using the transmission and reception journals (see page 205).  
RESIDUAL MEMORY  
The amount of memory remaining for memory transmission usage is called  
Residual Memory and is displayed as a percentage value.  
You may reserve a transmission even when other Memory Communications are  
under way.  
In effort to minimize Memory Full conditions, this facsimile is equipped with  
TOSHIBA’s Memory Release. Once scanning a document is started, the facsimile will  
dial, connect and start transmission to the remote location. In the event the Memory  
becomes full, Memory Release will hold originals in the ADF until the pages already  
stored into memory are successfully transmitted. As each page is successfully trans-  
mitted, the Memory for subsequent pages will be released and the next page is  
scanned.  
File Number and Residual Memory Display Example:  
SCANNING INTO MEMORY  
File No.  
FILE NBR =  
123  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 70%  
Residual Memory  
If a connection is not established during the scanning procedure, Memory Release will  
be disabled (see NOTES).  
NOTES:  
To bypass Memory Transmission, see page 103 on Direct Document Transmission.  
1. If there is not enough Residual Memory or the MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
Job queue it at full capacity, a Memory Full  
MEMORY OVERFLOW  
status may occur. If this occurs during scanning  
a document for transmission, the facsimile dis-  
plays MEMORY OVERFLOW.  
2. If this message is displayed, press  
to cancel the Memory Transmission.  
The Memory Overflow message will be reset and the document will be ejected.  
3. Wait until memory becomes available (i.e., after some reserved jobs are com-  
pleted), and retry the job later or use a Direct Document Transmission (see  
page 103).  
4. A maximum of 100 transmissions can be reserved for Memory Transmissions  
(including Polling Reception reservations and mailboxes). Any transmission at-  
tempted thereafter will result in a direct transmission from the ADF.  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Memory Transmission - continued  
Memory Transmission Procedure  
Load the Document  
Dial the Facsimile  
Number  
Start Scanning  
Return to the  
Standby Mode  
1
2
3
4
Load the document face down  
in the Document Tray (see page  
88).  
The facsimile starts scanning  
and storing the document into  
memory.  
Dial the facsimile number of the  
remote party using any of the  
four dialing methods.  
When the document scanning is  
complete, the facsimile returns  
to the Standby Mode.  
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
A File Number is assigned.  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 97%  
Residual Memory will decrease  
as the document is scanned.  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
Press  
to cancel the  
transmission operation.  
SCANNING INTO MEMORY  
Press  
if a dialing er-  
FILE NBR =  
108  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 97%  
ror occurs.  
Example of screen displayed  
while a number is entered by  
Keypad Dialing:  
COMM. RESERVATION  
TEL NUMBER =(MAX128)  
0559761234  
102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Transmission  
Direct Transmission is used if  
there is not enough residual  
memory or when a large num-  
ber of document pages are to  
be sent, etc.  
Direct Transmission as Default Setting  
Load the Document  
Dial the Facsimile  
Number  
Start Dialing  
Connect the Line to  
the Remote Party  
1
2
3
4
This mode is also useful if the  
operator wishes to visually con-  
firm the actual transmission of  
the document to the remote par-  
ty.  
This procedure will discuss Di-  
rect Transmission when se-  
lected as the default setting or  
when Residual Memory has  
been depleted.  
Once the facsimile number is  
entered, the dialing starts.  
Once connected to the destina-  
tion facsimile, the screen below  
is displayed.  
Dial the facsimile number of the  
remote party using any of the  
four dialing methods.  
The documents will remain in  
the ADF and be transmitted one  
by one.  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
DIALING  
FILE NBR =  
COMMUNICATING  
025  
FILE NBR =  
025  
Load the document face down  
in the Document Tray (see  
page 88).  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
0559761234  
0559761234  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
The remote party Terminal ID  
will be displayed as shown be-  
low.  
If the destination facsimile is  
busy, the screen below is dis-  
played.  
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
WAITING TO REDIAL  
COMMUNICATING  
FILE NBR =  
025  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
Press  
if a dialing er-  
+81 559 761234  
ror occurs.  
Example of screen displayed  
when Residual Memory has  
been depleted:  
If the redial procedure is com-  
pleted without success, the  
screen below is displayed and  
this transmission job is can-  
celled.  
Example of screen displayed  
while a number is entered using  
Keypad Dialing:  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
COMM. RESERVATION  
MAY-17-00 WED11:59  
LINE BUSY  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 0%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
TEL NUMBER =(MAX128)  
0559761234  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Transmission - continued  
Direct Transmission as Default Setting - continued  
Send the Document  
Complete the  
Transmission  
5
6
The transmission starts as the  
document is scanned.  
When the communication is  
complete, LINE lamp turns off  
and the facsimile returns to the  
Standby Mode.  
The page number being sent is  
displayed on the 1st row.  
The type of communication and  
transmission speed is displayed  
on the 3rd row.  
MAY-17-00 WED11:54  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
TRANSMIT P001  
FILE NBR =  
025  
EX 14400BPS  
+81 559 761234  
104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Transmission - continued  
Temporary Direct Transmission  
Even if the Memory Transmis-  
sion Mode is selected as the de-  
fault, you may desire to transmit  
Load the Document  
Change the  
Transmission Mode  
Select YES  
Dial the Facsimile  
Number  
1
2
3
4
a
specific document directly  
from the Automatic Document  
Feeder.  
Load the document face down  
in the Document Tray (see page  
88).  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
Select “1. YES” by pressing:  
Dial the facsimile number of the  
remote party using any of the  
four dialing methods.  
This is useful when the docu-  
ment consists of many pages or  
when the residual memory is too  
small to store the document  
data.  
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
Press:  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
DIRECT TRANSMIT  
1.YES  
2.NO  
COMM. RESERVATION  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Transmission - continued  
On-hook Transmission (Monitor Speaker Dialing)  
You can send your documents  
Load the Document  
Press the MONITOR  
Key  
Dial the Facsimile  
Number  
Press the START  
Key  
with On-hook Dialing using the  
monitor speaker to confirm the  
answering tone from the remote  
party’s facsimile.  
1
2
3
4
Load the document face down  
in the Document Tray (see page  
88).  
Press:  
Dial the facsimile number of the  
remote party using any of the  
four dialing methods.  
When you hear the answering  
tone, press  
. If  
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
The facsimile is connected to  
the telephone line and the dial  
tone is heard through the speak-  
er.  
an operator answers the phone,  
pick up the handset (if  
equipped) and inform the re-  
mote party that you wish to send  
a document.  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
ON HOOK  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
Upon hearing the facsimile tone,  
press:  
TEL NUMBER=  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
NOTE:  
If an incorrect number is di-  
When the transmission is com-  
pleted, the facsimile returns to  
the Standby Mode.  
aled, press  
and fol-  
low the instruction displayed  
on the LCD display to start  
the operation over.  
MAY-17-00 WED11:54  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
Example of screen displayed  
while a number is entered using  
Keypad Dialing:  
ON HOOK  
TEL NUMBER=  
0559761234  
106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Transmission - continued  
Off-hook Transmission (Optional Handset Dialing)  
This procedure may be useful  
when you want to talk with a  
remote party using the optional  
handset of the facsimile before  
Load the Document  
Pick Up the Handset  
(Optional)  
Dial the Facsimile Number  
1
2
3
sending a document.  
Load the document face down  
in the Document Tray (see  
page 88).  
Pick up the handset of the fac-  
simile.  
Dial the facsimile number of the Example of screen displayed  
remote party using any of the while a number is entered using  
four dialing methods.  
Keypad Dialing:  
The unit is connected to the  
telephone line and you hear the  
dial tone through the speaker of  
the handset.  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
OFF HOOK  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
TEL NUMBER=  
0559761234  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
OFF HOOK  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
TEL NUMBER=  
NOTES:  
To use the Keypad Dial-  
ing procedure on page  
84, do not press the final  
in this step.  
If an incorrect number is  
dialed, press  
and  
follow the instruction dis-  
played on the LCD dis-  
play to start the operation  
over.  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Transmission - continued  
Off-hook Transmission (Optional Handset Dialing) - continued  
Press the START  
Key  
4
When you hear the answering  
tone, press  
. If  
the remote party answers the  
phone, you can inform the re-  
mote party that you wish to send  
a document.  
Upon hearing the facsimile tone,  
press:  
Then replace the handset.  
When the transmission is com-  
pleted, the facsimile returns to  
the Standby Mode.  
MAY-17-00 WED11:54  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Transmission - continued  
External Off-hook Transmission (Transmission Using an External Telephone)  
This procedure may be useful  
Load the Document  
Pick Up the Handset of  
the External Telephone  
Dial on the External  
Telephone  
Press The START  
Key  
when you want to talk with a re-  
mote party before sending a  
document. A telephone set must  
be connected to the “TEL” con-  
nector. (This telephone set is  
called the “External Telephone”  
in this manual.)  
1
2
3
4
Load the document face down  
in the Document Tray (see  
page 88).  
Dial the facsimile number of the  
remote party using the keypad  
of the External Telephone.  
When you hear the answering  
Pick up the handset of the Ex-  
ternal Telephone connected to  
the “TEL” connector of the fac-  
simile.  
tone, press  
on  
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
The entered number is immedi-  
ately dialed. The number is not  
displayed on the facsimile’s  
LCD display.  
The External Telephone is con-  
nected to the telephone line via  
the facsimile, and the dial tone  
is heard through the speaker of  
the External Telephone.  
the facsimile. If the remote  
party answers the phone, you  
can inform the remote party that  
you wish to send a document.  
NOTE:  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
When the External Tele-  
phone is in the off-hook sta-  
tus (i.e. while “EXTERNAL  
OFF HOOK” is displayed),  
the Dial Keypad on the fac-  
simile does not accept any  
key entry.  
Upon hearing the facsimile  
tone, press:  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
The display on the facsimile  
shows  
“EXTERNAL  
OFF  
HOOK” on the top row of the  
LCD display.  
EXTERNAL OFF HOOK  
Then replace the handset of the  
External Telephone.  
When the transmission is com-  
pleted, the facsimile returns to  
the Standby Mode.  
MAY-17-00 WED11:54  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Redialing  
Automatic Redialing  
Manual Redialing Direct Transmission  
When the line of the remote  
party is busy, the facsimile will  
automatically redial the remote  
party up to the set number of  
times with intervals of the set  
length (see page 67).  
This function enables you to re-  
Press the MONITOR  
Key  
Press the REDIAL  
Key  
Redial the Remote  
Party  
dial the number last dialed us-  
ing this facsimile to transmit a  
document.  
1
2
3
Press:  
To enter the On-hook Dialing  
(Monitor Speaker Dialing) mode,  
press:  
When you hear the answering  
WARNING:  
If the line is not connected after  
the set number of redialing at-  
tempts, the facsimile will record  
a LINE BUSY error.  
tone, press  
. If  
If you press  
, the fac-  
The last number dialed is dis-  
played. The display varies de-  
pending on the dialing method  
used.  
the remote party answers the  
phone, pick up the handset (op-  
tional). Inform the remote party  
that you wish to send a docu-  
ment.  
simile will clear the facsimile  
number registered and lose  
the manual redial capability.  
Confirm the facsimile number of  
the remote party and repeat the  
transmission procedure.  
ON HOOK  
TEL NUMBER=  
The displayed number is imme-  
diately redialed.  
NOTE:  
Upon hearing the facsimile  
tone, press:  
This feature will not function  
with numbers dialed using  
an external telephone.  
ON HOOK  
TEL NUMBER=  
0559761234  
When the transmission is com-  
pleted, the facsimile returns to  
the Standby Mode.  
If no number is registered as a  
redial number, the screen below  
is displayed for 2 seconds, then  
returns to Step 1.  
ON HOOK  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
NUMBER NOT LISTED  
110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Redialing - continued  
Manual Redialing Jobs in Memory  
This function enables you to  
Press the REDIAL  
Key  
Select the Job to be Redialed  
Start Redialing  
transmit a document after select-  
ing it from the jobs reserved in  
memory waiting to be redialed.  
1
2
3
Press:  
Wait 5 seconds or press any  
key on the Operation Panel ex-  
When the desired job is dis-  
played, press:  
NOTE:  
If you are using Department  
Codes, the initiating Depart-  
ment Code must match for  
this operation to work.  
SINGLE TRANSMIT  
L.A. OFFICE  
MAY-17-00 13:53  
FILE NBR =121  
cept  
to display the  
REDIAL  
[ENTER]:START  
screen on the right.  
Screen Index:  
[ ]:PREVIOUS SCREEN  
The facsimile starts to dial the  
number for a transmission.  
[ ]:NEXT SCREEN  
MAY-17-00 WED14:05  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 75%  
SINGLE TRANSMIT  
SEATTLE FACTORY  
MAY-17-00 13:56  
FILE NBR =123  
1st line ... Type of job  
If there are no jobs to be  
redialed, the screen below is  
2nd line ... Destination of  
redialing  
displayed for  
2
seconds,  
3rd line ... Date & Time of  
job accepted  
then the facsimile returns to  
the Standby Mode.  
4th line ... File Number  
REDIAL  
SINGLE TRANSMIT  
L.A. OFFICE  
MAY-17-00 14:03  
FILE NBR =124  
Locate the screen of the desired  
job using the following scroll  
keys.  
NUMBER NOT LISTED  
(for the previous screen)  
(for the next screen)  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- RECEIVING  
Automatic  
Manual  
Selecting the  
Receiving Mode  
Receiving Mode  
Receiving Mode  
“Auto Reception” is the ability of “Manual Reception” allows you The Automatic Receiving Mode  
the facsimile to receive docu- to use the facsimile as a tele- (AUTO RECEIVE) is normally  
ments sent to your facsimile au- phone (talking function) first and selected. You can change the  
tomatically.  
then start a document reception receiving mode from Automatic  
by pressing:  
to Manual, or vice versa.  
The facsimile starts to receive a  
document after a pre-selected  
number of rings. You can  
change the ringer count (see  
page 68).  
Refer to Receive Mode Selec-  
tion on page 68.  
1. When the facsimile rings,  
pick up the optional handset  
and talk with the remote  
party.  
NOTE:  
A ring delay can be selected  
should you wish to speak to  
the calling party before re-  
ceiving a facsimile.  
If you do not pick up the  
handset within the selected  
delay period, the facsimile  
will automatically answer the  
call and attempt to receive a  
document.  
2. If you hear the facsimile tone  
through the handset instead  
of operator’s voice, you may  
manually initiate a facsimile  
reception by pressing:  
3. Replace the handset to the  
cradle. The facsimile will  
start receiving the document.  
112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording Paper Size  
Reception Reduction Setting  
This facsimile can use Letter and Legal size paper. The received  
document is recorded (printed) within the Effective Recording Area  
of the paper.  
This function allows the reduc-  
Display the SET RX  
REDUCTION Menu  
Select the Desired  
Option  
1
2
tion of the received image, if  
the received document is  
larger than the recording pa-  
per.  
Paper Size  
Letter: mm 216 210 271 279  
11.0  
A
B
C
D
Press:  
Select the desired option.  
Effective  
Recording  
Area  
To set RX Reduction to ON,  
press:  
D
C
inches 8.5 8.3 10.6  
Legal: mm 216 210 348 356  
inches 8.5  
14.0  
+
+
+
+
8.3 13.7  
B
A
To set RX Reduction to OFF,  
press:  
NOTES:  
If the received document is equal to or shorter than the re-  
cording area of the paper, the received document is printed at  
its actual size.  
If the received document is larger than the recording area of  
the paper, it will be vertically reduced to fit on the recording  
paper installed. The reception will be divided onto two sheets  
if the document needs to be reduced to smaller than 73% of  
its original size.  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
Document  
Recording Paper  
RX REDUCTION  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
If you desire to receive large originals without reduction or  
excessive paper usage, set the ”DISCARD” function to “ON.”  
If the lower part of the original exceeds the recording paper  
by 13 mm or less, the image will be automatically discarded.  
This predetermined dimension is a service function setting.  
Contact your Toshiba dealer for the setup.  
If the “RX REDUCTION” function is “OFF”, the larger original  
will be recorded on two or more sheets. The top of the sec-  
ond page will repeat about 5mm of the lower part of the first  
page.  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reception Discard Setting  
This function allows up to 13  
Display the  
DISCARD Menu  
Select the Desired  
Option  
mm* of the lower portion of the  
document to be discarded, if the  
document is larger than the re-  
cording paper.  
1
2
Press:  
Select the desired option.  
*
To change this dimension,  
contact your service repre-  
sentative.  
To set the DISCARD function to  
ON, press:  
+
+
+
+
To set the DISCARD function to  
OFF, press:  
DISCARD  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reverse Order Printing Setting  
This function receives the entire  
Display the  
Select the Desired  
Option  
facsimile document into memory  
and then prints the document in  
reverse order. In this way, the  
pages of the document will be in  
correct order.  
1
2
REVERSE ORDER  
PRINT Menu  
Press:  
Select the desired option.  
To set REVERSE ORDER  
PRINT to ON, Press:  
+
+
+
+
To set REVERSE ORDER  
PRINT to OFF, press:  
REVERSE ORDER PRINT  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reception Multicopy Setting  
The DP120F/DP125F can print  
multiple copies of the same re-  
ceived document automatically.  
Display the RX  
MULTI COPY Menu  
Select the Desired  
Number of Copies  
1
2
You may select REVERSE OR-  
DER PRINT to collate the re-  
ceived document.  
Press:  
Enter the desired number of  
copies to be printed (01 to 99).  
+
+
+
+
Press:  
RX MULTI COPY  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
COPY NUMBER=(01-99)  
01  
116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- TELEPHONE HANDSET OPERATION (Optional)  
If the optional handset is in-  
stalled, you can make a tele-  
On-hook Dialing  
phone call using your DP120F/  
Press the MONITOR  
Key  
Dial the Remote  
Party  
Pick Up the Handset  
Replace the Handset  
DP125F just like an ordinary  
telephone.  
1
2
3
4
Without loading any document  
on the Document Tray, press:  
Enter the telephone number of Pick up the handset to talk.  
the remote party using any of  
When you finish talking, return  
the handset to the handset  
cradle.  
NOTE:  
the following dialing methods.  
If you do not pick up the  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
handset within 1 minute after  
dialing, the line will be auto-  
matically disconnected.  
The display returns to the  
Standby Mode.  
The message “ON HOOK” is  
displayed, and you hear the dial  
tone through the speaker.  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tone Output  
Redialing  
This function is for utilizing vari- When the number you dialed is  
ous information services via the busy, or you want to redial the  
Press the MONITOR  
or Pick Up the  
Handset  
Press The REDIAL  
Key  
1
2
telephone.  
last number you dialed, you can  
recall the last number dialed us-  
Even when the dial type of your  
facsimile is set to DP (Dial  
Pulse) type, the facsimile can  
generate a TONE signal to ac-  
cess information services such  
as facsimile on-demand sys-  
tems, voice menus, etc.  
Pick up the optional telephone Press:  
handset or press:  
ing  
.
To use redialing with voice call-  
ing, you must press or  
The last-dialed number or ID  
name is displayed and redialing  
starts immediately.  
You hear the dial tone through  
the speaker or the handset.  
pick up the optional handset of  
the facsimile first.  
Once on line, generating the  
TONE signal can be accom-  
plished by pressing:  
ON HOOK  
ON HOOK  
NOTE:  
To prevent others from  
redialing your call, press  
TEL NUMBER=  
TEL NUMBER=  
0559761234  
NOTE:  
while in the on-hook  
From the moment  
is  
or off-hook status. This will  
clear the phone number reg-  
ister.  
pressed until the end of that  
transaction or until you press  
again, the touch-  
tone (MF) signals will be  
transmitted when you press  
any key on the Dial Keypad.  
118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- COMMUNICATION STATUS  
Current Job Status  
The job being processed can be  
monitored via the LCD. You can  
cancel the job if necessary.  
Continue or Cancel  
the Job  
Press the JOB STATUS Key  
Select YES or NO  
2
1
3
NOTES:  
In the Standby Mode, press:  
Remote Station ID  
Station ID returned from the re- in Step 1 displayed, you can ei-  
ceiving station (if provided)  
With the Line 1 or Line 2 status Press one of the following keys.  
When no communication  
job is being processed,  
only the number of re-  
served jobs is displayed  
as below.  
To cancel the job, press:  
ther continue or cancel the job.  
To continue, wait for the fac-  
simile to return to the Standby  
The following screen shows an  
example of the Pending Jobs  
display status when the phone  
line is in use:  
The status of the line in use is  
displayed. (If Line 2 is in use in-  
stead of Line 1, the Line 2 sta-  
tus is displayed in the same for-  
mat).  
To continue without cancelling  
the job, press:  
PENDING JOBS=  
x
Mode or press  
.
NOTE:  
While the screen above is  
Whenever  
is pressed,  
To cancel and erase the dis-  
played job, press:  
CANCEL JOB TO CANCEL  
LINE 1 TRANSMIT P005  
FILE NBR =999  
G3 14400BPS  
the status of the phone line and  
Pending Jobs will be displayed.  
When no jobs are re-  
served or being pro-  
cessed, the screen below  
is displayed for 2 sec-  
onds.  
TRANSMIT  
A fax transmission is under way.  
+81 425 85 3002  
RECEIVE  
A fax reception is under way.  
CANCEL ?  
FILE NBR =999  
1.YES  
displayed, pressing  
again will display the Pending  
Jobs screen.  
Pxxx  
2.NO  
Page Number of the file being  
processed  
NO ENTRY  
Pressing  
PENDING JOBS=  
can cancel  
FILE NBR  
File Number assigned to this job  
x
JOB STATUS TO VIEW  
JOB CANCEL TO CANCEL  
G3  
Communication Mode that is be-  
ing used:  
G3 = Standard Group 3  
EC = Error Correction Mode  
EX = ECM with shortened  
protocol  
the Pending Job.  
See page 121.  
xxxxxBPS  
Communication speed  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Display & Print Transmission Report  
Communication  
Journal  
You can display the last 150  
A Communication Journal (or  
Transmission Journal and Re-  
ception Journal separately) can  
be issued to confirm 150 trans-  
missions and 150 receptions.  
Display the PREVIEW  
Select the Job  
Printing a Job  
Status  
transmissions on the LCD.  
You can also print out the report  
of the displayed job.  
1
2
3
TX REPORT Menu  
With the Standby Mode screen The last transmission job is dis- If you want to print a report of  
displayed, select the direct func- played as in the screen below. the displayed job, press:  
tion access view on the opera- Use your  
With the Standby Mode screen  
displayed, select the “50-73”  
view on the Flip Panels.  
tion panel.  
or  
Press:  
Press:  
keys to scroll to the desired job.  
The facsimile prints a TRANS-  
MISSION REPORT.  
A communication journal is is-  
sued. (See page 195.)  
PREVIEW TX REPORT  
MAY-17-00 WED12:43  
[COPY]:PRINT REPORT  
Previous Job Report  
Screen  
[ ]:PREVIOUS SCREEN  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 80%  
PRINTING LIST  
[ ]:NEXT SCREEN  
FILE NBR =123  
REDFIELD EX  
MAY-29 23:25  
OK xx  
Next Job Report  
Screen  
120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- CANCELLING A COMMUNICATION JOB  
Cancelling a Direct Transmission  
Cancelling a Job Reservation  
Reserved jobs can be cancelled  
A Document is  
Being Transmitted  
Press the STOP Key  
Select the Desired  
Option  
Display the JOB  
CANCEL Menu  
while they remain in memory.  
The following 5 types of jobs  
can be cancelled using this pro-  
cedure.  
1
2
3
1
A screen such as the one below  
is displayed while a document  
is being transmitted in the Di-  
rect Transmission Mode.  
Press:  
Select the desired option.  
In the Standby Mode, press:  
To cancel the transmission,  
press:  
1. TRANSMIT  
2. RECEIVE  
3. POLLING  
4. POLLING RESERVE  
5. JOB NUMBER  
The following screen is dis-  
played with the first three items  
(1 to 3) indicated.  
TRANSMIT P001  
FILE NBR =001  
EX 14400BPS  
+81425867449  
CANCEL ?  
1.+81123456789  
2.NO  
To continue the transmission,  
press:  
JOB CANCEL  
1.TRANSMIT  
2.RECEIVE  
3.POLLING  
4.POLLING RESERVE  
5.JOB NUMBER  
NOTE:  
The types of jobs displayed  
within the Job Cancel screen  
will vary depending upon the  
actual job types currently in  
use.  
If a job type is not currently  
active, it will not appear on  
the LCD screen.  
Items 4 to 5 are outside the LCD  
frame. Use the  
to display and highlight  
the desired item.  
or  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cancelling a Job Reservation - continued  
Select the Job Type  
Cancel a Reception  
Enter JOB NUMBER  
Cancel Other Jobs  
Press the ENTER to  
Cancel the Job  
2
3
4
5
6
Select the desired job type.  
To cancel a reception, use the Enter the job number you want  
following keys to select the tele- to cancel.  
phone line to stop the reception.  
When the desired job screen is  
displayed, press:  
JOB CANCEL  
[ENTER]:CANCEL  
[ ]:PREVIOUS SCREEN  
[ ]:NEXT SCREEN  
or  
A screen like the one below is  
displayed.  
Display the status of the desired  
Go to Step 6.  
job by using  
.
and/or  
CANCEL ?  
NOTE:  
FILE NBR =  
1.YES  
xxx  
If Line 2 is also in use for  
receiving, the Line 2 status  
is also displayed by pressing  
Go to Step 6.  
The operation and screen to fol-  
low varies for each item number  
selected.  
2.NO  
To confirm deletion, press:  
.
JOB NUMBER=  
The two screens are alter-  
If you selected 2.RECEIVE, go  
Previous Job in the List  
to Step 3.  
nated by pressing  
.
or  
XXX  
If you selected 5.JOB NUM-  
BER, go to Step 4.  
To not cancel the selection,  
press:  
Go to Step 6.  
If you selected:  
SINGLE TRANSMIT  
REDFIELD EX  
MAY-29 23:25  
FILE NBR =  
LINE-1 RECEIVE  
+81 425 86 7449  
1. TRANSMIT  
3. POLLING  
4. POLLING RESERVE  
123  
JOB CANCELLED  
FILE NBR =  
xxx  
Go to Step 5.  
LINE-2 RECEIVE  
Next Job in the List  
122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADVANCED FUNCTIONS - MULTI-ADDRESS TRANSMISSION (BROADCASTING)  
Group Broadcast Transmission  
The Group Broadcast Transmis-  
Load the Document  
Select the Group  
Location  
Enter the Group  
Number  
Press the START  
Key  
sion feature allows you to send  
a document to multiple remote  
parties in a single operation.  
1
2
3
4
Load the document face down  
in the Document Tray (see page  
88).  
Press the One Touch Key pro- Enter the Multi-address Trans-  
When the correct Group Num-  
ber is displayed, press:  
Note that a Group Broadcast  
Transmission requires all pages  
to be scanned to memory prior  
to dialing, and thus adequate re-  
sidual memory is required.  
grammed for the desired group.  
mission Group Number (1 to  
1999).  
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
EXAMPLE:  
To enter the Group Number  
0001, press:  
COMM. RESERVATION  
NOTE:  
ONE TOUCH =  
COLORADO GRP  
35  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
If the optional handset is in-  
stalled, the handset dialing is  
not available.  
COMM. RESERVATION  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
After 2 seconds:  
GROUP NBR =  
COLORADO GRP  
0001  
(Leading zeros, if any, may  
be omitted.)  
SCANNING INTO MEMORY  
FILE NBR = xxx  
After 2 seconds:  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 70%  
NOTE:  
SCANNING INTO MEMORY  
FILE NBR = xxx  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 70%  
When an incorrect number  
When document scan-  
ning is completed:  
is entered, use  
to de-  
When document scan-  
ning is completed:  
Standby Mode screen  
lete the preceding digits, or  
Or, display the Group Dial Di-  
rectory by pressing:  
Standby Mode screen  
press  
once to start  
ABB  
DIRECTORY  
GROUP  
over from the beginning.  
+
COMM. RESERVATION  
GROUP NBR =(1-1999)  
1
COMM. RESERVATION  
GROUP NBR =(1-1999)  
Go to Step 3.  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Multi-Key Quick Broadcast Transmission  
The Multi-Key Quick Broadcast  
Transmission allows documents  
to be sent to a combination of  
the following numbers without  
pre-programming a group.  
Load the Document  
Press the MULTI  
Key  
Enter the Facsimile Number  
1
2
3
Enter the facsimile number of  
the remote party using any of  
the four dialing methods.  
Load the document face down Press:  
in the Document Tray (see page  
88).  
Repeat this step until the fac-  
simile numbers of all the desired  
remote parties are entered.  
Abbreviated Dial Numbers  
One Touch Dial Keys  
Alphabet Dialed Numbers  
Keypad Dialed Numbers  
When the facsimile numbers of  
all the desired remote parties  
are entered, go to Step 5.  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
To cancel or modify the fac-  
simile number already being  
programmed to a Manual Group  
Dial, go to Step 4.  
MULTI GROUP  
000  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
ENTER TEL NUMBER,  
SPEED DIAL KEY OR  
ONE TOUCH KEY  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
A screen like the one below is  
displayed.  
MULTI GROUP  
ABB NBR=  
000  
154  
INFORMATION BUREAU  
After 2 seconds:  
MULTI GROUP  
001  
[] TO PREVIOUS  
ENTER MORE OR  
PRESS [START]  
NOTE:  
If you select the same entry  
twice, you are prompted to  
delete or retain that second  
entry.  
124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Multi-Key Quick Broadcast Transmission - continued  
Press the START  
Key  
Select the CANCEL or MODIFY Facsimile Number  
5
4
You can cancel or modify the  
Manual Group Dial Number reg-  
istered in this facsimile.  
Press:  
4c  
4a  
4b  
Retain the Existing  
Number  
Cancel the Existing  
Number  
Modify the Existing  
Number  
Select the number you want to  
To cancel the existing number, To modify the existing number, To retain the existing number,  
press: press: press:  
delete or modify using  
or  
, and press:  
READING INTO MEMORY  
FILE NBR = xxx  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 70%  
(to CANCEL)  
(to MODIFY)  
(to RETAIN)  
When document scan-  
ning is completed:  
MULTI GROUP  
MULTI GROUP  
001  
MULTI GROUP  
001  
MULTI GROUP  
1.CANCEL  
2.MODIFY  
3.RETAIN  
[] TO PREVIOUS  
ENTER MORE  
OR PRESS START  
[] TO PREVIOUS  
ENTER MORE  
OR PRESS START  
Standby Mode screen  
ABB NBR=  
DELETED  
154  
To select “1.CANCEL,” go to  
Step 4a.  
Return to Step 3.  
Go to Step 3 for the Facsimile Return to Step 3.  
Number entry.  
To select “2.MODIFY,” go to  
Step 4b.  
To select “3.RETAIN,” go to  
Step 4c.  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- RELAY TRANSMISSION  
Relay Transmission, Relay-Relay Transmission Overview  
To perform Relay Transmissions or Relay-Relay Transmissions, you must build a  
network beforehand.  
What is a “Relay Transmission”?  
A relay transmission is used to send documents from your facsimile (originator)  
to a Hub Station, which then sends them to additional end stations. If you have  
several stations in one or more regional areas (e.g. Los Angeles Metro, New  
York City, Dallas-Ft. Worth, Seattle-Tacoma, etc.); you can save time and phone  
charges by setting up a relay system. By sending your document to a Hub  
Station, you can then instruct the Hub Station to retransmit the document to the  
end stations in their local geographical area.  
Consult your authorized TOSHIBA dealer for assistance in using this function.  
Conditions for a Relay/Relay-Relay Transmission Network  
1. The sending station must be a TOSHIBA DP120F/DP125F/DP80F/DP85F fac-  
simile or another ITU-T relay communication compatible facsimile unit.  
2. The Hub Station must be a TOSHIBA DP120F/DP125F facsimile or another  
ITU-T relay communication compatible facsimile unit with the Hub Station func-  
tions.  
End Station Group  
(stations to finally re-  
ceive the document)  
Hub  
Station  
Originator  
Station  
3. The relay station must program the end station telephone numbers to Abbrevi-  
ated Dial numbers or One Touch keys or Group numbers. Up to 50 abbreviated  
dial numbers or one touch keys or groups can be programmed. For information  
on setting Relay Box, see page 127.  
End Station  
4. Due to advanced planning and setup requirements for the Relay-Relay trans-  
missions involving two or more Hub Stations transfers, contact your authorized  
TOSHIBA dealer for detailed instructions.  
What is a “Relay-Relay Transmission”?  
A Relay Transmission where two levels of Hub Stations are involved is called a  
Relay-Relay Transmission. In a Relay-Relay Transmission, the first Hub Station  
sends the document to another Hub Station(s) which then transmits them to  
additional end stations.  
How to Setup a Relay Transmission:  
• Hub Station  
Create a Relay Box within a hub unit (like the DP120F/DP125F) by following the  
procedures beginning on page 127.  
End Station Group  
(stations to finally re-  
ceive the document)  
NOTE: A Relay Box must be established for every possible unit if you wish to  
obtain a result report after the relay is completed.  
Second  
Hub Station  
End Station  
• Originator  
Hub  
Station  
Originator  
Station  
Transmit a document to the hub unit from an ITU-T relay compatible remote  
facsimile (like the DP120F/DP125F) with the procedures beginning on page 134.  
End Station  
End Station  
Second  
Hub Station  
126  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Relay Transmission, Relay-Relay Transmission Overview  
-
Setting Up a Relay Box  
continued  
This section describes the pro-  
How to Setup a Relay-Relay Transmission:  
Display the MAILBOX  
Menu  
Select SETUP &  
DELETE  
cedures to setup a Relay Box in  
1
2
• Hub Station  
the DP120F/DP125F hub unit.  
Using this function, all ITU-T F-  
code compliant facsimiles can  
1. Register the facsimile telephone number of the Second  
Hub Station to a One Touch key or Abbreviated Number,  
see pages 70 and 77 At this time, the Relay Box Number  
located in the Second Hub Station should be registered as  
the SUB Address of the One Touch key or Abbreviated  
Number.  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
Select “4.BOX SETUP” by  
pressing:  
receive or transmit documents  
to and from the DP120F/  
DP125F. Relay Boxes must be  
setup prior to utilizing the  
DP120F/DP125F as a Relay  
Box Hub. For more information,  
see page 126.  
Press:  
2. Create a Relay Box in the Hub Station, see “Setting Up a  
Relay Box.” Register the One Touch key or Abbreviated  
Number programmed in Step 1 to the Relay Box as the  
Second Hub Station.  
You can assign a maximum of  
50 End Stations using Addrevi-  
ated Dial Numbers, One Touch  
Keys, or Group Numbers.  
MAILBOX  
SETUP MAILBOX  
1.COMPLETE  
2.BOX SETUP  
3.BOX DELETE  
• Second Hub Station  
1.CONFIDENTIAL  
2.BULLETIN BOARD  
3.RELAY  
1. Register the facsimile telephone number of the End Sta-  
tion to a One Touch key or Abbreviated Number, see  
pages 76 and 77.  
4.BOX SETUP  
2. Create a Relay Box in the Second Hub Station, see “Set-  
ting Up a Relay Box.” Register the One Touch key or  
Abbreviated Number programmed in Step 1 to the Relay  
Box as the End Station.  
• Originator  
Transmit a document to the hub unit from an ITU-T relay  
compatible remote facsimile (like the DP120F/DP125F) with  
the procedures beginning on page 134.  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up a Relay Box - continued  
Select BOX SETUP  
Select the RELAY  
Enter the Box  
Number  
Select the Password  
Option  
Enter the Password  
3
4
5
6
7
Select “3.RELAY” by pressing:  
Enter the Relay Box number  
(max. 20 digits).  
Select whether or not to use the Enter the password (max. 20  
password option for this relay digits).  
box.  
Select “2.BOX SETUP” by  
pressing:  
To set the password option for  
this relay box, press:  
TYPE OF BOX  
ENTER NEW BOX NBR  
1.CONFIDENTIAL TYPE  
2.BULLETIN BRD TYPE  
3.RELAY  
BOX NUMBER =(MAX20)  
Go to Step 7.  
If you do not wish to set the  
password option with this relay  
box, press:  
Then press:  
ENTER PASSWORD  
PASSWORD =(MAX20)  
XXXXX  
Then press:  
Go to Step 8.  
PROGRAM PASSWORD?  
RELAY END NUMBER  
1.YES  
2.NO  
PRESS SPEED DIAL KEY  
OR ONE TOUCH KEY  
128  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up a Relay Box - continued  
Enter the End Station  
8
Repeat this step until all of the  
required end station are en-  
tered. Then go to Step 9.  
8a  
8b  
Enter the Abbreviated Dial Number of End Station  
Enter the One Touch  
Key of End Station  
8c  
Enter the Group  
Number of End Station  
If an end station is assigned to a If an end station is assigned to  
Then press:  
If an end station is assigned to  
a Group Number, press:  
One Touch Key, press:  
an Abbreviated Dial Number,  
press:  
Example: One Touch Key 35.  
RELAY END NUMBER  
+
+
ABB. NUMBER=  
XXXXXXXX  
XXX  
RELAY END NUMBER  
After 2 seconds:  
Enter the Group Number.  
Enter the Abbreviated Dial  
Number.  
ONE TOUCH =  
XXXXXX  
35  
RELAY END NUMBER  
After 2 seconds:  
ABB. NUMBER=  
ENTER MORE OR  
PRESS [START]  
XXX  
RELAY END NUMBER  
ONE TOUCH =  
ENTER MORE OR  
PRESS [START]  
35  
Go to Step 8.  
Go to Step 8.  
RELAY END NUMBER  
RELAY END NUMBER  
ABB. NUMBER =(1-999)  
XX  
GROUP NBR =(1-1999)  
XXX  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up a Relay Box - continued  
Enter the End Station - continued  
Complete the End  
Station Entry  
Enter the Number to send the Transmission  
10  
Result  
8
9
When all the desired End Sta-  
tion Entries (One Touch Keys,  
Abbreviated Dial Numbers or  
Group Numbers) are completed  
under the same Relay Box,  
press:  
Enter the facsimile number you  
want the relay transmission re-  
port (relay transmission End  
Stations results) sent to.  
Enter the Group  
Number of End Station  
- continued  
8c  
8d  
10a  
Enter the Number  
Cancel or Retain the  
Existing Station  
Using the Dial Keypad  
Then press:  
If the End Station (One Touch  
Key, Abbreviated Dial Number  
or Groups Number) designated  
in Step 8a, 8b or 8c have al-  
ready been entered under the  
same Relay Box, the following  
LCD prompt is displayed.  
Enter the facsimile number us-  
ing the Dial Keypad.  
If you do not desire a relay  
transmission  
report,  
press  
.
RELAY END NUMBER  
TRANSMISSION REPORT  
ENTER TEL NUMBER,  
SPEED DIAL KEY OR OT  
ENTER TO COMPLETE  
The following screen is dis-  
played for about 2 seconds to  
indicate that the Mailbox is reg-  
istered.  
GROUP NUMBER= XXXX  
XXXXXXXX  
RELAY END NUMBER  
ALREADY ASSIGNED  
1.CANCEL  
After 2 seconds:  
2.RETAIN  
RELAY END NUMBER  
GROUP NUMBER= XXXX  
ENTER MORE OR  
TRANSMISSION REPORT  
REGISTERED  
To cancel the existing End Sta-  
tion (One Touch Key, Abbrevi-  
ated Dial Number or Group  
Number), press:  
TEL NUMBER =(MAX128)  
XXXX  
PRESS [START]  
Go to Step 8.  
Then press:  
To retain the existing End Sta-  
tion (One Touch Key, Abbrevi-  
ated Dial Number or Group  
Number), press:  
The following screen is dis-  
played for about 2 seconds to  
indicate that the Mailbox is reg-  
istered.  
Go to Step 8.  
REGISTERED  
130  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up a Relay Box - continued  
Enter the Number to send the Transmission Result - continued  
10  
Enter the Number using the Abbreviated Dial  
Number  
10b  
10c  
Enter the Number  
using the One Touch  
Key  
Then press:  
Press the desired One Touch Press the desired Abbreviated  
Key.  
Dial Number.  
Example: One Touch Key 01.  
The following screen is dis-  
played for about 2 seconds to  
indicate that the Mailbox is reg-  
istered.  
+
TRANSMISSION REPORT  
ONE TOUCH  
01  
Enter the Abbreviated Dial Num-  
ber.  
The following screen is dis-  
played for about 2 seconds to  
indicate that the Mailbox is reg-  
istered.  
REGISTERED  
REGISTERED  
TRANSMISSION REPORT  
ABB. NBR=  
001  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Deleting a Relay Box  
This section describes the proce-  
dures to delete an existing Relay  
Box in a DP120F/DP125F hub  
unit.  
Display the MAILBOX  
Menu  
Select SETUP &  
DELETE  
Select BOX  
DELETE  
Enter the Box  
Number  
1
2
3
4
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
Enter the Box number (max. 20  
digits) of the Relay Box you  
want to delete.  
Select “4.BOX SETUP” by  
pressing:  
Select “3.BOX DELETE” by  
pressing:  
Press:  
MAILBOX  
SETUP MAILBOX  
1.COMPLETE  
2.BOX SETUP  
3.BOX DELETE  
ENTER DELETE BOX NBR  
BOX NUMBER =(MAX20)  
1.CONFIDENTIAL  
2.BULLETIN BOARD  
3.RELAY  
Then press:  
4.BOX SETUP  
If the entered Box number does  
not have  
a
password pro-  
grammed, go to Step 6.  
If the entered Box number has  
a password programmed, the  
screen below is displayed.  
Go to Step 5.  
ENTER PASSWORD  
PASSWORD =(MAX20)  
132  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Deleting a Relay Box - continued  
Enter the Password  
Complete the  
Procedure  
5
6
Enter the Password (max. 20).  
The following screen is dis-  
played to indicate that the can-  
cellation is accepted.  
CANCELLED  
ENTER PASSWORD  
PASSWORD =(MAX20)  
******  
Then press:  
NOTE:  
Make sure that the correct  
password is entered. Other-  
wise, the machine will inform  
you that the password is in-  
correct.  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Relay Transmission to a Remote Hub  
This section describes the pro-  
Load the Document  
Display the MAILBOX  
Menu  
Select the RELAY  
Enter the Box  
Number  
cedures to send a document to  
Relay Box in a remote hub unit.  
The remote hub unit must be  
compliant with ITU-T F-code  
communications. For more infor-  
mation, see page 126.  
1
2
3
4
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50- Select the “3.RELAY” by press-  
73” view to select the desired ing:  
Function Key.  
Enter the Box Number (max. 20  
digits).  
Load the document face down  
in the Document Tray (see page  
88).  
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
Press:  
NOTE:  
The destination relay box  
must be setup in the remote  
hub unit prior to sending  
document.  
MAILBOX  
MAY-17-00 WED10:22  
SEND(RELAY)  
1.CONFIDENTIAL  
2.BULLETIN BOARD  
3.RELAY  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
BOX NUMBER =(MAX20)  
Then press:  
4.BOX SETUP  
PROGRAM PASSWORD?  
1.YES  
2.NO  
134  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Relay Transmission to a Remote Hub - continued  
Enter the Box  
Number  
Enter the Password  
for Reservation  
Dial the Remote Hub  
Unit  
Complete the  
Procedure  
5
6
7
8
Enter the password to access  
the Relay Box.  
If the remote hub unit has a  
password programmed, press:  
Enter the facsimile number of  
the remote hub unit using any  
of the following dialing meth-  
ods.  
The facsimile starts scanning  
the document into memory.  
The following screen is dis-  
played for about 2 seconds be-  
fore returning to the Standby  
Mode.  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
Go to Step 6.  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
SCANNING INTO MEMORY  
FILE NBR=  
231  
If the remote hub unit does not  
have a password programmed,  
press:  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 90%  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
Then press:  
Go to Step 7.  
SEND(RELAY)  
ENTER TEL NUMBER.  
SPEED DIL KEY OR  
ONE TOUCH KEY  
TEL NUMBER=(MAX128)  
123  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- POLLING & MAILBOX COMMUNICATIONS  
The DP120F/DP125F features  
advanced Polling and Mailbox  
Polling & Mailbox Overview  
functions designed to provide  
remote document retrieval capa-  
bilities. In addition, the DP120F/  
DP125F is a “Hub” type unit  
where documents can be stored  
and polled by other facsimiles  
(with polling capabilities to re-  
trieve documents from the  
DP120F/DP125F).  
Polling Reservation  
Polling Reception  
Polling Reservation allows documents to be stored in the DP120F/ Polling Reception is the ability to call up another facsimile and re-  
DP125F so that other facsimile machines can remotely retrieve motely retrieve a document stored within the remote facsimile. The  
(Poll) those documents. Following types of polling reservations are following types of polling receptions are available.  
available.  
Simple Polling  
Simple  
The DP120F/DP125F can call any other facsimile with polling  
reservation capabilities to remotely retrieve a document. See  
page 141.  
Documents can be reserved for a one time polling operation  
using the facsimile’s memory so that any facsimile with polling  
reception capabilities can remotely retrieve the document. See  
page 138.  
Secure Polling  
The DP120F/DP125F can call another TOSHIBA facsimile with  
security polling reservation capabilities to remotely retrieve a  
document using a 4-digit security code. See page 141.  
Security  
Documents can be reserved for a one time polling operation that  
requires a 4-digit security code to be entered prior to sending the  
document. Security reservation is only available when communi-  
cating with other TOSHIBA facsimiles. See page 138.  
Multi Address Polling  
Multi Address Polling allows the DP120F/DP125F to sequentially  
poll multiple remote facsimiles using a group of facsimile num-  
bers stored as a group directory or as a MULTI key operation.  
See page 143.  
Public Mailbox  
Documents can be reserved for multiple polling operations using  
the facsimile’s memory so that any facsimile with polling capabili-  
ties can remotely retrieve the document. See page 140.  
Continuous Polling  
Continuous Polling permits the DP120F/DP125F to sequentially  
dial and retrieve documents from a group of facsimile numbers  
on a continuous basis. See page 145.  
Turnaround Polling  
Turnaround Polling allows the DP120F/DP125F to transmit docu-  
ments to a remote facsimile and then poll documents from the  
remote facsimile on the same phone call. See page 147.  
Delayed Polling  
Delayed Polling permits the DP120F/DP125F to poll  
a
document(s) from a remote location(s) at a later time. See page  
181.  
136  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Polling & Mailbox Overview - Continued  
Open Mailbox (ITU-T Compatible)  
The Open Mailbox is a new international standard for mailbox communications. Open Mailbox (ITU-T F-  
code communications) allows storage and retrieval of documents via mailboxes that comply with this  
standard. The DP120F/DP125F is a hub unit that has document storage capabilities so that ITU-T F-  
Code compliant remote units can retrieve documents from the DP120F/DP125F. Prior to utilizing Open  
Mailbox, mailboxes must be created in the DP120F/DP125F. Following two types of Mailboxes are  
available.  
Confidential Box  
Confidential box allows a one time document retrieval from the mailbox. Once a document is  
retrieved, it is cleared. If a new document is stored using the same box number where another  
document is already present, it is added to the existing one. It is possible to setup a password  
requirement for accessing the Confidential Box for document retrieval to prevent unauthorized re-  
trieval of documents. This password is used only when retrieving documents and not used during  
document reservation.  
Bulletin Board Box  
Bulletin Board box allows multiple document retrievals from the mailbox. If a new document is stored  
using the same Box number where another document is already present, it replaces the existing one.  
It is possible to setup a password requirement for accessing the Bulletin Board Box for document  
reservation during setup. This password is used only when reserving documents from a remote  
facsimile or the local hub and not used during document retrieval.  
1. To setup an Open Mailbox, see page 149.  
2. To delete an Open Mailbox, see page 151.  
3. To reserve a document to a remote hub, see page 153.  
4. To reserve a document to a local DP120F/DP125F, see page 155.  
5. To retrieve (Poll) a document from a remote hub, see page 157.  
6. To retrieve (Print) a document from a local DP120F/DP125F, see page 159.  
7. To delete a document from an Open Mailbox, see page 161.  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Simple & Security Polling Reservation  
This procedure allows the  
DP120F/DP125F to send a doc-  
Load the Document  
Display the  
POLLING Menu  
Select POLLING  
RESERVE  
Select POLLING  
1
2
3
4
ument to another remote fac-  
simile when requested. In addi-  
tion, documents can be protect-  
ed from unauthorized remote  
facsimiles by using security  
codes. Two types of security  
codes are offered.  
Load the document face down Turn the Flip Panel to the “50- Select “2.POLLING RESERVE”  
in the Document Tray (see page 73” view to select the desired by pressing:  
Select “1.POLLING” by press-  
ing:  
88).  
Function Key.  
Adjust the resolution and con- Press:  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
4-Digit Security Code  
When the 4-digit security code  
is selected as the check code,  
the document can only be re-  
ceived by TOSHIBA facsimiles  
with the matching security code.  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
POLLING  
1.POLLING  
2.POLLING RESERVE  
3.PROG. CONT. POLL.  
POLLING RESERVE  
1.POLLING  
2.PUBLIC FAX MAILBOX  
SECURITY CODE/TEL?  
1.NO  
2.SECURITY CODE  
3.TEL NO.  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
Facsimile Number  
4.CODE & TEL NO.  
If a facsimile number is selected  
as the check code, the remote  
facsimile’s Transmit Terminal  
Identification (TTI) is checked  
prior to document transmission.  
This type of security code can  
be used with facsimiles made  
by other manufacturers.  
This TTI must be properly pro-  
grammed into the remote fac-  
simile for this procedure to func-  
tion.  
NOTES:  
Only one Simple Polling  
reservation can be set at  
one time.  
Simple Polling reserva-  
tion is not available if a  
document is reserved in  
the Public Mailbox.  
138  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Simple & Security Polling Reservation - continued  
6a Select  
6b Select TEL NO.  
6c Select CODE & TEL  
7
Select the Security  
Option  
Complete the  
Procedure  
5
SECURITY CODE  
NO.  
Select “4.CODE & TEL NO.” by  
pressing:  
Use the Dial Keypad to select Select “2.SECURITY CODE” by  
one of the following options or pressing:  
Select “3.TEL NO.” by pressing:  
The facsimile starts scanning  
the document.  
use  
/
to scroll  
SCANNING INTO MEMORY  
up/down the menu and press  
.
Enter the number of the polling  
FILE NBR =  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 70%  
140  
POLLING RESERVE  
SECURITY CODE =  
POLLING RESERVE  
SECURITY CODE =  
POLLING RESERVE  
SECURITY TEL=(MAX20)  
When the document scanning is  
complete, the display returns to  
the Standby Mode.  
1. NO  
Select this option if you do  
not want to use security. Go  
to Step 7.  
Enter a 4-digit Security Code  
(0000 to 9999) using the Dial  
Keypad.  
Enter a 4-digit Security Code  
(0000 to 9999) using the Dial  
Keypad. Each digit of the en-  
tered code is displayed as an  
asterisk.  
(remote) facsimile using the Dial  
Keypad (max. 20 digits).  
NOTE:  
If a Simple Polling operation  
is already reserved, the fol-  
lowing screen is displayed.  
2. SECURITY CODE  
POLLING RESERVE  
Select this option to use a 4-  
digit Security Code with  
TOSHIBA facsimiles only.  
Go to Step 6a.  
SECURITY CODE =  
****  
ALREADY ASSIGNED  
1.CANCEL  
POLLING RESERVE  
POLLING RESERVE  
3. TEL NO.  
2.ADD  
3.RETAIN  
SECURITY TEL=(MAX20)  
123456789  
SECURITY CODE =  
****  
Then press:  
Select this option to use the  
telephone number of the  
polling (remote) facsimile’s  
as the security code. Go to  
Step 6b.  
POLLING RESERVE  
You may select one of the fol-  
lowing three options.  
Then press:  
Then press:  
SECURITY TEL=(MAX20)  
1. CANCEL  
4. CODE & TEL NO.  
Select this option to use both  
a 4-digit security code and a  
telephone number. Go to  
Step 6c.  
Select this option to replace  
the previous reservation.  
Go to Step 7.  
Go to Step 7.  
Enter the number of the polling-  
receiver’s facsimile (max. 20  
digits).  
NOTE:  
NOTE:  
2. ADD  
You must provide this 4-digit  
number to the remote party  
in advance or they will not be  
able to retrieve this docu-  
ment. If no code or an incor-  
rect code is used, a polling  
error will occur.  
This number must be pro-  
grammed in the terminal ID  
of the remote facsimile. If no  
number or an unmatched  
number is in the terminal ID,  
a polling error will occur.  
Select this option to add this  
document to the existing res-  
ervation.  
POLLING RESERVE  
SECURITY TEL=(MAX20)  
123456789  
3. RETAIN  
Select this option to retain  
the existing reservation.  
When the number is displayed  
correctly, press:  
Go to Step 7.  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Public Mailbox Polling Reservation  
Public Mailbox is a feature used  
Load the Document  
Display the POLLING  
RESERVE Menu  
Select PUBLIC  
FAX M-BOX  
Complete the  
Procedure  
to store a document in memory  
so that multiple remote parties  
may poll to receive it at any  
time. No Security Codes are  
used with this feature. The  
document is retained in memory  
regardless of how many times it  
is polled.  
1
2
3
4
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
Select “2.PUBLIC FAX MAIL- The facsimile starts scanning  
BOX” by pressing:  
Load the document face down  
in the Document Tray (see  
page 88).  
the document.  
SCANNING INTO MEMORY  
FILE NBR = 140  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 70%  
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
Press:  
NOTES:  
Only one Public Mailbox  
polling reservation can be  
set at one time.  
+
When the document scanning is  
complete, the display returns to  
the Standby Mode.  
When a Simple Polling  
reservation is reserved,  
Public Mailbox reserva-  
tion is not available.  
NOTE:  
If a Public Mailbox operation  
is already reserved, the fol-  
lowing screen is displayed.  
POLLING RESERVE  
1.POLLING  
2.PUBLIC FAX MAILBOX  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
POLLING  
1.POLLING  
2.POLLING RESERVE  
3.PROG. CONT. POLL.  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
ALREADY ASSIGNED  
1.CANCEL  
2.ADD  
3.RETAIN  
You may select one of the fol-  
lowing three options.  
1. CANCEL  
Select this option to replace  
the previous reservation.  
2. ADD  
Select this option to add this  
document to the existing res-  
ervation.  
3. RETAIN  
Select this option to retain  
the existing reservation.  
140  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Simple & Secure Polling  
Use this procedure to retrieve a  
document from a remote fac-  
simile.  
Display the  
POLLING Menu  
Select POLLING  
Dial the Remote  
Facsimile  
Select the Security  
Code Option  
1
2
3
4
If the remote facsimile is a  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
Select “1.POLLING” by press- Dial the number of the remote Select the security code option.  
TOSHIBA facsimile and a 4-digit  
security code is programmed to  
the document to be polled, you  
must enter the correct 4-digit se-  
curity code in order to retrieve  
the document.  
ing:  
facsimile (in which the document  
you want to retrieve is located)  
using any of the following dialing  
methods.  
If the remote facsimile is a  
TOSHIBA facsimile and a 4-  
digit security code is pro-  
grammed to the document to be  
polled, select “1. YES” by  
pressing:  
Press:  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
POLLING  
1.POLLING  
2.POLLING RESERVE  
3.PROG. CONT. POLL.  
POLLING  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
Go to Step 5.  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
If the remote facsimile is not a  
TOSHIBA facsimile or a Secu-  
rity Code is not in use, select  
“2. NO” by pressing:  
Press:  
POLLING  
SECURITY CODE ?  
1.YES  
Go to Step 6.  
2.NO  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Simple & Secure Polling - continued  
Enter the Security  
Code  
Complete the  
Procedure  
5
6
Enter the 4-digit security code The facsimile will dial the re-  
for the document to be re- mote facsimile to retrieve the  
trieved.  
document. When the operation  
is complete, the following  
screen is displayed for about 2  
seconds and your documents  
will be printed.  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
FILE NBR =  
167  
POLLING  
SECURITY CODE =  
****  
When the 4-digit security code  
is entered, press:  
Go to Step 6.  
142  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Multi Address Polling  
In a Multi Polling operation, the  
documents are retrieved from  
multiple remote facsimiles using  
pre-programmed groups, One  
Touch Keys, Abbreviated Dial  
Numbers, Alphabet Dial, or from  
the Dial Keypad.  
Display the  
POLLING Menu  
Select POLLING  
Press the MULTI  
Key  
Enter the Number of  
Remote Facsimiles  
1
2
3
4
Select “1.POLLING” by press-  
ing:  
Press:  
Enter the number of the remote  
facsimiles using any combina-  
tion of the following dialing  
methods.  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
Press:  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
POLLING  
1.POLLING  
2.POLLING RESERVE  
3.PROG. CONT. POLL.  
POLLING  
MULTI POLLING  
ENTER TEL NUMBER.  
SPEED DIAL KEY OR  
ONE TOUCH KEY  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
Group Dialing  
... See page 123  
After each entry, the selected  
facsimile is displayed for 2 sec-  
onds.  
MULTI POLLING  
ABB. NUMBER=  
009  
GREENSVILLE PLANT  
Repeat this procedure until all  
remote facsimiles are entered.  
MULTI POLLING  
ENTER MORE OR  
PRESS [START]  
143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Multi Address Polling - continued  
Select the Security  
Code Option  
Enter the Security  
Code  
Complete the  
Procedure  
5
6
7
When all the remote facsimile  
locations have been entered in  
Step 4, press:  
Enter the 4-digit security code The facsimile will dial the re-  
for the document to be re- mote facsimiles to retrieve the  
trieved.  
documents. When the operation  
is complete, the following  
screen is displayed for about 2  
seconds and your documents  
will be printed.  
MULTI POLLING  
SECURITY CODE ?  
1.YES  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
2.NO  
FILE NBR =  
167  
If the remote facsimile is a  
TOSHIBA facsimile and a 4-digit  
security code is programmed to  
the document to be polled, se-  
lect “1. YES” by pressing:  
POLLING  
SECURITY CODE =  
****  
When the 4-digit security code  
is entered, press:  
Go to Step 6.  
If the remote facsimile is not a  
TOSHIBA facsimile or no Secu-  
rity Codes are being used, se-  
lect “2. NO” by pressing:  
Go to Step 7.  
144  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Continuous Polling  
Use this procedure to poll the  
same remote facsimile(s) on a  
regular schedule. Continuous  
Polling operations can be pro-  
grammed for specific time inter-  
vals on the days selected. In ad-  
dition, a 4-digit security code  
can be used with other TOSHI-  
BA facsimiles when the docu-  
ment has a security code pro-  
grammed.  
Display the  
POLLING Menu  
Select PROG. CONT.  
POLL.  
Enter the Polling  
Interval  
Enter the Start and  
Stop Time  
1
2
3
4
Select “3.PROG. CONT. POLL”  
by pressing:  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
Enter the time interval between  
polling sequences (10 to 70  
minutes).  
Enter the polling start and stop  
time.  
Press:  
Only interval settings of 10-  
minute increments are permis-  
sible. (Example: Enter “1” for  
10 minutes or “2” for 20 min-  
utes, etc.)  
NOTES:  
Calls  
are  
performed  
POLLING  
1.POLLING  
2.POLLING RESERVE  
3.PROG. CONT. POLL.  
PROG. CONT. POLL.  
within the set time period  
on the days selected with  
the set interval between  
callings.  
INTERVAL=(10-70)MIN  
0
When the time period is dis-  
played correctly, press:  
If multiple sending sta-  
tions are programmed,  
callings are performed to  
all those stations within  
the set time period.  
NOTES:  
If the polling operation  
exceeds the set time pe-  
riod, it will continue until  
all the facsimiles have  
been polled.  
You may use  
/
Then press:  
to move the cursor left  
and right.  
If the 12-hour format is  
selected, you may use  
Redialing or calling to al-  
ternate dialing numbers is  
not available during this  
operation.  
PROG. CONT. POLL.  
the  
/
keys  
TIME PERIOD =  
08:00 -17:00  
to select AM or PM.  
If a power failure occurs  
during this procedure, the  
polling continues when  
power is restored.  
PROG. CONT. POLL.  
[ ] FOR SETTING  
↑↓  
SCHEDULE =  
MON-FRI  
If the set time period is  
shorter than the set call-  
ing interval, polling will be  
performed only once at  
the start time.  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Continuous Polling - continued  
Select the Day of the  
Week  
Enter the Number of  
Remote Facsimile  
Select the Security  
Code Option  
Enter the Security  
Code  
5
6
7
8
Select the day of the week to Enter the number of the remote  
start polling. When the day-of- facsimile using any of the fol-  
week range is displayed cor- lowing dialing methods.  
rectly, press:  
When all the remote facsimile  
locations have been entered in  
Step 6, press:  
Enter the 4-digit security code  
for the document to be re-  
trieved.  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
If the remote facsimile is a  
TOSHIBA facsimile and a 4-  
digit security code is pro-  
grammed to the document to be  
polled, go to Step 8.  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
NOTES:  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
To designate the start or  
end day, use  
to move the entry point.  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
/
If the remote facsimile is not a  
TOSHIBA facsimile or no Secu-  
rity Codes are in use, press:  
After each entry, the selected  
facsimile is displayed for 2 sec-  
onds.  
Press  
/
to  
POLLING  
change the day.  
SECURITY CODE =11111  
****  
No Security Code will be se-  
lected and the facsimile will re-  
turn to the Standby Mode.  
PROG. CONT. POLL.  
ENTER TEL NUMBER,  
ABB. NUMBER OR  
ONE TOUCH KEY  
PROG. CONT. POLL.  
When the 4-digit security code  
is entered, press:  
ONE TOUCH=  
PORTLAND PLANT  
24  
The facsimile will automatically  
start polling at the time set in  
this procedure.  
Repeat this procedure until all  
remote facsimiles are entered.  
The procedure is now complete.  
The display returns to the  
Standby Mode.  
PROG. CONT. POLL.  
The facsimile will automatically  
start polling at the time set in  
this procedure.  
ENTER MORE OR  
PRESS [START]  
146  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Turnaround Polling  
Turnaround Polling allows you  
to poll another facsimile after  
transmitting documents to it on  
the same phone call.  
Display the  
TURNAROUND POLL  
Menu  
Load the Document  
Select ON  
Select the Security  
Code Option  
1
2
3
4
Press:  
Load the document face down in  
the Document Tray (see page  
88).  
To set Turnaround Poll to ON,  
press:  
Select the security code option.  
NOTE:  
Turnaround polling may not  
operate with certain non-  
TOSHIBA models.  
TURNAROUND POLL  
SECURITY CODE ?  
1.YES  
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
+
+
2.NO  
MAY-17-00 WED11:49  
TURNAROUND POLL  
SECURITY CODE ?  
1.YES  
If the remote facsimile is a  
TOSHIBA facsimile and a 4-digit  
security code is assigned to the  
document to be polled, select  
“1. YES” by pressing:  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
2.NO  
TURNAROUND POLL  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
Go to Step 5.  
If the remote facsimile is not a  
TOSHIBA facsimile or no secu-  
rity Codes are in use, select “2.  
NO” by pressing:  
Go to Step 6.  
147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Turnaround Polling - continued  
Enter the Security  
Code  
Dial the Number of  
Remote Facsimile  
Complete the  
Procedure  
5
6
7
Enter the number of the remote  
facsimile using any of the follow-  
ing dialing methods.  
The facsimile will dial the re-  
mote facsimile to perform an or-  
dinary transmission. When the  
transmission is complete, poll-  
ing of the document from the re-  
mote facsimile will start immedi-  
ately.  
Enter the 4-digit security code  
for the document to be re-  
trieved.  
• One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
• Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
When the polling operation is  
complete, the Turnaround Poll-  
ing setting is automatically can-  
celled.  
• Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
• Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
COMM. RESERVATION  
TURNAROUND POLL  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 80%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
SECURITY CODE =  
****  
When the 4-digit security code  
is entered, press:  
Go to Step 6.  
148  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- MAILBOX (ITU-T Compatible)  
This section describes the procedures to setup a Mailbox in the  
DP120F/DP125F hub unit. Using this function, all ITU-T F-code  
compliant facsimiles can reserve, transmit, or retrieve documents to  
and from the DP120F/DP125F. Mailboxes must be setup prior to  
utilizing the DP120F/DP125F as an Mailbox Hub. For more informa-  
tion, see page 137. Two Types of Mailboxes are available.  
Setting Up a Mailbox  
Display the MAILBOX  
Select SETUP &  
DELETE  
Select BOX SETUP  
1
2
3
Menu  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
Select “4.BOX SETUP” by  
pressing:  
Select “2.BOX SETUP” by  
pressing:  
Confidential Box  
Confidential Box allows a one time document retrieval from the  
mailbox. Once a document is retrieved, it is cleared. A document  
retrieval password for accessing the Confidential Box can be  
added during setup.  
Press:  
It is important to note that a password is required to retrieve a  
document from a Confidential Box using a remote facsimile. If  
the contents of this mailbox are to be polled remotely, a pass-  
word must be used. A password is not mandatory if the contents  
are to be printed locally.  
SETUP MAILBOX  
1.COMPLETE  
2.BOX SETUP  
3.BOX DELETE  
TYPE OF BOX  
MAILBOX  
1.CONFIDENTIAL TYPE  
2.BULLETIN BRD TYPE  
3.RELAY  
1.CONFIDENTIAL  
2.BULLETIN BOARD  
3.RELAY  
Bulletin Board Box  
Bulletin Board box allows multiple document retrievals from the  
mailbox. It is possible to add a password requirement for docu-  
ment reservation so that only users with the correct password  
can reserve documents. The password is not required to retrieve  
documents from the Bulletin Board Box.  
4.BOX SETUP  
149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up a Mailbox - continued  
Select the Mailbox  
Type  
Enter the Box  
Number  
Select the Password  
Option  
Enter the Password  
Complete the  
Procedure  
4
5
6
7
8
Select the desired type of Mail- Enter the Mailbox number (max.  
Select whether or not to use the Enter the password (max. 20  
password option for this mail- digits).  
box.  
The following screen is dis-  
played for about 2 seconds to  
indicate that the Mailbox is reg-  
istered.  
box.  
20 digits).  
To select the Confidential Box,  
press:  
To set the password option for  
this mailbox, press:  
Go to Step 7.  
REGISTERED  
To select the Bulletin Board  
Box, press:  
If you do not wish to set the  
password option with this mail-  
box, press:  
Then press:  
ENTER PASSWORD  
PASSWORD =(MAX20)  
*****  
Go to Step 8.  
ENTER NEW BOX NBR  
PROGRAM PASSWORD?  
1.YES  
2.NO  
NOTES:  
BOX NUMBER =(MAX20)  
Then press:  
If you selected the Confi-  
dential Box in Step 4, a  
password must be used if  
the document is to be re-  
trieved remotely. The re-  
mote facsimile will re-  
quire its operator to enter  
this password before be-  
ing able to retrieve the  
document.  
If you selected the Bulle-  
tin Board Box in Step 4,  
assigning a password will  
require a password to be  
entered before any docu-  
ments can be reserved  
into the Bulletin Board  
Box.  
150  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Deleting a Mailbox  
This section describes the pro-  
cedures to delete an existing  
Mailbox in a DP120F/DP125F  
hub unit.  
Display the MAILBOX  
Menu  
Select BOX SETUP  
Select BOX  
DELETE  
Enter the Box  
Number  
1
2
3
4
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
Enter the Box number (max. 20  
digits) of the Mailbox you want  
to delete.  
Select “4.BOX SETUP” by  
pressing:  
Select “3.BOX DELETE” by  
pressing:  
NOTE:  
If a document exists in the  
Mailbox you want to delete,  
this operation is not allowed  
until the document is re-  
trieved, printed, or cancelled  
from the Mailbox.  
Press:  
MAILBOX  
SETUP MAILBOX  
1.COMPLETE  
2.BOX SETUP  
3.BOX DELETE  
ENTER DELETE BOX NBR  
BOX NUMBER =(MAX20)  
1.CONFIDENTIAL  
2.BULLETIN BOARD  
3.RELAY  
Then press:  
4.BOX SETUP  
If the entered Box number does  
not have  
a
password pro-  
grammed, go to Step 6.  
If the entered Box number has  
a password programmed, the  
screen below is displayed.  
Go to Step 5.  
ENTER PASSWORD  
PASSWORD =(MAX20)  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Deleting a Mailbox - continued  
Enter the Password  
Complete the  
Procedure  
5
6
Enter the Password (max. 20).  
The following screen is dis-  
played to indicate that the can-  
cellation is accepted.  
CANCELLED  
ENTER PASSWORD  
PASSWORD =(MAX20)  
******  
Then press:  
NOTE:  
Make sure that the correct  
password is entered. Other-  
wise, the machine will inform  
you that the password is in-  
correct.  
152  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sending a Document to a Mailbox (Remote Hub)  
This section describes the pro-  
Load the Document  
Display the MAILBOX  
Menu  
Select the Mailbox  
Type  
Select TX TO  
MAILBOX  
cedures to send a document to  
a remote hub unit’s Confidential  
Box, or reserving a document to  
a Bulletin Board Box in a remote  
hub unit. The remote hub unit  
must be compliant with ITU-T F-  
code communications. For more  
information, see page 137.  
1
2
3
4
Load the document face down Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
in the Document Tray (see 73” view to select the desired  
page 88).  
Select the desired type of Mail-  
box.  
Select “2. TX TO MAILBOX” by  
pressing:  
Function Key.  
To send the document to a  
Confidential Box, press:  
Adjust the resolution and con- Press:  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
NOTE:  
The destination mailbox  
number must be setup in the  
remote hub unit prior to  
sending document.  
TX(CONFIDENTIAL)  
BOX NUMBER =(MAX20)  
CONFIDENTIAL  
MAILBOX  
MAY-17-00 WED10:22  
1.PRINT MAILBOX  
2.TX TO MAILBOX  
3.POLL FROM MAILBOX  
1.CONFIDENTIAL  
2.BULLETIN BOARD  
3.RELAY  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
or  
4.BOX SETUP  
TX(BULLETIN BOARD)  
BOX NUMBER =(MAX20)  
To reserve the document to a  
Bulletin Board Box in a remote  
hub unit, press:  
BULLETIN BOARD  
1.PRINT MAILBOX  
2.TX TO MAILBOX  
3.POLL FROM MAILBOX  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sending a Document to a Mailbox (Remote Hub) - continued  
Enter the Box  
Number  
Enter the Password  
for Reservation  
Dial the Remote Hub  
Unit  
Complete the  
Procedure  
5
6
7
8
Enter the Box Number (max. 20  
digits).  
Enter the password to access  
the Bulletin Board Box.  
Enter the facsimile number of  
the remote hub unit using any  
of the following dialing meth-  
ods.  
The facsimile starts scanning  
the document into memory.  
The following screen is dis-  
played for about 2 seconds be-  
fore returning to the Standby  
Mode.  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
SCANNING INTO MEMORY  
FILE NBR=  
231  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 90%  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
Then press:  
Then press:  
If you are sending to a Confi-  
dential Box, go to Step 7.  
If you are sending to a Bulletin  
Board, go to Step 6.  
TX(CONFIDENTIAL)  
ENTER TEL NUMBER.  
SPEED DIAL KEY OR  
ONE TOUCH KEY  
TX(BULLETIN BOARD)  
ENTER TEL NUMBER.  
SPEED DIAL KEY OR  
ONE TOUCH KEY  
TX(CONFIDENTIAL)  
TEL NUMBER=(MAX128)  
123  
or  
or  
TX(BULLETIN BOARD)  
ENTER PASSWORD  
PASSWORD =(MAX20)  
TEL NUMBER=(MAX128)  
123  
154  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reserving a Document to a Mailbox (Local Hub)  
This section describes the pro-  
Load the Document  
Display the MAILBOX  
Menu  
Select the Mailbox  
Type  
Select INPUT TO  
MAILBOX  
cedure to reserve a document  
to the DP120F/DP125F’s Confi-  
dential Box or Bulletin Board  
Box.  
1
2
3
4
Select the desired type of Mail-  
box.  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
Select “4.INPUT TO MAILBOX”  
by pressing:  
Load the document face down  
in the Document Tray (see  
page 88).  
NOTE:  
Before a document can be  
reserved to a mailbox; that  
mailbox must first be setup.  
See page 149.  
To reserve the document to a  
Confidential Box, press:  
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
Press:  
NOTE:  
You may use  
/
MAY-17-00 WED10:22  
MAILBOX  
CONFIDENTIAL  
1.CONFIDENTIAL  
2.BULLETIN BOARD  
3.RELAY  
1.PRINT MAILBOX  
2.TX TO MAILBOX  
3.POLL FROM MAILBOX  
to scroll up/down the menu  
screen to select this option.  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
4.BOX SETUP  
4.INPUT TO MAILBOX  
5.CANCEL MAILBOX  
INPUT(CONFIDENTIAL)  
BOX NUMBER =(MAX20)  
To reserve the document to a  
Bulletin Board Box, press:  
or  
INPUT(BULLETIN BRD)  
BOX NUMBER =(MAX20)  
BULLETIN BOARD  
1.PRINT MAILBOX  
2.TX TO MAILBOX  
3.POLL FROM MAILBOX  
4.INPUT TO MAILBOX  
5.CANCEL MAILBOX  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reserving a Document to a Mailbox (Local Hub) - continued  
Enter the Box  
Number  
Enter the Password  
for Reservation  
Complete the  
Procedure  
5
6
7
Enter the Box Number (max. 20  
digits).  
Enter the password to access  
the Bulletin Board Box.  
The facsimile starts scanning  
the document into memory.  
The following screen is dis-  
played for about 2 seconds be-  
fore returning to the Standby  
Mode.  
SCANNING INTO MEMORY  
FILE NBR=  
231  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 90%  
Then press:  
INPUT(BULLETIN BRD)  
PASSWORD =(MAX20)  
****  
If you are reserving to a Confi-  
dential Box, go to Step 7.  
Then press:  
If you are reserving to a Bulletin  
Board Box, go to Step 6.  
INPUT(BULLETIN BRD)  
PASSWORD =(MAX20)  
156  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Retrieving (Polling) a Document from a Mailbox (Remote Hub)  
This section describes the pro-  
Display the  
MAILBOX Menu  
Select the Mailbox  
Type  
Select POLL FROM  
MAILBOX  
Enter the Box  
Number  
cedure to retrieve a document  
from a Confidential Box or Bulle-  
tin Board Box in a remote hub  
unit.  
1
2
3
4
Select “3.POLL FROM MAIL-  
BOX” by pressing:  
Select the desired type of Mail-  
box.  
Enter the Box Number (max. 20  
digits).  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
To poll a document in a Confi-  
dential Box, press:  
Press:  
MAILBOX  
POLL(CONFIDENTIAL)  
BOX NUMBER =(MAX20)  
CONFIDENTIAL  
1.CONFIDENTIAL  
2.BULLETIN BOARD  
3.RELAY  
1.PRINT MAILBOX  
2.TX TO MAILBOX  
3.POLL FROM MAILBOX  
Then press:  
4.BOX SETUP  
or  
To poll a document in a Bulletin  
Board Box, press:  
If you are retrieving from a  
Confidential Box, go to Step 5.  
POLL(BULLETIN BOARD)  
BOX NUMBER =(MAX20)  
If you are retrieving from a Bul-  
letin Board Box, go to Step 6.  
POLL(CONFIDENTIAL)  
PASSWORD =(MAX20)  
BULLETIN BOARD  
1.PRINT MAILBOX  
2.TX TO MAILBOX  
3.POLL FROM MAILBOX  
or  
POLL(BULLETIN BOARD)  
ENTER TEL NUMBER.  
SPEED DIAL KEY OR  
ONE TOUCH KEY  
157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Retrieving a Document from a Mailbox (Remote Hub) - continued  
Enter the Password  
Dial the Remote Hub  
Unit  
Complete the  
Procedure  
5
6
7
The facsimile starts dialing the  
remote hub unit to retrieve the  
document. The following screen  
is displayed for about 2 seconds  
before returning to the Standby  
Mode.  
Enter the password to access  
the Confidential Box.  
Enter the facsimile number of  
the remote hub unit using any  
of the following dialing meth-  
ods.  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
Then press:  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
POLL(CONFIDENTIAL)  
ENTER TEL NUMBER.  
SPEED DIAL KEY OR  
ONE TOUCH KEY  
POLL(CONFIDENTIAL)  
FILE NBR =  
234  
TEL NUMBER=(MAX128)  
123  
or  
POLL(BULLETIN BOARD)  
TEL NUMBER=(MAX128)  
123  
158  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printing a Document from a Mailbox (Local Hub)  
This section describes the pro-  
Display the  
MAILBOX Menu  
Select the Open  
Mailbox Type  
Select PRINT  
MAILBOX  
Enter the Box  
Number  
cedure to retrieve a document  
from a local DP120F/DP125F’s  
Confidential Box or Bulletin  
Board Box. For more informa-  
tion, see page 149.  
1
2
3
4
Select “1.PRINT MAILBOX” by  
pressing:  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50- Select the desired type of Mail-  
73” view to select the desired box.  
Enter the Box Number (max. 20  
digits).  
Function Key.  
To print a document from a  
Press:  
Confidential Box, press:  
PRT(CONFIDENTIAL)  
MAILBOX  
CONFIDENTIAL  
1.CONFIDENTIAL  
2.BULLETIN BOARD  
3.RELAY  
1.PRINT MAILBOX  
2.TX TO MAILBOX  
3.POLL FROM MAILBOX  
BOX NUMBER =(MAX20)  
Then press:  
4.BOX SETUP  
or  
If you are printing from a Confi-  
dential Box, go to Step 5.  
To print a document from a Bul-  
letin Board Box, press:  
PRT(BULLETIN BOARD)  
BOX NUMBER =(MAX20)  
If you are printing from a Bulle-  
tin Board Box, go to Step 6.  
BULLETIN BOARD  
PRT(CONFIDENTIAL)  
PASSWORD =(MAX20)  
1.PRINT MAILBOX  
2.TX TO MAILBOX  
3.POLL FROM MAILBOX  
159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Printing a Document from a Mailbox (Local Hub) - continued  
Enter the Password  
Complete the  
Procedure  
5
6
Enter the password to access  
the Confidential Box.  
The facsimile starts printing the  
document. The following screen  
is displayed during the printing  
sequence before returning to  
the Standby Mode.  
MAY-17-00 WED10:22  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 80%  
PRINTING  
Then press:  
160  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cancelling Documents in a Mailbox (Local Hub)  
This section describes the pro-  
cedure to cancel the docu-  
Display the  
MAILBOX Menu  
Select the Mailbox  
Type  
Select CANCEL  
MAILBOX  
Enter the Box  
Number  
1
2
3
4
ments stored in the DP120F/  
DP125F. This operation will  
erase all existing documents in  
each Mailbox, but not erase the  
Mailbox itself.  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
Select the desired type of Mail- Select “5.CANCEL MAILBOX”  
Enter the Box Number (max. 20  
digits).  
box.  
by pressing:  
To cancel documents from a  
Confidential Box, press:  
Press:  
NOTE:  
You may use  
/
to scroll up/down the menu  
screen to select this option.  
CONFIDENTIAL  
MAILBOX  
1.PRINT MAILBOX  
2.TX TO MAILBOX  
3.POLL FROM MAILBOX  
1.CONFIDENTIAL  
2.BULLETIN BOARD  
3.RELAY  
Then press:  
CANCEL(CONFIDENTIAL)  
BOX NUMBER =(MAX20)  
4.INPUT TO MAILBOX  
5.CANCEL MAILBOX  
4.BOX SETUP  
If you are cancelling from a Box  
with a password assigned, go  
to Step 5.  
or  
To cancel a document from a  
Bulletin Board Box, press:  
CANCEL(BULLETIN BD.)  
BOX NUMBER =(MAX20)  
If you are cancelling from a Box  
with no password assigned, go  
to Step 6.  
BULLETIN BOARD  
1.PRINT MAILBOX  
2.TX TO MAILBOX  
3.POLL FROM MAILBOX  
4.INPUT TO MAILBOX  
5.CANCEL MAILBOX  
161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cancelling Documents in a Mailbox (Local Hub) - continued  
Enter the Password  
Complete the  
Procedure  
5
6
Enter the password to access  
Confidential Box.  
The facsimile will display the fol-  
lowing screen for approximately  
2 seconds before returning to the  
Standby Mode.  
CANCELLED  
CANCEL(CONFIDENTIAL)  
PASSWORD =(MAX20)  
****  
or  
CANCEL(BULLETIN BD.)  
PASSWORD =(MAX20)  
****  
Then press:  
162  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- ADVANCED TRANSMISSION FUNCTIONS  
Department Code Access  
This procedure assumes that  
DEPT CODE  
Standby Menu  
Enter the  
Department Code  
Complete the  
Procedure  
you have selected and config-  
ured the Department Codes on  
pages 55 and 56 of this manual.  
1
2
3
The Department Code Standby  
menu is shown below.  
Enter the 5-digit Department  
Code preset for your depart-  
ment.  
If the password you have en-  
tered is valid, the ordinary  
Standby Mode screen (as  
shown below) will be displayed.  
The access will be limited to  
one transmission job or one Op-  
eration Panel function (printing a  
list, accessing a Mailbox, etc.)  
Once selected, the use of the  
facsimile is limited to authorized  
personnel only.  
MAY-17-00 WED10:22  
NOTE:  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 80%  
ENTER DEPT CODE  
The usage for each depart-  
ment is recorded on the De-  
partment Control List (see  
page 217).  
If the password does not match,  
verify your password and re-en-  
ter.  
ENTER DEPT CODE  
MAY-17-00 WED10:22  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
LOAD DOCUMENT  
*****  
NOTE:  
Then press:  
Upon entering a valid 5-digit  
password,  
the  
standby  
prompt will remain on the  
LCD for one operation or  
one minute whichever oc-  
curs first.  
NOTE:  
If you do not have a valid  
Department Code Password,  
you cannot access this fac-  
simile.  
Contact the key operator or  
supervisor for more informa-  
tion.  
163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Account Code Entry  
This procedure assumes that  
you have enabled the Account  
Code option on page 58 of this  
manual.  
Load the Document  
Enter the Facsimile  
Number  
Enter an Account  
Code  
Complete the  
Procedure  
1
2
3
4
Load the document face down  
in the Document Tray (see page  
88).  
Enter the number of the remote Enter the 4-digit Account Code.  
facsimile using any of the fol-  
lowing dialing methods.  
The facsimile starts scanning  
the document into memory.  
When document scanning is  
complete, the display returns to  
the Standby Mode.  
Once enabled, the facsimile will  
prompt for an Account Code  
prior to dialing the remote party.  
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
The entered Account Code will  
be printed in the Account Code  
column on the Activity Journal.  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
MAY-17-00 WED10:22  
SCANNING INTO MEMORY  
FILE NBR =  
244  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 80%  
NOTES:  
• “Account Code” tracking is  
only possible when using  
the memory communica-  
tions (Memory Transmis-  
sion, Polling Receptions,  
etc.).  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
COMM. RESERVATION  
COMM. RESERVATION  
ACCOUNT CODE =  
ENTER ACCOUNT CODE  
OR PRESS [START]  
• Once entered, an Account  
Code is only effective for  
that communication proce-  
dure. It will automatically  
clear upon completion of  
the communication, upon  
job cancellation, or upon a  
communication error.  
****  
Then press:  
NOTE:  
It is possible to send a docu-  
ment without entering an Ac-  
count Code. Simply press  
or  
.
164  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cover Sheet Registration  
This function enables the at-  
tachment of a cover sheet to the  
document being transmitted.  
Display the COVER  
SHEET Menu  
Enable / Disable the  
Cover Sheet  
Include an Image on  
the Cover Sheet  
Load the Image  
Document  
1
2
3
4
Prior to selecting this function  
for the first time, you may wish  
to prepare a Cover Sheet image  
(Logo) to be used on the cover  
sheet. See Step 4 of this proce-  
dure.  
Load the image document to be  
included on the cover sheet.  
Press:  
Enable or Disable the Cover To include an image (a scanned  
Sheet attachment.  
company logo, etc.), press:  
NOTE:  
+
+
+
+
In preparing a document for  
your cover sheet image, only  
a limited area of the sheet  
will be included as shown  
below. Any data out of the  
specified range will be disre-  
garded.  
(for ON-Enable)  
(for YES)  
To omit an image on the cover  
sheet, press:  
(for OFF-Disable)  
8.5 in.  
(216 mm)  
When “ON” is selected, the fol-  
lowing screen is displayed.  
(for NO)  
Effective  
Range  
5.9 in.  
(150 mm)  
WITH IMAGE?  
1.YES  
2.NO  
Feed  
Direction  
When the document is pulled  
into the appropriate position, the  
following screen is displayed.  
COVER SHEET  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
When “OFF” is selected, the  
“OPERATION  
COMPLETED”  
message will be displayed. Con-  
tinue to the final step.  
COVER SHEET  
Image Area  
PRESS [START]  
Press:  
When scanning is complete, the  
facsimile returns to the Standby  
Mode.  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chain Dialing  
This allows you to dial tele-  
phone/facsimile numbers that  
may require many digits with  
pauses for voice prompts or  
variations in number sequences  
such as long distance access  
codes, or specialized access  
lines. You can combine sets of  
numbers (Abbreviated Dialing,  
Alphabet Dialing, One Touch Di-  
aling, and Keypad Dialing) and  
pauses in a “Chained” dial se-  
quence by using the Chain Dial  
Key.  
Load the Document  
Display the CHAIN  
DIAL COMM. Menu  
Enter the Dial  
Number  
Press the START  
Key  
1
2
3
4
Load the document face down Turn the Flip Panel to the “50- Start constructing your dialing When all the required entries  
in the Document Tray (see page 73” view to select the desired sequence using any of the fol- are made, press:  
88).  
Function Key.  
lowing dialing methods. You  
may use them consecutively un-  
til your entire dialing string has  
been entered. After each entry  
sequence, the LCD screen dis-  
plays the screen shown is step  
2.  
Press:  
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
The facsimile starts scanning  
the document into memory, dis-  
playing the screen shown be-  
low. When document scanning  
is complete, the display returns  
to the Standby Mode.  
MAY-17-00 WED10:22  
CHAIN DIAL COMM.  
ENTER TEL NUMBER.  
SPEED DIAL KEY OR  
ONE TOUCH KEY  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
If your operation requires paus-  
ing for voice prompts, you will  
need to insert pause signals be-  
tween dial strings.  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
To determine the correct  
amount of time for your pauses,  
you should perform the opera-  
SCANNING INTO MEMORY  
FILE NBR =  
108  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 97%  
tion using  
first. This  
Pause Signal  
way you will know how many 3-  
second pauses will be required.  
166  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TTI (Transmit Terminal ID) Print  
To properly identify the sender of your documents, the DP120F/DP125F prints a transmission header (TTI) on the recording paper of the  
remote facsimile. The information included in the TTI are:  
Display the TTI  
Menu  
1
Date and Start Time  
The date and start time when this document is sent to the remote facsimile.  
Press:  
Transmitting Station ID Name (see page 42)  
Transmission Serial Number  
With each transmission, the DP120F/DP125F automatically assigns a unique transmission number. This number is also printed on the  
Activity Journals.  
+
+
Page Number/Total Number of Pages  
Each page of the document is printed with a page number followed by the total number of pages in the document (e.g. 001/003 means  
the first page of three total pages).  
File Number  
Each document sent from memory is assigned a file number. This file number is used by the DP120F/DP125F to assist you in managing  
multiple document jobs.  
+
+
Total Page  
Number  
Transmission  
Serial Number  
Date  
Transmission  
Station ID Name  
Page  
Number  
Start Time  
File Number  
05-17-2000 10:00 FROM: TOSHIBA  
+1-714-583-0000  
T-123 P.001/003 F-030  
TTI  
1.INSIDE  
2.OUTSIDE  
3.OFF  
You can select the following options for your TTI information.  
Inside  
The document is sent to the receiver with the TTI included in the document data. Accordingly, if any characters exist near the top edge  
of the sending data, they may be overlapped with the TTI.  
Outside  
The document is sent to the receiver with the TTI to be printed outside the sending data. Accordingly, if any characters exist near the top  
edge of the sending data, the TTI and the sending data will not overlap in transmission.  
Off  
IMPORTANT NOTE:  
The U.S. Federal Communication Commission (FCC) requires that anyone sending a facsimile message must identify themselves (or  
company), give their facsimile telephone number, and provide the date and time of the transmission. This information must be on the lead-  
edge of, at least, the first page of the facsimile transmission.  
167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TTI - continued  
Setting Recovery Transmission  
Recovery Transmission allows  
Display the  
Select the TTI Print  
Option  
Select the Recovery  
Transmit Option  
Enter the STORED  
TIME  
2
the operator to re-transmit a  
document after failing the ini-  
tially specified number of redial  
attempts.  
1
2
3
RECOVERY  
TRANSMIT Menu  
Select the TTI Print option.  
To select INSIDE, press:  
Press:  
Select the Recovery Transmit  
option.  
Enter the stored time length (01  
to 24, in unit of hours).  
If the Recovery Transmission is  
set to ON, the document is  
stored in memory for a specified  
length of time. You may retrans-  
mit the document during this  
time period without re-scanning  
the original document.  
To turn ON Recovery Transmis-  
sion, press:  
+
+
To select OUTSIDE, press:  
To select OFF, press:  
Go to Step 3.  
To turn OFF Recovery Trans-  
mission, press:  
+
+
Then press:  
Skip the procedure in Step 3.  
Your setting is now complete.  
The facsimile will display the  
same screen shown in Step 3.  
When completed, the following  
screen is displayed. Press  
The display shows the screen  
below to indicate that the menu  
selection is accepted. To return  
to the Standy Mode, press  
to return to the Standby  
Mode.  
.
OPERATION COMPLETED  
RECOVERY TRANSMIT  
RECOVERY TRANSMIT  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
STORED TIME =(01-24)  
06  
168  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sending Recovery Transmission  
This operation is used to re-  
Display the  
Select the Desired  
Job  
Change the  
Facsimile Number  
Cancel the  
Document  
send a document after the docu-  
ment initially failed to be sent. If  
recovery transmission is set to  
ON, the document is stored in  
the DP120F/DP125F for resend-  
ing.  
1
2
3
4
RECOVERY  
TRANSMIT Menu  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
When the desired job is dis-  
played, you have an option to  
re-transmit the document or to  
permanently delete the job from  
memory.  
Enter the new facsimile num-  
ber.  
Press:  
Press:  
NOTE:  
When Recovery Transmis-  
sion is set to OFF, an error  
tone and “NOT ALLOWED  
NOW” LCD prompt result  
when Recovery Transmis-  
sion is selected.  
When Recovery Transmis-  
sion is set to ON but no  
documents are in the Recov-  
ery Queue, a “NO ENTRY”  
LCD prompt will result.  
CANCEL?  
FILE NBR =  
1.YES  
You can also change the num-  
ber of the remote facsimile if di-  
aled from the Dial Keypad.  
To re-transmit the document or  
change the facsimile number,  
123  
2.NO  
Press the  
or  
is  
to view the jobs stored for  
resending. The information dis-  
played on the LCD display.  
press  
.
If the correct number is entered,  
press:  
SINGLE TRANSMIT  
1.START  
2.CHANGE  
1st row  
Type of transmission  
The transmission starts immedi-  
ately if the phone line is avail-  
able.  
2nd row  
ID name or dial number of  
the destination  
To start the transmission, press:  
To change the number, press:  
3rd row  
Date and time when the  
document (file) was stored  
into memory  
4th row  
File number assigned to the  
transmission job  
RECOVERY TRANSMIT  
[ENTER]:START  
[CANCEL]:DELETE  
[ ]:SEARCH  
↑ ↓  
TEL NUMBER=(MAX128)  
12345  
To cancel the document, go to  
Step 4.  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sending Recovery Transmission - continued  
Select the Cancel  
Option  
5
To delete the selected docu-  
ment stored for resending,  
press:  
To retain the selected document  
stored for resending, press:  
DELETED  
FILE NBR =  
123  
170  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PIN Mask  
Some telephone PBX (Private  
Branch Exchange) systems can  
track and monitor all outgoing  
calls made by a facsimile. This  
is done by entering a PIN code  
after dialing the destination fac-  
simile number.  
Load the Document  
Enter the Facsimile  
Number  
Press the MULTI  
Key  
Enter the PIN  
Number  
1
2
3
4
Select the Flip Panel “50-73”  
view on the Operation Panel.  
Enter the number of the remote  
facsimile.  
Enter the PIN number.  
Load the document face down  
in the Document Tray (see  
page 88).  
Press the CHARGE CODE key  
to initiate the PIN number se-  
quence. A “+” will be displayed  
on the LCD display.  
The Toshiba DP120F/DP125F  
faciliates the telephone PBX  
system by masking the PIN en-  
tered with a “$” on both the LCD  
and TX Reports/Journals.  
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
NOTE:  
This feature is limited to key-  
pad dialing.  
This feature is not available  
with Abbreviated, Alphabet,  
or One Touch Key dialing.  
The PIN number entered is  
masked with “$” displayed on  
the LCD display.  
MAY-17-00 WED20:58  
COMM. RESERVATION  
COMM. RESERVATION  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
TEL NUMBER=(MAX 128)  
17145551212  
TEL NUMBER=(MAX 128)  
17145551212+  
When the entry is complete,  
press  
.
COMM. RESERVATION  
TEL NUMBER=(MAX 128)  
17145551212+$$$$$  
171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Disabling ECM Temporarily  
If the ECM default setting is set  
Display the SET  
ECM Menu  
Select the ECM  
Option  
to ON, it is always effective for  
communications on your facsim-  
ile.  
1
2
Press:  
Select “2.OFF” by pressing:  
You can turn ECM OFF for a  
single transmission using this  
procedure. The facsimile will au-  
tomatically return to its default  
status immediately after that  
transmission is complete.  
+
+
The following screen is dis-  
played. You may dial the remote  
facsimile for your communica-  
tion job. The display will return  
to the Standby Mode in about  
60 seconds if no keys are  
pressed.  
NOTE:  
If ECM is set to “OFF” in the  
default setting procedure,  
this procedure is not appli-  
cable and the facsimile will  
warn you with an error mes-  
sage,  
NOW.”  
“NOT  
ALLOWED  
SET ECM  
1.ON  
COMM. RESERVATION  
2.OFF  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
172  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- ADVANCED RECEPTION FUNCTIONS  
Privileged Reception  
This function prevents your fac-  
Display the  
Select the Privileged  
Reception Option  
simile from receiving docu-  
ments from unknown parties.  
Transmissions to the DP120F/  
DP125F are only possible when  
the sending facsimile’s terminal  
identification or telephone num-  
ber match those assigned to  
the Abbreviated Dial Numbers  
or One Touch Dial Keys on  
your facsimile.  
1
2
PRIVILEGED RX  
Menu  
Press:  
To turn ON Privileged Recep-  
tion, press:  
+
+
To turn OFF Privileged Recep-  
tion, press:  
NOTES:  
• Privileged Reception is ef-  
fective only on incoming  
calls received in the Auto-  
matic Reception Mode.  
+
+
• Privileged Reception is not  
available for polling or  
mailbox retrieval requests  
from the remote facsimiles.  
• For this feature to work,  
you must pre-program the  
numbers of the facsimiles  
in your communication  
system into your DP120F/  
DP125F’s  
Abbreviated  
SET PRIVILEGED RX  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
Number or One Touch Dial  
Key database. In addition,  
the remote facsimile must  
have the correct telephone  
number programmed as its  
terminal identification.  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
RTI (Remote Terminal ID) Print  
To clearly identify the time, date, and page count of your facsimile receptions, the DP120F/DP125F is  
able to print a Reception Footer (RTI) on received documents using the DP120F/DP125F’s internal  
clock.  
Display the RTI  
Menu  
Select the RTI Print  
Option  
1
2
Select the RTI Print option.  
To print, press:  
Press:  
RECEIVED 05-17-2000  
Date  
10:00  
FROM-+81425887449  
TO-TOSHIBA  
PAGE 001  
+
+
Transmitting Station  
ID Number  
Footer Message  
Receiving Station ID  
Not to print, press:  
Start Time  
Page  
Number  
+
+
NOTES:  
The Transmitting Station ID Number will only be provided if it is programmed in the remote  
facsimile’s Terminal ID.  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
The Receiving Station ID will only be provided if it is programmed in this facsimile’s Terminal ID.  
RTI  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
174  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Memory Reception Setting  
When the printer becomes unavailable during a document recep-  
tion, due to a recording paper jam, toner empty or other error condi-  
tion, this facsimile backs up the received data by storing it in  
memory.  
Display SET  
MEMORY RX Menu  
Select the Memory  
Reception Option  
1
2
Press:  
Select the Memory Reception  
Option.  
Once the document is stored in memory, the message “Memory  
Reception” is displayed on the LCD display. In addition, the LCD  
provides a message to indicate the error that caused the Memory  
Reception.  
To set the Memory Reception  
ON, press:  
+
+
MAY-17-00 WED10:22  
PAPER EMPTY  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 90%  
MEMORY RECEPTION  
To set the Memory Reception to  
OFF, press:  
+
+
To retrieve the data stored in memory, simply correct the error con-  
dition (such as refill your paper tray with recording paper). Your  
document will be printed automatically.  
When the setting is complete,  
the following screen is dis-  
played. To return to the Standby  
NOTES:  
The default setting is ON.  
When OFF is selected, no receptions will be possible should  
the paper supply be exhausted or a paper jam occurs.  
Mode, press  
.
Note that “Memory Reception” will not occur when the re-  
sidual memory is zero. When the residual memory becomes  
zero during a Memory Reception, document reception will  
stop and no further receptions are possible until memory be-  
comes available.  
SET MEMORY RX  
1.ON  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
2.OFF  
175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Secure Reception Access Code Setting  
There are occasions when you  
may wish to secure access to  
Display the SECURE  
RX Menu  
Select the Option  
Determine New or  
Existing Code  
Enter the Current  
Security Code  
1
2
3
4
incoming documents. Secure  
RX allows you to receive docu-  
ments to memory until a security  
code is entered. This ensures  
that only users with the correct  
security code may retrieve  
documents. In addition, the Se-  
cure RX can be setup to auto-  
matically be activated during a  
specified time period.  
Press:  
To select a security code for the If the security code already ex- Before you change the security  
first time or to change an exist- ists and you wish to change the code, you must enter the exist-  
ing security code, press:  
current code, go to Step 4.  
ing code to gain the access.  
Enter the current security code.  
+
When you enter a security code  
for the first time, go to Step 5.  
+
If a new code needs to be en-  
tered:  
+
To setup Secure RX, a 4-digit  
security code must be pro-  
grammed first. After program-  
ming the security code, you can  
specify the time period during  
which the Secure RX will be ac-  
tive. 24-hour coverage for spe-  
cific days of the week is select-  
able. This section describes the  
procedure for programming a  
security code or changing an  
existing security code.  
If the code already exists:  
SECURITY CODE ENTRY  
NEW CODE  
SECURITY CODE=  
+
+
Then press:  
Go to Step 5.  
SECURITY CODE ENTRY  
CURRENT CODE  
SECURITY CODE=  
If the correct code is entered,  
following is displayed.  
SECURE RX  
01.SECURITY CODE  
02.ACTIVITY MODE  
SECURITY CODE ENTRY  
NEW CODE  
SECURITY CODE=  
XXXX  
176  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Code - cont.  
Secure RX Activation Period Setting  
This section describes the pro-  
Enter a New  
Security Code  
Display the SECURE  
RX Menu  
Select the Option  
Enter the Security  
Code  
cedure to setup the DP120F/  
DP125F to automatically acti-  
vate Secure RX during a speci-  
fied time period. Prior to setting  
this option, you must have a se-  
curity code set in the facsimile.  
5
1
2
3
Enter your new 4-digit security  
code. The screen shown below  
is displayed to confirm your en-  
try.  
Press:  
To set the activity period for Se- Enter the current security code.  
cure RX, press:  
+
+
+
NOTE:  
If a security code is not set,  
the DP120F/DP125F auto-  
matically prompts the secu-  
rity code setting. See the  
preceding section for details  
on setting the security code.  
NOTE:  
If a security code is not set,  
the DP120F/DP125F auto-  
matically prompts the secu-  
rity code setting. See the  
preceding section for details  
+
+
on setting the security code.  
Then press:  
Then press:  
Your security code entry is now  
complete. Go to Step 7 of next  
section to set your Activity Pe-  
riod.  
SECURE RX  
01.SECURITY CODE  
02.ACTIVITY MODE  
SECURE RX  
SECURE RX  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
SECURITY CODE=  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Secure RX Activation Period Setting - continued  
Activate the  
Automatic Secure RX  
Enter the Start and  
End Time  
Select 24-HOUR  
SECURE RX Option  
Set for Each Day  
Complete the  
Procedure  
4
5
6
7
8
To activate automatic Secure  
RX during a specified time pe-  
riod, press:  
Enter the time period (start time  
and end time) subject to auto-  
matic activation using the fol-  
lowing keys.  
You can also set Secure RX to To set Secure RX for the entire The following is displayed for 2  
ON for an entire 24-hour-period 24-hour-period for the day dis- seconds.  
(e.g. Saturdays & Sundays).  
played, press:  
To set 24-HOUR SECURE RX  
for each day, press:  
Press  
to return to the  
To move the entry  
point to the left or  
right.  
Standby Mode.  
Go to Step 5.  
To not set, Press:  
To de-activate automatic Secure  
RX during a specified time pe-  
riod, press:  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
To enter the  
To bypass setting 24-HOUR  
SECURE RX for each day,  
press:  
desired  
nu-  
meric value  
for each time  
digit.  
Repeat this step until you select  
YES or NO for each day of the  
week (up to Sunday).  
Then press:  
Go to Step 8.  
NOTE:  
The day of the week is  
shown in line #1 of the LCD.  
Selecting YES for Monday  
means Secure RX will be ac-  
tive for the entire 24 hours of  
Monday.  
To change the time-  
of-day forward or  
backward when the  
12-hour system is  
used.  
MONDAY  
24HR SECURE RX?  
1.YES  
to return to the Standby Mode.  
2.NO  
When the start time and end  
time or the desired period is dis-  
played correctly, press:  
SECURE RX  
SET SECURE RX  
FOR 24HR OPERATION?  
1.YES  
TIME PERIOD =  
22:00 -09:00  
2.NO  
178  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Secure RX Manual Activation  
This section describes the pro-  
cedure to manually activate Se-  
cure RX.  
Select START or  
STOP  
Display the SECURE  
RX Menu  
1
2
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50- To manually activate Secure  
73” view to select the desired RX, press:  
Function Key.  
NOTES:  
In order to manually activate  
Secure RX, you must first  
activate Secure RX by going  
through the Secure RX Ac-  
cess Code setting. (See  
page 176).  
Press:  
The following screen is dis-  
played for 2 seconds to confirm  
NOTE:  
If Secure RX Activation is set  
your selection. Then the display  
returns to the Standby Mode.  
to OFF in the “Secure RX  
Activation Period Setting”, an  
error will result upon press-  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
ing  
in the operation  
above. The message “NOT  
ALLOWED NOW” will be dis-  
played for 2 seconds, then  
the screen returns to the  
Standby Mode.  
SECURE RX  
1.START  
2.PRINT  
179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Secure RX Print  
This section describes the pro-  
cedure to manually print out  
document data received into  
memory during Secure RX op-  
eration.  
Display the SECURE  
RX Menu  
Select PRINT  
Enter the Security  
Code  
1
2
3
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
To print any documents re- Enter the 4-digit security code.  
ceived into memory during Se-  
cure RX, press:  
Press:  
SECURE RX  
NOTE:  
SECURITY CODE=  
If Secure RX Activation is set  
to OFF in the “Secure RX  
Activation Period Setting”, an  
error will result upon press-  
Then press:  
ing  
in the operation  
The screen below is displayed  
for 2 seconds to indicate that  
Secure RX Print is selected. If  
there are any received docu-  
ments in memory, the DP120F/  
DP125F will print the docu-  
ments automatically upon se-  
lecting Secure RX Print.  
above. The message “NOT  
ALLOWED NOW” will be dis-  
played for 2 seconds, then  
the screen returns to the  
Standby Mode.  
SECURE RX  
1.START  
2.PRINT  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
180  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- TRANSMISSION OPTIONS  
Delayed Communication (Time Designation)  
This function is available to re-  
serve a document for transmis-  
sion at a programmed time.  
Display the  
DELAYED COMM.  
Menu  
Load the Document  
Enter the Time and  
Date  
Enter the Facsimile  
Number  
1
2
3
4
This function is convenient for  
Load the document face down  
Enter the time and day-of-  
month to start the communica-  
tion.  
Enter the number of the remote  
facsimile using any of the fol-  
lowing dialing methods.  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
-
TRANSMISSION OPTIONS  
making use of non-peak dis-  
count telephone rates for do-  
mestic and overseas facsimile  
transmissions. Delayed commu-  
nication can be applied to  
Single Transmissions (to trans-  
mit a single document to a  
specified destination), Multi-ad-  
dress (Group) Transmissions,  
Mailbox Transmissions, Relay  
in the Document Tray (see page  
88).  
Adjust the resolution and con- Press:  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
MAY-17-00 WED11:13  
DELAYED COMM.  
TIME =HH:MM DD  
Transmissions,  
Communication.  
and  
Polling  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
You can activate this option  
while programming an Abbrevi-  
ated Dial Number (page 70) or  
One Touch Dial key setting  
(page 77) if communication with  
the remote party always re-  
quires this option. Otherwise,  
use the following procedure.  
(The cursor moves to the next  
right digit as a numeric value is  
entered on each digit. Use the  
NOTE:  
If the day-of-month value  
entered in Step 2 does  
not exist in the current  
month, the communica-  
tion will start on the first  
day of the next month.  
For example, if “30” is  
entered in February, the  
communication will start  
on March 1st.  
NOTE:  
[
] key to backspace and de-  
It is not necessary to input a  
day-of-month, if you wish the  
communication to be com-  
pleted within the next 24-  
hour period.  
lete the values on the digits al-  
ready entered.)  
Press:  
Simply leave the day-of-  
month area blank.  
COMM. RESERVATION  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Communication Report Print  
You can request a communica-  
Load the Document  
Display the TX  
REPORT Menu  
Select the Option  
Enter the Facsimile  
Number  
tion report every time a docu-  
ment is sent. If you desire a  
communication report every  
time you send a document, set  
this function to ON as a default  
(see page 195).  
1
2
3
4
Load the document face down  
in the Document Tray (see page  
88).  
To set the DP120F/DP125F to Enter the number of the remote  
always print a communication facsimile using any of the fol-  
report in any condition, press:  
Press:  
lowing dialing methods.  
If you plan to use communica-  
tion reports only occasionally,  
use this procedure. The TX Re-  
port key allows you to obtain a  
report for one communication  
only.  
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
To set the DP120F/DP125F to  
only print a communication re-  
port when an error condition is  
encountered, press:  
MAY-17-00 WED11:13  
TX REPORT  
1.ALWAYS  
2.ON ERROR  
3.OFF  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
You can activate this option  
while programming an Abbrevi-  
ated Dial Number (see page 70)  
or One Touch Dial Key setting  
(see page 77) if communication  
with a specific remote party al-  
ways requires this option.  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
To set the DP120F/DP125F to  
never print a communication re-  
port, press:  
COMM. RESERVATION  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 80%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
182  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Priority Transmission  
Priority Transmission permits  
you to execute a transmission  
before any other reserved trans-  
mission job.  
Load the Document  
Display the  
PRIORITY TX Menu  
Enter the Facsimile  
Number  
1
2
3
Load the document face down Turn the Flip Panel to the “50- Enter the number of the remote  
in the Document Tray (see 73” view to select the desired facsimile using any of the fol-  
NOTES:  
page 88).  
Function Key.  
lowing dialing methods.  
Priority reservation is  
good for a Single Trans-  
mission only.  
Adjust the resolution and con- Press:  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
Only one communication  
can be reserved as a Pri-  
ority Transmission.  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
When a transmission is  
already reserved as a Pri-  
ority Transmission, press-  
MAY-17-00 WED11:13  
PRIORITY RESERVE  
ENTER TEL NUMBER.  
SPEED DIAL KEY OR  
ONE TOUCH KEY  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
ing  
will result in  
SCANNING INTO MEMORY  
FILE NUMBER = 110  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 90%  
an error.  
183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Low Speed Transmission  
If communication errors fre-  
Load the Document  
Display the QUALITY  
TX Menu  
Select a Speed  
Enter the Facsimile  
Number  
quently occur while transmitting  
documents due to bad line con-  
ditions, we recommend you to  
1
2
3
4
select  
a
lower transmission  
Load the document face down  
in the Document Tray (see page 73” view to select the desired  
88).  
Function Key.  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
Select the desired speed.  
To select OFF, press:  
Enter the number of the remote  
facsimile using any of the fol-  
lowing dialing methods or you  
may designate another option at  
this point.  
speed to enable quality trans-  
missions. The transmission  
speed will be restored to the de-  
fault value automatically after  
the low speed transmission is  
completed.  
Adjust the resolution and con- Press:  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
To select 14400 BPS, press:  
To select 9600 BPS, press:  
To select 4800 BPS, press:  
You can activate this option  
while programming an Abbrevi-  
ated Dial Number (page 70) or  
One Touch Dial Key (page 77) if  
communication with a certain  
remote party always requires  
this option.  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
MAY-17-00 WED11:13  
QUALITY TX  
1.OFF  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
2.14400BPS  
3. 9600BPS  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
4. 4800BPS  
COMM. RESERVATION  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
184  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dialing with Sub-Address  
This function attaches a sub-ad-  
Display the SUB  
ADDRESS COMM  
Menu  
Load the Document  
Select the Option  
Enter the SUB  
Address  
dress to the standard destina-  
tion address in the event the re-  
mote party requires one.  
1
2
3
4
Load the document face down Turn the Flip Panel to the “50- Select one of the following op- Enter the required SUB address  
Three types of sub-addresses  
can be used (SUB, SEP, and  
PWD); or any combination of  
two or three types can be used.  
After selecting the desired  
types, the transmission to follow  
will be sent to the desired ad-  
dress using the designated sub-  
address.  
in the Document Tray (see page 73” view to select the desired tions from the menu.  
(max. 20 digits), then press:  
88).  
Function Key.  
To select SUB, press:  
Adjust the resolution and con- Press:  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
The display returns to the  
screen at the bottom of Step 2.  
You may continue from Step 3  
and enter another sub-address  
of a different type. To complete  
your sub-address entry, select  
option “1.COMPLETE” in Step  
3.  
Go to Step 4.  
MAY-17-00 WED11:13  
SUB ADDRESS COMM.  
To select SEP, press:  
You can activate this option  
while programming an Abbrevi-  
ated Dial Number (page 70) or  
One Touch Dial Key (page 77) if  
communication with a certain re-  
mote party always requires this  
option.  
1.COMPLETE  
2.SUB  
3.SEP  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
4.PWD  
Go to Step 5.  
SUB ADDRESS COMM.  
SUB =(MAX20)  
To select PWD, press:  
If you activate this option using  
both the Abbreviated Dial Num-  
ber (or One Touch Dial Key)  
setting and using this procedure  
for the same destination, this  
operation will take precedence  
over the pre-programmed set-  
ting in Abbreviated Dial or One  
Touch Dial.  
Go to Step 6.  
To complete this procedure,  
press:  
NOTE:  
For more information on  
when to use SUB/SEP/PWD,  
refer to page 75. If you des-  
ignate an erroneous or un-  
necessary sub-address, the  
communication will result in  
an error.  
Go to Step 7.  
185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dialing with Sub-Address - continued  
Enter the SEP  
Address  
Enter the PWD  
Complete the  
Sub-Address Entry  
Enter the Facsimile  
Number  
5
6
7
8
Enter the required SEP address  
(max. 20 digits), then press:  
When the sub-address data has  
been entered, the following is  
displayed.  
Enter the number of the remote  
facsimile using any of the fol-  
lowing dialing methods or you  
may designate another option at  
this point.  
Enter the required PWD (max.  
20 digits), then press:  
COMM. RESERVATION  
The display returns to the  
screen at the bottom of Step 2.  
You may continue from Step 3  
and enter another sub-address  
of a different type. To complete  
your sub-address entry, select  
option “1.COMPLETE” in step 3.  
The display returns to the  
screen at the bottom of Step 2.  
You may continue from Step 3  
and enter another sub-address  
of a different type. To complete  
your sub-address entry, select  
option “1.COMPLETE” in Step  
3.  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
SUB ADDRESS COMM.  
SEP =(MAX20)  
SUB ADDRESS COMM.  
PWD =(MAX20)  
186  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Attaching or Printing a Cover Sheet  
This function attaches a cover  
Load the Document  
Display the COVER  
SHEET Menu  
Select the Option  
Enter the Remote  
Party’s Name  
sheet to the document to be  
transmitted or prints the cover  
sheet for confirmation purposes.  
1
2
3
4
Prior to using this cover sheet  
feature, the Cover Sheet func-  
tion must be set to ON. For  
more information see  
165.  
To attach a cover sheet, press:  
Select the direct function access  
view on the Operation Panel.  
Enter the name of the remote  
party.  
Load the document face down  
in the Document Tray (see page  
88).  
page  
Press:  
See page 37 for more informa-  
tion on Character Entry.  
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
NOTES:  
Then press:  
• When sending multi-ad-  
dress transmissions, the  
cover sheet will be attached  
to the document for every  
address.  
ENTER REMOTE NAME  
MAY-17-00 WED11:13  
COVER SHEET  
1.SEND  
2.PRINT  
• TTI will not be printed on  
the cover sheet.  
ENTER YOUR NAME  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 99%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
Go to Step 4.  
• Smart Batch is not available  
if this function is used.  
To print a cover sheet, press:  
• When re-sending a docu-  
ment due to an error, the  
cover sheet is again at-  
tached to the retransmis-  
sion.  
When the printing is complete,  
the display returns to the  
Standby Mode.  
• In Transmission Reports  
and Journals, the number of  
pages of each transmission  
includes the cover sheet.  
• When a Transmission Re-  
port is issued with the docu-  
ment image output, the first  
page data of the facsimile  
will be printed but not the  
cover page data.  
• The cover sheet is always  
sent in Letter size.  
• The resolution for the cover  
sheet is fixed to FINE. How-  
ever, if the receiving unit is  
set to STD, the cover sheet  
is sent in STD.  
187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Attaching or Printing a Cover Sheet - continued  
Enter the Sender’s  
Name  
Enter the Facsimile  
Number  
5
6
Cover Sheet Format  
Enter your name.  
Enter the number of the remote  
facsimile using any of the follow-  
ing dialing methods.  
Your Station ID (if preset; max. 40 characters)  
See page 37 for more informa-  
tion on Character Entry.  
Remote Station ID (printed when preset to the Abbrevi-  
ated Dial Number or One Touch Dial Key used for dial-  
ing). Max. 20 characters  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
Then press:  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
FACSIMILE MESSAGE  
Cover Page Title (fixed)  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
Date this document was re-  
served  
MAY-17-2000  
*** RE-TRANSMISSION ***  
COMM. RESERVATION  
Subtitle printed for retransmis-  
sion only  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 99%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
TO  
: ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRST  
(ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQR )  
Remote Name which was en-  
tered using this operation  
Dialed Facsimile Number (first  
38 digits)  
FAX NUMBER :  
1234567890123456789012345678901234567890  
Your Name which was entered  
using this operation  
FROM  
: ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ  
(ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQR )  
Your Facsimile Number (max. 20  
digits).  
FAX NUMBER : 12345678901234567890  
Number of document pages to  
be transmitted  
TOTAL PAGE  
00
PA
- Image Data Area -  
(The image here may be your company logo, etc. It can be preset by  
scanning, using the Cover Sheet Function setting operation on page 165. If  
no image is scanned for this purpose, this area is left blank.)  
188  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Line Selection  
This option allows you to select  
the phone line to be used for a  
transmission if this facsimile is  
equipped with the 2nd Line  
Board.  
Load the Document  
Display the TEL  
LINE SELECT Menu  
Select the Desired  
Option  
Enter the Facsimile  
Number  
1
2
3
4
Load the document face down Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
in the Document Tray (see page 73” view to select the desired  
Enter the number of the remote  
facsimile using any of the fol-  
lowing dialing methods or you  
may designate another option at  
this point.  
Select the desired option.  
You can activate this option  
when programming an Abbrevi-  
ated Dial Number (see page 70)  
or One Touch Dial Key (see  
page 77) if the communication  
with a certain remote party al-  
ways requires this option.  
To not select a specific line,  
press:  
88).  
Function Key.  
Adjust the resolution and con- Press:  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
APR-15-00 SAT11:13  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 98  
To select Line 1, press:  
NOTE:  
If no Line 2 Board is in-  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
NOTE:  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 99  
Line 2 is available for trans-  
mission if Line 2 has been  
set for Transmission/Recep-  
tion (see page 69). In addi-  
tion, if Line 2 is set for recep-  
tion only with timer, trans-  
missions are only possible  
when the timer has expired.  
stalled, an error prompt will  
result from this application.  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
To select Line 2, press:  
TEL LINE SELECT  
1.FIRST AVAILABLE  
2.LINE #1  
3.LINE #2  
COMM. RESERVATION  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 80%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enabling or Disabling Send After Scan Temporarily  
With the Send After Scan Mode  
Load the Document  
Display the SEND  
AFTER SCAN Menu  
Select the Send After Scan Option  
Default Setting set to “OFF”, this  
feature allows you enable the  
Send After Scan mode for a  
single transmission. Once that  
transmission is complete, the  
default status is regained.  
1
2
3
Load the document face down  
in the Document Tray (see page  
88).  
Turn the Flip Panels to the “50- Select the desired Send After To enable Send After Scan,  
73” view to select the desired Scan Option.  
Function Key.  
press:  
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
To disable Send After Scan,  
press:  
With Send After Scan selected,  
every page of the doument will  
be scanned into memory before  
dialing will begin.  
Press:  
WHEN MEMORY FULL  
1. DELETE SCAN PAGES  
2. SEND SCAN PAGES  
With Send After Scan set to NO  
(off), your DP120F/DP125F will  
begin dialing after the first page  
is scanned to memory.  
The following screen is dis-  
played. You may dial the remote  
facsimile for your communica-  
tion job. The display will return  
to the Standby Mode in about  
60 seconds if no keys are  
pressed.  
MAY-17-00 WED11:13  
SEND AFTER SCAN  
1.YES  
2.NO  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
Go to Step 4.  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
After 2 seconds:  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
Go to Step 5.  
190  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enabling or Disabling Send After Scan Temporarily - contined  
Select the Memory  
Full Option  
Enter the Facsimile  
Number  
4
5
Select the desired Memory Full Enter the number of the remote  
Option.  
facsimile using any of the fol-  
lowing dialing methods.  
To delete the pages being  
scanned, press:  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
To send the pages being  
scanned, press:  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
The following screen is dis-  
played. You may now dial the  
remote facsimile for your com-  
munication job. The display will  
return to the Standby Mode in  
about 60 seconds if no keys are  
pressed.  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting the Page Count  
When this function is set to ON,  
the designated number of pages  
Load the Document  
Display the PAGE  
NUMBER Menu  
Enter the Number of  
Document Pages  
Enter the Facsimile  
Number  
1
2
3
4
will be printed at the top of the  
recording paper at the remote  
station. This function is effective  
for a Direct Document Trans-  
mission only. (The total number  
of pages will be printed auto-  
matically as part of the TTI in  
Memory Transmissions.)  
Press:  
Enter the number of document  
pages (1 to 999).  
Load the document face down  
in the Document Tray (see page  
88).  
Enter the number of the remote  
facsimile using any of the fol-  
lowing dialing methods or you  
may designate another option at  
this point.  
+
+
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
This setting is very helpful for  
confirming that all of the pages  
loaded into the feeder have  
been successfully sent.  
MAY-17-00 WED11:13  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 98  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 99  
It will also assist the recipient to  
track the number of pages as it  
will add a page count to a the  
TTI at the top of your transmit-  
ted pages (i.e., 1/5, 2/5, 3/5,  
etc.).  
PAGE NUMBER  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
The press:  
PAGE NUMBER =(1-999)  
The facsimile will compare the  
number of pages actually sent  
with the number you entered.  
COMM. RESERVATION  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
192  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Line Monitor  
This function is used to set the  
facsimile’s speaker ON in order  
to monitor the phone line for one  
communication only. This func-  
tion is mainly used to confirm di-  
aling and phone line status.  
Load the Document  
Display the LINE  
MONITOR Menu  
Select the Option  
Enter the Facsimile  
Number  
1
2
3
4
Press:  
Load the document face down  
in the Document Tray (see  
page 88).  
Turn ON the monitor speaker by  
pressing:  
Enter the number of the remote  
facsimile using any of the fol-  
lowing dialing methods or you  
may designate another option at  
this point.  
You can activate this option  
when programming an Abbrevi-  
ated Dial Number (page 70) or  
One Touch Dial Key (page 77) if  
communication with a certain re-  
mote party always requires this  
option.  
+
+
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
COMM. RESERVATION  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
LINE MONITOR  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
MAY-17-00 WED11:13  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Security Transmission  
This function prevents your fac-  
simile from sending to an incor-  
Load the Document  
Display the SET  
SECURITY TX Menu  
Select the Option  
Enter the Facsimile  
Number  
1
2
3
4
rectly dialed phone. With this  
function set ON, the dialed num-  
ber will be checked against the  
remote facsimile’s programmed  
Transmit Terminal ID (TTI). The  
transmission will only occur if  
the number dialed matches the  
remote party’s number.  
Press:  
Load the document face down  
in the Document Tray (see  
page 88).  
Turn ON Security Transmission  
by pressing:  
Enter the number of the remote  
facsimile using any of the fol-  
lowing dialing methods or you  
may designate another option  
at this point.  
+
+
Adjust the resolution and con-  
trast if desired (see page 89).  
One Touch Key Dialing  
... See page 97  
NOTE:  
Abbreviated Dialing  
... See page 98  
To change the default set-  
ting of this function, refer to  
page 91. The status selec-  
tion in this operation will take  
precedence over the default  
setting.  
Alphabet Dialing  
... See page 99  
COMM. RESERVATION  
Keypad Dialing  
... See page 100  
MAY-17-00 WED11:13  
SET SECURITY TX  
1.ON  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
RESIDUAL MEMORY 100%  
ENTER TEL NUMBER  
2.OFF  
194  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
LISTS AND REPORTS - LIST AND REPORT OPTIONS SETTING  
This facsimile allows the operator to set various options regarding the lists and reports listed below.  
Reception Journal Settings  
JOURNAL  
Display the  
JOURNAL Menu  
Select the Desired  
Option  
1
2
There are two types of Journals available on the DP120F/DP125F. Both the Transmission Journal (TX  
Journal) and Reception Journal (RX Journal) list the 150 most recent transactions. Journals can be  
printed either Automatically or Manually. When manually printed,  
must be pressed. To select the  
Press:  
To configure the type of Journal  
to print when  
press:  
is used,  
type of Journal to print when  
section.  
is pressed, complete manual Journal printing discussed in this  
+
+
+
+
+
COMMUNICATION REPORT  
Communication Report allows you to print a report after every transmission. Reports can be printed  
automatically or manually. When printing automatically, you can designate to print a report for every  
transmission or only when an error has occurred during the transmission.  
In addition, you have the option of printing the first page image of the fax document on the report to  
facilitate identification.  
Go to Step 3.  
To set automatic printing, press:  
+
To setup the Communication Report, go to pages 197 to 203.  
Go to Step 4.  
RECEPTION LIST  
The DP120F/DP125F will print a reception list under the following conditions:  
Reservation to Local Mailbox  
When reserving a document to a Mailbox within the DP120F/DP125F locally, a reception list is  
printed.  
If Manual is selected:  
01.MANUAL  
02.AUTO  
MANUAL OUTPUT  
1.TX & RX JOURNAL  
2.TX JOURNAL  
Remote Mailbox  
When reserving a document to a Mailbox within the DP120F/DP125F remotely from another fac-  
simile, a reception list is printed at the DP120F/DP125F.  
3.RX JOURNAL  
Relay Station Reception  
When the DP120F/DP125F is setup as a relay hub and receives a relay transmission from an  
originator, a reception list is printed.  
If Automatic is selected:  
AUTOMATIC JOURNAL  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reception Journal Settings - continued  
MANUAL OUTPUT Options  
AUTOMATIC JOURNAL Options  
3
4
Select the desired option.  
To print both TX and RX Jour-  
After completing the Reception  
Journal Setting, you may con-  
tinue to select other Report set-  
tings referring to their associ-  
ated pages for instruction, or  
press  
Press the following key to setup  
automatic printing of the TX and  
RX Journals whenever 150  
transactions have taken in  
place.  
After completing the Reception  
Journal Setting, you may con-  
tinue to select other Report set-  
tings referring to their associ-  
ated pages for instruction, or  
press  
nal when  
press:  
is used,  
To turn ON Automatic printing of  
journal, press:  
To print only a TX Journal  
when is used, press:  
to exit the Report Setting mode  
and return to the Standby Mode.  
to exit the Report Setting mode  
and return to the Standby Mode.  
To turn OFF Automatic printing  
of journal, press:  
To print a RX Journal when  
is used, press:  
The following screen is dis-  
played to confirm your selection.  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
The following screen is dis-  
played to confirm your selec-  
tion.  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
196  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Direct Transmission Report Setting  
Display the SET TX  
REPORT Menu  
Select the Option for  
Direct Transmissions  
Select the Option for A5 SIZE PRINT  
1
2
3
Select the desired printing option To reduce the report size and After completing the Direct  
Press:  
for non-memory, direct transmis- print on A5 size paper, press:  
sions.  
Transmission Report Setting,  
you may continue to select  
other Report settings referring to  
their associated pages for in-  
struction, or press  
+
+
+
+
+
+
To ALWAYS print a Transmis-  
sion Report whenever a docu-  
To print the report normally,  
press:  
ment is transmitted, press:  
To only print a Transmission Re-  
port when an error has occurred,  
press:  
NOTES:  
to exit the Report Setting mode  
and return to the Standby Mode.  
To print the report on A5  
size paper, the A5 size  
paper must be loaded to  
the Bypass Tray (option  
for DP120F) in portrait,  
and the recording paper  
size must also be set to  
“OTHERS.”  
To turn OFF automatic printing of  
Transmission Reports, press:  
If no paper is loaded in  
the Bypass Tray, the re-  
port will be printed from  
another tray.  
The following screen is dis-  
played to confirm your selection.  
SET TX REPORT  
1.ALWAYS  
A5 SIZE PRINT  
1.ON  
2.ON ERROR  
3.OFF  
2.OFF  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Memory Transmission Report Setting  
Display the  
Select the Option for  
Memory TX  
Set the Option for  
First Page Image  
Select the Option for A5 SIZE PRINT  
1
2
3
4
MEMORY-TX  
REPORT Menu  
Press:  
Select the desired printing option To print a first page image of the  
for single location memory trans- facsimile document on the  
After completing the Memory  
To reduce the report size and  
print on A5 size paper, press:  
Transmission Report Setting,  
you may continue to select  
other Report settings referring  
to their associated pages for in-  
struction, or press  
missions.  
Transmission Report, press:  
+
+
+
+
+
+
To ALWAYS print a Transmis-  
sion Report whenever a docu-  
ment is transmitted, press:  
To print the report normally,  
press:  
To not print a first page image of  
the facsimile document on the  
Transmission Report, press:  
To only print a Transmission Re-  
port when an error has occurred,  
press:  
NOTES:  
to exit the Report Setting mode  
and return to the Standby  
Mode.  
To print the report on the  
A5 size paper, the A5  
size paper must be load-  
ed to the Bypass Tray  
(option for DP120F) in  
portrait, and the record-  
ing paper size must also  
be set to “OTHERS.”  
A5 SIZE PRINT  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
To turn OFF automatic printing of  
Transmission Reports, press:  
If no paper is loaded in  
the Bypass Tray, the re-  
port will be printed from  
another tray.  
The following screen is dis-  
played to confirm your selection.  
SET MEMORY-TX REPORT  
1.ALWAYS  
PRINT 1ST PG IMAGE?  
1.ON  
2.ON ERROR  
3.OFF  
2.OFF  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
198  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Multi-Address Transmission Report Setting  
Display the  
Select the Option for  
Multi-Address TX  
Set the Option for  
First Page Image  
1
2
3
MULTI-ADD  
REPORT Menu  
Press:  
Select the desired option for To print a first page image of  
Multi-address Transmission Re- the document on the transmis-  
ports.  
sion report, press:  
+
+
+
+
+
+
To ALWAYS print a Transmis-  
sion Report whenever a docu-  
ment is transmitted, press:  
To not print a first page image  
of the document on the trans-  
mission report, press:  
To only print a Transmission Re-  
port when an error has occurred,  
press:  
The following screen is dis-  
played to confirm your selection.  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
To turn off automatic printing of  
Transmission Reports, press:  
After completing the Mult-Ad-  
dress Transmission Report Set-  
ting, you may continue to select  
other Report settings referring to  
their associated pages for in-  
struction, or press  
SET MULTI-ADD REPORT  
1.ALWAYS  
PRINT 1ST PG IMAGE?  
1.ON  
2.ON ERROR  
3.OFF  
2.OFF  
to exit the Report Setting mode  
and return to the Standby Mode.  
199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Multi-Polling Report Setting  
Display the  
Multi-polling Report Options  
1
2
MULTI POLL  
REPORT Menu  
Press:  
Select the desired option for  
Multi-polling Reports.  
After completing the Multi-poll-  
ing Report Setting, you may  
continue to select other Report  
settings referring to their associ-  
ated pages for instruction, or  
press  
To ALWAYS print  
a
report  
+
+
+
+
+
+
whenever a document is trans-  
mitted, press:  
To only print a report when an  
error has occurred, press:  
to exit the Report Setting mode  
and return to the Standby Mode.  
To turn OFF automatic printing  
of this report, press:  
The following screen is dis-  
played to confirm your selection.  
SET MULTIPOLL REPORT  
1.ALWAYS  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
2.ON ERROR  
3.OFF  
200  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Relay Originator Report Setting  
Display the RELAY  
ORG. REPORT Menu  
Select the Option for  
Relay Originator  
Set the Option for  
First Page Image  
1
2
3
Press:  
Select the desired option to print To print a first page image of the  
a report whenever a Relay trans- facsimile document on the trans-  
mission is sent.  
mission report, press:  
+
+
+
+
+
+
NOTE:  
This is only applicable if the  
DP120F/DP125F is used as  
an Originator for a relay trans-  
mission (see page 134).  
To not print a first page image of  
the facsimile document on the  
transmission report, press:  
To ALWAYS print a report when-  
ever a document is transmitted,  
press:  
The following screen is dis-  
played to confirm your selection.  
To only print a report when an er-  
ror has occurred, press:  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
To turn OFF Automatic printing of  
reports, press:  
After completing the Relay  
Originator Report Setting, you  
may continue to select other  
Report settings referring to their  
associated pages for instruction,  
or press  
SET RELAY ORG. REPT.  
1.ALWAYS  
PRINT 1ST PG IMAGE?  
1.ON  
2.ON ERROR  
3.OFF  
2.OFF  
to exit the Report Setting mode  
and return to the Standby Mode.  
201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Relay Station Transmission Report Setting  
Display the RELAY  
STN. REPORT Menu  
Set the Option for  
Relay Hub Station  
Set the Option for  
First Page Image  
1
2
3
Press:  
Select the option to print a re-  
To print a first page image of the  
port when the DP120F/DP125F document, press:  
is used as a relay hub station.  
This report is printed by the hub  
unit after a relay transmission to  
end terminals.  
+
+
+
+
+
+
To not print a first page image of  
the document, press:  
To ALWAYS print  
press:  
a
report,  
To only print a report when an  
error has occurred, press:  
The following screen is dis-  
played to confirm your selection.  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
To turn OFF automatic printing  
of reports, press:  
After completing the Relay Sta-  
tion Transmission Report Set-  
ting, you may continue to select  
other Report settings referring to  
their associated pages for in-  
struction, or press  
Go to Step 12.  
SET RELAY STN. REPT.  
1.ALWAYS  
PRINT 1ST PG IMAGE?  
1.ON  
2.ON ERROR  
3.OFF  
2.OFF  
to exit the Report Setting mode  
and return to the Standby Mode.  
202  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Relay Destination Report Setting  
Display the RELAY  
DEST. REPORT Menu  
Select the Option  
for End Terminal  
Set the Option for  
First Page Image  
1
2
3
To send a first page image of  
the facsimile document, press:  
Press:  
Select the desired option to  
send a Relay result report to the  
Originator terminal when this  
DP120F/DP125F is the hub unit  
used in a relay transmission.  
This is only applicable if the  
DP120F/DP125F is used as a  
Hub unit for the relay transmis-  
sion.  
+
+
+
+
+
+
To not send a first page image  
of the facsimile document,  
press:  
To ALWAYS send a report to  
the Originator, press:  
The following screen is dis-  
played to confirm your selection.  
To only send a report when an  
error has occurred, press:  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
To turn OFF Automatic sending  
of report, press:  
After completing the Relay Des-  
tination Report Setting, you may  
continue to select other Report  
settings referring to their associ-  
ated pages for instruction, or  
press  
SET RELAY END REPORT  
1.ALWAYS  
PRINT 1ST PG IMAGE?  
1.ON  
2.ON ERROR  
3.OFF  
2.OFF  
to exit the Report Setting mode  
and return to the Standby Mode.  
203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reception List Settings  
Display the  
RECEPTION LIST  
Menu  
Select the Job for  
Reception List  
LOCAL MAILBOX  
LIST  
REMOTE MAILBOX  
LIST  
RELAY RECEPTION  
LIST  
1
2
3
4
5
Press:  
Select the desired option.  
When “1.LOCAL MAILBOX” is  
selected in Step 2, the following  
screen displays.  
When “3.RELAY” is selected in  
Step 2, the following screen dis-  
plays.  
When “2.REMOTE MAILBOX”  
is selected in Step 2, the follow-  
ing screen displays.  
To select the LOCAL MAIL-  
BOX, press:  
+
+
+
+
LOCAL MAILBOX LIST  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
REMOTE MAILBOX LIST  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
RELAY RECEPTION LIST  
1.ON  
2.OFF  
+
Go to Step 3.  
To turn ON, press:  
To turn OFF, press:  
To turn ON, press:  
To turn OFF, press:  
To turn ON, press:  
To turn OFF, press:  
To select the REMOTE MAIL-  
BOX, press:  
+
Go to Step 4.  
To select the RELAY, press:  
01.LOCAL MAILBOX  
02.REMOTE MAILBOX  
03.RELAY  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
OPERATION COMPLETED  
+
Go to Step 5.  
204  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- LIST AND REPORT PRINT FORMAT AND PRINTING PROCEDURE  
Transmission/Reception Journal (Communication Journal)  
Transmission/Reception Journal  
shows the result of each com-  
munication for up to the past  
150 transmissions/receptions.  
Facsimile/Telephone Number  
“TO” is replaced with “FROM”  
of this facsimile unit, Line 1  
in a RECEPTION JOURNAL  
Facsimile/Telephone Number  
of this facsimile unit, Line 2  
Machine Counter  
Information  
Time of output of this  
list or report  
List/Report Name  
Printing Procedure  
TRANSMISSION JOURNAL  
Auto Print (available if pro-  
grammed; see page 195):  
PAGE  
TIME  
:001  
: MAY-17-00 14:25  
Your Station’s  
ID Name  
TEL NUMBER1:12345678901234567890  
TEL NUMBER2:12345678901234567890  
NAME  
SCAN COUNT :1234 (000004D2)  
PRINT COUNT:2345 (00000929)  
DRUM COUNT :3456 (00000D80)  
Printing will automatically  
start whenever 150 transmis-  
sions (or 150 receptions) are  
completed.  
:ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ12345678901234  
NBR. FILE NBR  
001 020  
DATE  
TIME  
DURATION PGS  
59/59 099  
TO  
+1234567890  
DEPT NBR  
01  
ACCOUNT MODE  
9999 G3 502 P  
STATUS  
NG 20  
Manual Print (always available;  
see page 196):  
MAY-17 14:01  
VERY IMPORTANT:  
Up to date Activity Journals  
must be maintained by the  
user. In the event an elec-  
tronic circuit board must be  
replaced in this unit, informa-  
tion pertaining to Scan, Print,  
and Drum counters must be  
entered into the replacement  
electronic circuit board. This  
information is listed at the  
top of every journal.  
Date and Time the  
communication  
started  
Remote Station’s  
Account No.  
Serial No.  
Error Code  
Fax/Telephone Num-  
ber (“ ” is alternate  
number or sub-ad-  
dress dial was used.)  
(printed only when the  
Account Number op-  
tion is ON and used)  
(lists the trans-  
missions in the  
order they took  
place)  
Result:  
OK (successful)  
NG (failure)  
Length of each  
transaction:  
Minutes/Seconds  
P
= Polling  
SR, R = Relay Communication  
SB = Mailbox Communication  
Communication Mode  
G3 = G3  
EC = ECM  
EX  
Number of Pages  
1st  
2nd  
3rd  
(bps) (Resolution) (Mode)  
Department No.  
= ECM with shortened  
protocol  
File No.  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
8
2400  
4800  
7200  
9600  
12000 16x15.4  
14400  
8x3.85  
8x7.7  
8x15.4  
-
MH  
MR  
MMR  
JBIG  
(indicates the depart-  
ment responsible for  
this transmission job;  
printed only when the  
Department Control  
option is ON)  
(assigned to all com-  
munication jobs at the  
time of scanning)  
HW, HR= RDC communication  
(“ ” is 2nd line communication)  
V.34  
300dpi  
205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transmission/Reception Journal (Communication Journal) - continued  
Manual Print  
Display the PRINT  
NUMBER Menu  
Select the Option  
Printing will start when  
1
2
is pressed with no  
document loaded in the  
Document Tray.  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
Select one of the following op-  
erations from the menu.  
To print the 50 communication  
Journal, press:  
Press:  
PRINT NUMBER  
1.1-50 (1 PAGE)  
2.1-100 (2 PAGES)  
3.1-150 (3 PAGES)  
To print the 100 communication  
Journal, press:  
To print the 150 communication  
Journal, press:  
206  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transmission Report  
This is the result report printed  
after a Direct Transmission (a  
job transmitted directly from the  
document feeder instead of  
from memory).  
TRANSMISSION REPORT  
Printing Procedure  
PAGE  
TIME  
:001  
:MAY-17-00 14:25  
TEL NUMBER1:12345678901234567890  
TEL NUMBER2:12345678901234567890  
Auto Print (if programmed, see  
page 197):  
NAME  
:ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ12345678901234  
Printing will automatically  
start after a transmission is  
completed.  
NBR. FILE NBR DATE  
TIME  
DURATION PGS  
TO  
DEPT NBR ACOUNT  
MODE  
STATUS  
NG 20  
001 020 MAY-17 14:01  
00/58  
002  
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRST  
G3 512  
The print format is the same as that for the Transmission Journal on the preceding page except that the record of the  
only last transmission job is issued in a Transmission Report.  
207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Memory Transmission Report  
This is the result report printed  
after a Memory Transmission.  
(A job transmitted after the  
document is first scanned into  
memory.)  
MEMORY TRANSMISSION REPORT  
PAGE  
TIME  
:001  
:MAY-17-00 14:25  
Printing Procedure  
TEL NUMBER1:12345678901234567890  
TEL NUMBER2:12345678901234567890  
NAME  
:ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ12345678901234  
Auto Print (if programmed, see  
page 198):  
FILE NUMBER  
DATE  
: 070  
Printing will automatically  
start after a transmission is  
completed.  
: MAY-17 14:18  
: ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRST  
: 02  
TO  
DOCUMENT PAGES  
START TIME  
END TIME  
SENT PAGES  
STATUS  
: MAY-17 14:20  
: MAY-17 14:23  
: 02  
: OK  
File Number of the transmission job  
Date and time when the job is accepted  
Remote Party’s Name or Facsimile/Tele-  
phone Number  
Number of pages input to memory  
Time when the transmission started  
Time when the transmission ended (the  
time when a Recovery Transmission is  
designated)  
Number of pages transmitted normally  
Transmission result  
208  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reservation List  
This is a listing of the communi-  
cation jobs now reserved in  
memory.  
RESERVATION LIST  
PAGE  
TIME  
:001  
:MAY-17-00 14:25  
Printing Procedure  
TEL NUMBER1:12345678901234567890  
TEL NUMBER2:12345678901234567890  
NAME  
:ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ12345678901234  
Manual Print  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
TX/RX  
FILE NBR FUNCTION  
PGS MAIL DATE  
TIME  
TO  
001  
MULTI TX  
003  
MAY-16 11:55 TEL NBR:123456789012345678901234567890  
1234567890  
ABB.NBR:001 002 003 004 005 006 007  
GROUP :0001 0002 0003 0004 0005 0006  
MAY-16 22:50 ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRST  
OT NBR :01  
Press:  
005  
009  
010  
POLLING RX  
RELAY STATION  
MULTIPOLLING  
001  
MAY-16 22:25 GROUP :1001 1002 1999  
POLLING/FAX MAILBOX FILE NBR FUNCTION  
961 POLLING  
PGS MAIL DATE  
TIME  
TO  
TO  
099 MAY-13 17:30  
RECOVERY TX  
PC JOB  
FILE NBR FUNCTION  
PGS MAIL DATE  
TIME  
970  
SINGLE TX MAY-15  
14:20 123-4567  
FILE NBR FUNCTION  
PGS MAIL DATE  
TIME  
TO  
Box Number  
(in case of Mailbox  
communication)  
Destination  
(Name or Dial Number of the  
Remote Party)  
Type of  
communication  
File Number of the  
communication  
Designated Time, or  
Time of Reception  
Number of Pages  
209  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Multi-Address Transmission Report  
This is the result report printed  
after a Multi-address Transmis-  
sion.  
MULTI TRANSMISSION REPORT  
PAGE  
TIME  
:001  
:MAY-17-00 14:25  
Printing Procedure  
TEL NUMBER1:  
TEL NUMBER2:  
12345678901234567890  
12345678901234567890  
NAME  
:
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ12345678901234  
Auto Print (if programmed; see  
FILE NUMBER  
DATE  
: 005  
page 199):  
: MAY-17 14:18  
: 15  
Printing will automatically  
start after all transmissions  
in the operation have been  
completed successfully or  
unsuccessfully.  
DOCUMENT PAGES  
START TIME  
END TIME  
: MAY-17 10:56  
: MAY-17 14:18(RECOVERY TIME:MAY-17 14:18)  
SUCCESSFUL  
GROUP NUMBER  
0001  
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRST  
ABB. 001 002 003 004 005 006 007 008  
009 010  
OT  
02  
05  
ONE TOUCH NUMBER  
01  
TSRQRPONMLKJIHGFEDCBA  
12345678901234567890  
TEL NUMBER  
UNSUCCESSFUL  
SENT PAGES  
GROUP NUMBER  
0002  
AABBCCDDEEFFGGHHIIJJ  
0T  
33  
AAABBBCCCDDDEEEFFFGG  
01  
Receiver where an error occurred  
SENT PAGES ... Number of pages sent normally  
Receiver where the transmission was completed normally  
210  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Multi-Polling Report  
This is the result report printed  
after a Multi-polling Reception.  
MULTI POLLING REPORT  
PAGE  
TIME  
TEL NUMBER1:  
TEL NUMBER2:  
:001  
:MAY-17-00 14:25  
Printing Procedure  
12345678901234567890  
12345678901234567890  
NAME  
:
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ12345678901234  
Auto Print (if programmed, see  
FILE NUMBER  
DATE  
:
:
:
:
:
005  
page 200):  
MAY-17 14:18  
15  
Printing will automatically  
start after all polling opera-  
tions have been completed  
successfully or unsuccess-  
fully.  
DOCUMENT PAGES  
START TIME  
END TIME  
MAY-17 10:56  
MAY-17 14:18  
(RECOVERY TIME:MAY-17 14:18)  
SUCCESSFUL  
GROUP NUMBER  
0001  
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRST  
ABB. 001 002 003 004 005 006 007 008  
009 010  
OT  
02 05  
ABB. NUMBER  
014  
HONG KONG OFFICE  
TEL NUMBER  
1234567890123456789  
UNSUCCESSFUL  
PAGES  
SENT  
GROUP NUMBER  
0002  
AABBCCDDEEFFGGHHIIJJ  
0T  
33 AAABBBCCCDDDEEEFFFGG  
01  
Receiver where an error occurred  
SENT PAGES ... Number of pages sent normally  
Receiver where the transmission was completed normally  
211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Relay Transmission Originator Report  
This is the result report the  
Originating Terminal prints after  
a Relay Transmission.  
RELAY TX ORIGINATOR TERMINAL REPORT  
PAGE  
TIME  
:001  
:MAY-17-00 14:25  
Printing Procedure  
TEL NUMBER1:12345678901234567890  
TEL NUMBER2:12345678901234567890  
NAME  
:ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ12345678901234  
Auto Print (if programmed, see  
page 201):  
FILE NUMBER  
DATE  
:
:
:
:
:
009  
MAY-17 10:55  
15  
Printing will automatically  
start after the originating sta-  
tion transmits to all of the  
assigned relay stations, suc-  
cessfully or unsuccessfully.  
DOCUMENT PAGES  
START TIME  
END TIME  
MAY-17 10:56  
MAY-17 14:18  
(RECOVERY TIME:MAY-17 14:10)  
SUCCESSFUL  
GROUP NUMBER  
0012  
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRST  
OT  
01 02  
ABB. 001 002 003 004 005 006 007 008  
009 010  
UNSUCCESSFUL  
GROUP NUMBER  
0014  
SENT PAGES  
01  
AABBCCDDEEFFGGHHIIJJ  
0T  
03 AAABBBCCCDDDEEEFFFGG  
ABB. 011 123-45678901234567890123456789  
012 SEATTLE PLANT  
14  
09  
Each Relay Group to which the Relay Transmission was not completed  
SENT PAGES ... Number of pages sent normally  
Each Relay Group to which the Relay Transmission was performed successfully  
Group Number, Relay Station Name or Number, End Terminal One Touch or Abbreviated Dial Numbers  
NOTE:  
The format sample above is obtained when a Relay Transmission was performed with Group designations.  
When a Relay Transmission is performed with individual designations, the Group Number print is skipped.  
212  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Relay Transmission Relay Station Report  
This is the Relay Station result  
report, output by the Relay Sta-  
tion and printed after a Relay  
Transmission  
RELAY TX RELAY STATION REPORT  
PAGE  
TIME  
:001  
:MAY-17-00 14:25  
TEL NUMBER1:12345678901234567890  
TEL NUMBER2:12345678901234567890  
Printing Procedure  
NAME  
:ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ12345678901234  
FILE NUMBER  
DATE  
:
:
:
:
:
011  
Auto Print (if programmed, see  
page 202):  
MAY-17 10:55  
15  
DOCUMENT PAGES  
START TIME  
END TIME  
Printing will automatically  
start after the relay station in  
a relay operation completes  
all of the transmissions as-  
signed to it, successfully or  
unsuccessfully.  
MAY-17 10:56  
MAY-17 14:18 (RECOVERY TIME:MAY-17 15:18)  
SUCCESSFUL  
GROUP NUMBER  
0012  
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRST  
OT  
02 03  
ABB. 001 002 003 004 005 006 007 008  
009 010  
UNSUCCESSFUL  
ONE TOUCH NUMBER  
01  
PAGES SENT  
000  
AABBCCDDEEFFGGHHIIJJ  
Each Relay Group to which the Relay Transmission was not completed  
SENT PAGES ... Number of pages sent normally  
Each Relay Group to which the Relay Transmission was performed successfully  
Group Number, Relay Station Name or Number, End Terminal One Touch or Abbreviated Dial Numbers  
NOTE:  
The format sample above is obtained when a Relay Transmission was performed with Group designations.  
When a Relay Transmission is performed with individual designations, the Group Number print is skipped.  
213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Relay Transmission End Terminal Report  
This is the End Terminal result  
report sent from the Relay Sta-  
tion to the Originating Terminal  
and printed by the Originating  
Terminal.  
RELAY TX END TERMINAL REPORT  
PAGE  
TIME  
:001  
:MAY-17-00 14:25  
TEL NUMBER1:12345678901234567890  
TEL NUMBER2:12345678901234567890  
Printing Procedure  
NAME  
:ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ12345678901234  
FILE NUMBER  
DATE  
:
:
:
:
:
013  
Auto Print (if programmed, see  
page 203):  
MAY-17 10:55  
15  
DOCUMENT PAGES  
START TIME  
END TIME  
Printing will automatically  
start after the relay station’s  
report on the success or fail-  
ure of the individual commu-  
nications in the relay opera-  
tion.  
MAY-17 10:56  
MAY-17 14:18  
(RECOVERY TIME:MAY-17 14:10)  
SUCCESSFUL  
GROUP NUMBER  
0012  
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRST  
OT  
01 02  
ABB. 001 002 003 004 005 006 007 008  
009 010  
UNSUCCESSFUL  
PAGES  
SENT  
GROUP NUMBER  
0014  
AABBCCDDEEFFGGHHIIJJ  
0T  
03 AAABBBCCCDDDEEEFFFGG  
01  
14  
09  
ABB. 011 123-45678901234567890123456789  
012 SEATTLE PLANT  
Each Relay Group to which the Relay Transmission was not completed  
SENT PAGES ... Number of pages sent normally  
Each Relay Group to which the Relay Transmission was performed successfully  
Group Number, Relay Station Name or Number, End Terminal One Touch or Abbreviated Dial Numbers  
NOTE:  
The format sample above is obtained when a Relay Transmission was performed with Group designations.  
When a Relay Transmission is performed with individual designations, the Group Number print is skipped.  
214  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Relay Reception List  
The list is output on the Relay  
Station upon receiving a relay  
request.  
Printing Procedure  
RELAY RECEPTION LIST  
PAGE  
TIME  
:001  
: MAY-17-00 14:25  
Auto Print (if programmed, see  
page 204):  
TEL NUMBER1:12345678901234567890  
TEL NUMBER2:12345678901234567890  
NAME  
:ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ12345678901234  
Printing will automatically  
start upon receiving a re-  
quest to perform a relay op-  
eration.  
FILE NUMBER  
DATE  
: 045  
: MAY-17 20:31  
: 00001 0002 0003 0004  
: 12  
GROUP NUMBER  
DOCUMENT PAGES  
FROM  
: +1234567890123456789  
File Number assigned by the Relay Station when the  
Relay request is received by the Relay Station  
Time and Date the Relay request is received  
Relay Group Numbers  
Number of documents received to memory by the Re-  
lay station  
Originator Terminal Name or Dial Number  
215  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mailbox/Relay Box (ITU-T Compatible F-code Communication) List  
Issues a list of the documents  
reserved through the local (i.e.,  
your own) station and remote  
stations, using the Open Mail-  
box System (ITU-T Compatible  
F-code Communication).  
MAILBOX/RELAY BOX REPORT  
PAGE  
TIME  
:001  
:MAY-17-00 14:25  
TEL NUMBER1 :12345678901234567890  
TEL NUMBER2 :12345678901234567890  
Printing Procedure  
NAME  
:ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ12345678901234  
MAILBOX  
BOX NBR  
To display the main menu,  
press:  
TYPE  
CONFIDENTIAL BOX  
PGS FILE NBR DATE  
TIME  
FROM  
12345678901234567890  
*123##456*  
025  
001  
012  
099  
033  
001  
099  
111  
198  
173  
MAY-15 22:30 12345678901234567890  
MAY-16 08:17 REMOTE  
MAY-16 11:50 +811234567  
MAY-16 19:37 LOCAL  
CONFIDENTIAL BOX  
###999***  
BULLETIN BOARD  
MAY-17 07:43 LOCAL  
1.COMM. OPTIONS  
2.LISTS  
3.INITIAL SETUP  
4.DEFAULT SETTING  
Box No.  
Mailbox Type  
File No.  
Document Originator ID  
LOCAL .................. Your Own Station  
Other indication ....Remote station’s ID  
Name or Dial Number  
Number of Document  
pages entered  
Date and Time the  
Document was entered  
To select “2.LISTS,” press:  
1.FUNCTION  
2.DEPARTMENT  
3.ITU MAILBOX  
RELAY  
RELAY BOX  
END STATION  
REPLY TO NUMBER  
3333  
ABB.  
OT  
001  
01  
OT  
01  
GROUP  
0001  
Then, to select “3.ITU MAIL-  
BOX,” press:  
End station  
Number to send Relay  
Transmission Report  
Box No.  
216  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Department Control List  
Available only when the Department Control Mode option is selected.  
Issues a list of Department  
Codes and data processed for  
the Department Control Mode.  
Printing Procedure  
DEPARTMENT CODE LIST  
PAGE  
TIME  
:001  
:MAY-17-00 14:25  
To display the main menu,  
press:  
TEL NUMBER1 :12345678901234567890  
TEL NUMBER2 :12345678901234567890  
NAME  
:ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ12345678901234  
DEPT NBR  
NAME  
DEPT CODE  
TX PGS  
RX PGS  
COPY PGS  
EMAILS SENT  
1.COMM. OPTIONS  
2.LISTS  
3.INITIAL SETUP  
4.DEFAULT SETTINGS ↓  
01  
02  
14  
15  
20  
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRST  
OPERATION CENTER  
SYSTEM DESIGN  
XYZ  
12345  
82615  
12131  
33151  
99990  
123456  
296541  
88888  
6543  
1
123456  
12104  
88887  
12109  
4
123456  
99999  
988886  
450  
123456  
2345  
4321  
1324  
6
7
To select “2.LISTS,” press:  
Department  
Name  
Department Code  
for operating the  
department  
Department  
No.  
Sent  
Received  
Copied  
E-Mali send  
Accumulated number of pages operated by  
the department  
1.FUNCTION  
2.DEPARTMENT  
3.ITU MAILBOX  
NOTE:  
The list shown is produced when the Master code (01) is used to initiate the print list operation. If a  
user code (02-99) is used, only the data relating to that department will be printed.  
Then, to select “2.DEPART-  
MENT,” press:  
217  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Preset Dialing Number Lists  
These are listings of the preset  
Abbreviated Dial Numbers, One  
Touch Keys, Multi-address  
All of Lists  
The following will be printed. For the print format and description of printed items, see the page listed  
below:  
Issues all four lists, one after  
another, in one operation se-  
quence.  
Groups, and Alphabetical sort.  
You can request all of these  
lists (except Alphabetical Sort  
List) as part of one operation se-  
quence or individually one by  
one.  
• Abbreviated Dial Number List  
• Group Number List  
(page 220)  
(page 221)  
(page 222)  
• One Touch Number List  
Printing Procedure  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
Press:  
To select “5.ALL REPORT,”  
press:  
218  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Preset Dialing Number Lists - continued  
Alphabetical Sort List  
Issues a listing of names pro-  
grammed to Abbreviated Dial  
Numbers, One Touch Keys, and  
Group Numbers.  
PHONEBOOK IN ALPHABETICAL ORDER  
PAGE  
TIME  
:001  
:MAY-17-00 14:25  
TEL NUMBER1 :12345678901234567890  
TEL NUMBER2 :12345678901234567890  
Printing Procedure  
NAME  
:ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ12345678901234  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
NAME  
LOCATION  
OT 01  
FAX NUMBER/E-MAIL ADDRESS  
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRST  
1234567890123456789012345678901234567890  
0987654321  
SUB:09876543210987654321  
SEP:998877665544  
Press:  
PWD:********************  
1234567890123456789012345678901234567890  
1234567  
BCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRST  
ABB. 001  
Chicago Group  
GREENVILLE OFFICE  
NEW YORK OFFICE  
GROUP 0001  
ABB. 109  
ABB. 900  
999999999  
333-912345678  
TELEPHONE NBRS LIST  
1.BY NAME  
2.ABB. NUMBERS  
3.GROUP NUMBERS  
Names of Abbreviated  
Dial Number, One  
Touch Key or Group  
Number  
Station Dial Number/E-Mail Address  
....... Alternate Dial Number  
4.ONE TOUCH NBRS  
5.ALL REPORT  
SUB, SEP, or PWD  
.......... Type of Sub-address  
To select “1.BY NAME,” press:  
OT ............ One Touch Key Numbers  
ABB. ......... Abbreviated Dial Numbers  
Group ....... Group Number  
219  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Preset Dialing Number Lists - continued  
Abbreviated Dial Number List  
Issues a list of remote station  
dialing numbers assigned as  
Abbreviated Dial Numbers.  
ABBREVIATED TEL NUMBER LIST  
Printing Procedure  
PAGE  
TIME  
:001  
:MAY-17-00 14:25  
TEL NUMBER1:12345678901234567890  
TEL NUMBER2:12345678901234567890  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
NAME  
:ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ12345678901234  
ABB.NBRNAME  
TEL NUMBER/E-MAIL ADDRESS  
TIME MONI BPS REPORT LINE MAILMODE  
Press:  
001  
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRST  
1234567890123456789012345678901234567890  
23:45 ON  
144  
ON  
1
1234567  
0987654321  
SUB:12345678901234567890  
SEP:112233445566  
PWD:********************  
TELEPHONE NBRS LIST  
1.BY NAME  
2.ABB. NUMBERS  
3.GROUP NUMBERS  
109  
900  
GREENVILLE OFFICE  
999999999  
333-912345678  
09:30 OFF  
96  
OFF  
Station  
Name  
4.ONE TOUCH NBRS  
5.ALL REPORT  
Station Dial Number:  
... Alternate Dial Number  
Abbreviated  
Dial Number  
SUB, SEP, or PWD  
To select “2.ABB. NUMBERS,”  
press:  
... Type of Sub-address  
Designated Time  
Line Monitoring  
Communication Speed  
Limit (x 100)  
TX Report Issue/Non-issue  
Status  
Attached Fax Option Status (if any)  
220  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Preset Dialing Number Lists - continued  
Group Number List  
Issues a list of One Touch Key  
or Abbreviated Dial Numbers  
registered  
in  
Multi-address  
Groups or Multi-polling Groups.  
GROUP NUMBER INFORMATION  
PAGE  
TIME  
:001  
:MAY-17-00 14:25  
TEL NUMBER1:12345678901234567890  
TEL NUMBER2:12345678901234567890  
Printing Procedure  
NAME  
:ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ12345678901234  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
GROUP NUMBER NAME  
OT/ABB. NUMBER  
0001  
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRST  
OT  
01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 10 11 12 13 14 15  
16 17 18 19 20  
001 002 003 004 005 006 007 008 009 010 011 012 013 014 015  
Press:  
ABB.  
016 017 018 019 020 021 022 023 024 025 026 027 028 029 030  
031 032 033 034 999  
100 200 300 400 500  
31 32 33  
1111  
1999  
ABBCCCDDDDEEEEE  
ZZZZZ  
ABB.  
OT  
ABB.  
995 996 997 998 999  
TELEPHONE NBRS LIST  
1.BY NAME  
2.ABB. NUMBERS  
3.GROUP NUMBERS  
Group Number  
One Touch Key Numbers and Abbreviated Dial  
Numbers belonging to the Group:  
4.ONE TOUCH NBRS  
5.ALL REPORT  
OT .... One Touch Key Numbers  
ABB. .... Abbreviated Dial Numbers  
Group Name  
To select “3.GROUP NUM-  
BERS,” press:  
221  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Preset Dialing Number Lists - continued  
One Touch Number List  
Issues a list of dial numbers of  
the remote stations assigned to  
One Touch Dial Keys.  
ONE TOUCH NUMBER INFORMATION  
Printing Procedure  
PAGE  
TIME  
:001  
:MAY-17-00 14:25  
TEL NUMBER1:12345678901234567890  
TEL NUMBER2:12345678901234567890  
Turn the Flip Panel to the “50-  
73” view to select the desired  
Function Key.  
NAME  
:ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ12345678901234  
TIME MONI BPS REPORT LINE MAILMODE  
23:45 ON 144 ON  
OT NBR NAME/FUNCTION  
ABB. FAX NUMBER & E-MAIL  
01  
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRST1234567890123456789012345678901234567890  
2
Press:  
1234567  
0987654321  
SUB:12345678901234567890  
SEP:112233445566  
PWD:********************  
09  
22  
35  
ABB.NBR  
GROUP NBR  
REDFIELD HS  
170  
0123  
9-1-605-1234567  
23:40  
TELEPHONE NBRS LIST  
1.BY NAME  
2.ABB. NUMBERS  
3.GROUP NUMBERS  
One Touch  
Key Number  
4.ONE TOUCH NBRS  
5.ALL REPORT  
Station Name, or  
use of the key  
Designated Time  
Line Monitoring  
To select “4.ONE TOUCH  
NBRS,” press:  
Communication Speed  
Limit (x 100)  
Abbreviated Dial Number,  
Group Number, or actual  
Dial Number  
TX Report Issue/Non-issue  
Status  
... Alternate Dial Number  
SUB, SEP, or PWD  
Attached Facsimile Option Status (if any)  
... Type of Sub-address  
222  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Function List  
Issues a list to confirm the func-  
tions currently set in this fac-  
simile unit.  
FUNCTION LIST  
PAGE  
TIME  
:001  
:MAY-17-00 14:25  
TEL NUMBER1:12345678901234567890  
TEL NUMBER2:12345678901234567890  
Printing Procedure  
NAME  
:ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ12345678901234  
RX SETTINGS  
SECURE RX  
MEMORY RX  
DIAL TYPE(LINE1)  
DIAL TYPE(LINE2)  
CALL NUMBER  
KEYBOARD TYPE  
MEMORY SIZE  
:MF  
:MF  
:
:QWERTY  
: 8MB  
:OFF  
:ON  
:ON  
To display the main menu,  
press:  
RX REDUCTION  
DISCARD  
:ON  
REV.ORDER PRINT  
PRIVILEGED RX  
RTI  
:OFF  
:OFF  
:OFF  
: 1  
MACHINE SETTING  
RINGER VOLUME  
ALARM VOLUME  
:4  
:3  
RX MULTI COPY  
KEY TOUCH VOLUME  
MONITOR VOLUME  
SUPER POWER SAVER  
PRINTER POWER SAVER  
START TIME  
:4  
:4  
:MANUAL  
:ON  
:00:00  
:00:00  
:OFF  
:OFF  
:OFF  
:AUTO  
:OFF  
: 0  
1.COMM. OPTIONS  
2.LISTS  
3.INITIAL SETUP  
4.DEFAULT SETTINGS ↓  
REPORT & LIST  
JOURNAL  
MANUAL  
:TX & RX  
:ON  
AUTO  
FAX/POLL/RELAY REPORTS  
END TIME  
COMMUNICATION REPORT:ON ERROR  
FAX SEPARATOR PAGE  
COPY SEPARATOR PAGE  
PC SEPARATOR PAGE  
SEPARATOR PAGE TRAY  
ACCOUNT CODE  
PRINT DENSITY  
DOCUMENT LENGTH  
LINE MONITOR  
RECEIVE INTERVAL  
ECM  
DOCUMENT MODE  
CONTRAST  
COLLATED COPY  
LETTER HEAD PAPER  
REDIAL MODE INTERVAL  
REDIAL MODE COUNTER  
AUTO RECEIVE MODE  
RING DELAY  
A5 SIZE PRINT  
MEMORY TX  
A5 SIZE PRINT  
MULTI TX  
:OFF  
:ON ERROR(IMAGE)  
:OFF  
:ON ERROR(IMAGE)  
:ON ERROR  
:ON ERROR(IMAGE)  
:ON ERROR(IMAGE)  
:ON ERROR(IMAGE)  
To select “2.LISTS,” press:  
MULTI POLL  
RELAY ORIGINATOR  
RELAY STATION  
RELAY DESTINATION  
:1m  
:OFF  
: 3MIN  
:ON  
:STD  
:NORMAL  
:OFF  
:OFF  
: 1MIN  
: 5  
1.FUNCTION  
2.DEPARTMENT  
3.ITU MAILBOX  
RECEPTION LIST  
LOCAL MAILBOX  
REMOTE MAILBOX  
RELAY STATION  
:OFF  
:OFF  
:ON  
REMOTE SERVICE  
Then, to select “1.FUNCTION,”  
press:  
REMOTE ACCESS  
DOWNLOAD  
RDC PASSWORD  
:OFF  
:NO JOB  
:
:AUTO  
: 1  
AUTO RECEIVE MODE(LINE2):TX/RX  
TOTAL PAGE  
SCAN  
PRINT  
:237  
:231  
TX SETTINGS  
MEMORY TX  
:ON  
SECURITY TX  
COVER SHEET  
RECOVERY TX  
TTI  
:OFF  
:OFF  
:OFF  
:INSIDE  
:OFF  
SEND AFTER SCAN  
223  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Menu List  
Issues a list of menu items  
through which functions or op-  
tions can be set.  
MENU LIST  
PAGE  
TIME  
:001  
:MAY-17-00 14:25  
This list can be a useful guide  
during machine programming.  
TEL NUMBER1:12345678901234567890  
TEL NUMBER2:12345678901234567890  
NAME  
:ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ12345678901234  
Printing Procedure  
1.COMM. OPTIONS  
1.PAGE NUMBER  
2.LINE MONITOR  
3.TURNAROUND POLL  
4.ECM  
3.RX SETTINGS  
01.SECURE RX  
02.MEMORY RX  
03.RX REDUCTION  
04.DISCARD  
05.REV.ORDER PRINT  
06.PRIVILEGED RX  
07.RTI  
To display the main menu,  
press:  
5.SECURITY TX  
2.LISTS  
1.FUNCTION  
2.DEPARTMENT  
3.ITU MAILBOX  
3.INITIAL SETUP  
1.LANGUAGE  
08.RX MULTI COPY  
4.REPORTS & LIST  
01.JOURNAL  
02.COMM. REPORT  
01.TX REPORT  
2.DATE & TIME  
3.TERMINAL ID  
4.DIAL TYPE  
1.COMM. OPTIONS  
2.LISTS  
3.INITIAL SETUP  
4.DEFAULT SETTINGS ↓  
02.MEMORY-TX REPORT  
03.MULTI-ADD REPORT  
04.MULTIPOLL REPORT  
05.RELAY ORG.REP  
06.RELAY STN.REP  
07.SET RELAY END REP  
03.RECEPTION LIST  
01.LOCAL MAILBOX  
02.REMOTE MAILBOX  
03.RELAY  
4.DEFAULT SETTING  
1.MACHINE SETTINGS  
01.SPEAKER VOLUME  
01.RINGER VOLUME  
02.ALARM VOLUME  
03.KEY TOUCH VOLUME  
04.MONITOR VOLUME  
02.POWER SAVER  
5.MENU LIST  
9.TEST MODE  
03.SEPARATOR PAGE  
04.DEPARTMENT CODE  
05.ACCOUNT CODE  
06.PRINTER DENSITY  
07.DOCUMENT LENGTH  
08.LINE MONITOR  
09.RECEIVE INTERVAL  
10.ECM  
5.REMOTE SERVICE  
To select “5.MENU LIST,”  
press:  
01.REMOTE ACCESS  
02.DOWNLOAD  
03.RDC PASSWORD  
04.SUPPLY ORDER  
5.MENU LIST  
9.TEST MODE  
1.AUTO TEST  
11.DOCUMENT MODE  
12.COLLATE COPY  
13.LETTER HEAD PAPER  
14.REDIAL MODE  
2.INDIVIDUAL TEST  
01.ADF TEST  
02.KEY TEST  
03.LED TEST  
01.INTERVAL  
04.LCD TEST  
02.COUNTER  
05.SPEAKER TEST  
15.AUTO RECEIVE MODE  
16.LINE-2 MODE  
06.SWITCH TEST  
07.TEST PRINT  
2.TX SETTINGS  
3.TEST RESULT LIST  
01.MEMORY TX  
02.SECURITY TX  
224  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power Failure List  
This facsimile has a battery to  
back up the document memory  
contents. However, when the  
power is turned off for a lengthy  
period (due to a power failure,  
etc.), the communication data  
stored in memory will be  
cleared. A list of the File Num-  
bers of those cleared communi-  
cations will be printed.  
POWER FAILURE LIST  
PAGE  
TIME  
TEL NUMBER1:  
TEL NUMBER2:  
:001  
:MAY-17-00 14:25  
12345678901234567890  
12345678901234567890  
NAME  
:
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ12345678901234  
TX/RX  
FILE NBR  
FUNCTION  
001  
005  
006  
010  
MULTI TX  
POLLING RX  
PRG. CONT POLL  
MULTI POLLING  
Printing Procedure  
POLLING/FAX M-BOX/MAIL BOX FILE NBR  
FUNCTION  
MAIL  
FROM  
DATE  
MAY-16  
MAY-17  
MAY-17  
TIME  
11:23  
07:55  
07:55  
This list is automatically printed  
after recovery from a power fail-  
ure event.  
101  
106  
107  
POLLING  
CONFIDENTIAL BOX  
BULLETIN BOARD  
LOCAL  
*1234567890#12345678 9999999999999  
###***#123#999*  
LOCAL  
MEMORY RECEPTION  
RECOVERY TX  
FILE NBR  
222  
FUNCTION  
MAIL  
FROM/TO  
DATE  
TIME  
*1234567890123456789MAY-16  
21:37  
FILE NBR  
333  
FUNCTION  
SINGLE TX  
Type of  
communication  
Station where the  
communication or the  
Mailbox is input  
Time of Input  
Box Number  
File Number of the  
communication  
(in case of Mailbox  
communication)  
225  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TROUBLESHOOTING  
Error Messages  
If an abnormal condition arises  
Error Message  
Cause / Solution  
Error Message  
Cause / Solution  
in the facsimile or an incorrect  
operation is performed, an  
alarm buzzer is generated for  
about 4 seconds and a mes-  
sage to indicate the nature of  
the error appears in the LCD  
window. In that case, take cor-  
rective action according to the  
following table.  
Autodialer numbers and initial  
setting have been lost (due to a  
long period of power failure,  
etc.).  
The maximum number of manu-  
ally input phone numbers (100)  
has been reached.  
BROKEN  
REGISTRATION  
JOB MEMORY FULL  
Split your transmission into two  
or more jobs.  
There is not enough memory to  
perform the requested operation.  
MEMORY OVERFLOW  
Press  
to restore the idle  
state. If this Error Message is  
repeatedly displayed, machine  
programming has become cor-  
rupted. The machine must be re-  
initialized by a trained techni-  
cian. Call for service.  
Press  
to cancel the mes-  
sage. Do the operation over  
again with the Direct Document  
Transmission, or do the opera-  
tion again when enough residual  
memory is regained. If the prob-  
lem occurs frequently, you re-  
quire additional memory.  
A power failure occurred during a  
communication, etc. The con-  
tents of memory were cleared  
due to a long power-off condi-  
tion.  
POWER FAILURE  
DOCUMENT JAM  
PAPER JAM XX  
A document jam has occurred.  
A Power Failure List is printed.  
Confirm the list contents (see  
page 225).  
Remove the jammed document  
(see page 232).  
A recording paper jam has oc-  
curred (see page 228).  
SCANNER COVER OPEN  
TOP COVER OPEN  
The scanner cover is open.  
Firmly close the scanner cover.  
The top cover is open.  
Remove the jammed paper (see  
page 233).  
Firmly close the top cover.  
No paper exists in the upper pa-  
per tray.  
UPPER PAPER EMPTY  
MIDDLE PAPER EMPTY  
The memory set aside for speed  
dial numbers (i.e. One Touch  
Keys and Abbreviated Dial Num-  
bers) has been exhausted.  
ENTRY MEMORY FULL  
Supply recording paper to the  
upper paper tray.  
No paper exists in the middle re-  
cording paper tray.  
This error occurs only with two  
optional paper tray installed.  
Delete unneed numbers, alter-  
nate numbers, and unnecessary  
pauses. Use shorter names for  
the dialing addresses.  
Supply recording paper to the  
middle recording paper tray.  
226  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Error Messages - continued  
Cause / Solution  
Error Message  
Cause / Solution  
Error Message  
No paper exists in the lower paper tray. This  
error occurs with an optional paper tray in-  
stalled.  
Line-2 is not connected to the telephone line.  
LOWER PAPER EMPTY  
CHECK LINE-2 (Display only  
when Line-2 is installed)  
Correctly connect a modular phone cord be-  
tween the telephone line jack and the LINE2  
connector on the right side of the machine  
(see page 18).  
Supply recording paper to the lower paper tray.  
No recording paper exists in any paper tray.  
Supply recording paper to the paper tray(s).  
The toner is nearly exhausted (warning).  
Replace the toner.  
PAPER EMPTY  
TONER LOW  
NETWORK ERROR  
With the Optional NIC board installed, a net-  
work connection is not detected.  
Insure you have a proper network connection.  
If the same error message is displayed again,  
call your service representative.  
NETWORK DISABLED  
Optional NIC board is out of order. Network  
related features do not work.  
The toner is exhausted.  
TONER EMPTY  
DRUM UNIT WARNING  
Replace the toner (see page 28).  
Power your machine off, then back on. If the  
error condition is cleared, confirm normal op-  
eration. If the error condition returns, call your  
service representative.  
The drum unit is approaching the end of its life  
(warning).  
PCL DISABLED  
Optional PCL board is out of order. PCL print-  
ing do not work.  
Replace the drum unit (see page 31).  
The drum unit has reached the end of its life.  
Replace the drum unit (see page 31).  
No developer assembly exists.  
REPLACE DRUM UNIT  
CONFIRM DEV. UNIT  
CHECK LINE-1  
Power your machine off, then back on. If the  
error condition is cleared, confirm normal op-  
eration. If the error condition returns, call your  
service representative.  
The machine system is out of order.  
DEVICE ERROR XX  
Install a developer assembly.  
Power your machine off, then back on. If the  
error condition is cleared, confirm normal oper-  
ation. If the error condition returns, call your  
service representative.  
Line-1 is not connected to the telephone line.  
Correctly connect a modular phone cord be-  
tween the telephone line jack and the LINE1  
connector on the right side of the machine  
(see page 18).  
227  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Paper Jam Error Codes  
Paper jam error codes indicate where (within the machine) a recording paper jam  
has occurred using a 2-digit number.  
Error  
Code  
Cause  
How to Correct  
10  
A paper jam has occurred within Open the right-side access door  
the paper feed section of the Re- and clear any paper. Then, draw out  
cording Paper Tray (when an Op- the Recording Paper Tray (upper)  
tional Recording Paper Tray is in- and remove any jammed recording  
stalled: upper-tray).  
paper.  
20  
30  
A paper jam has occurred within Open the right-side access door  
the paper feed section of the mid- and clear any paper. Then, draw out  
dle recording paper tray.  
the Recording Paper Tray (middle)  
and remove any jammed recording  
paper.  
A paper jam has occurred within Open the right-side access door  
the paper feed section of the lower and clear any paper. Then, draw out  
recording paper tray.  
the Recording Paper Tray (lower)  
and remove any jammed recording  
paper.  
50  
80  
90  
A paper jam has occurred within Open the Top Cover, remove the  
the paper feed section of the By- Developer Assembly, and remove  
pass Tray.  
the jammed recording paper.  
A paper jam has occurred within Open the Top Cover, remove the  
the Drum/Developer section of the Developer Assembly, and remove  
paper transport path.  
the jammed recording paper.  
A paper jam has occurred within Open the Top Cover, remove the  
the paper exit section of the paper Developer Assembly, and remove  
transport path.  
the jammed recording paper.  
228  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Error Codes Printed on Reports  
When an Error Code is printed as a status indication on Transmission Reports, etc., refer to the following description for the applicable Error Code to determine the cause.  
Error  
Code  
Error  
Code  
Cause  
How to Correct  
Cause  
Memory Overflow  
How to Correct  
10  
11  
Paper Empty  
Load recording paper and set the  
tray.  
42  
Wait until the memory is recov-  
ered by completing some of the  
reserved jobs or remove other  
causes if any, then retry the com-  
munication. If problem is continu-  
al, acquire additional memory.  
Recording Paper Jam  
Document Paper Jam  
Open the top cover and clear the  
recording paper jam.  
12  
13  
Remove the jammed document.  
50  
53  
Line Busy  
Send the document again.  
Operation Panel or Top Cover  
Open  
Close the cover or the panel, then  
retry.  
Security Mismatch in Relay or Confirm the remote party’s securi-  
Mailbox transmission  
ty code, system password, and  
your setup.  
20  
Power Failure  
Retry the transmission or ask the  
remote party to transmit the docu-  
ment again.  
B0-B5 Signal Error or Line Condition Error Retry the communication. Fre-  
C0-C4  
D0-D2  
F0, F1  
quent failure may indicate a phone  
line problem. If possible, move the  
unit to another line and try your  
communications again.  
E0  
E6  
Error relating to the printer or mem- Remove the cause of the error on  
ory.  
the printer, if any. Then ask the re-  
mote party to retry the transmis-  
sion. If not corrected, call your ser-  
vice representative.  
87  
No residual memory was remain- Retry the transmission.  
ing on the remote party’s machine  
for Relay or Mailbox transmission.  
22  
30  
File Error due to a Directory Error  
was pressed during the com-  
Power the unit ON/OFF, then retry.  
Retry the transmission or ask the  
remote party to transmit the docu-  
ment again.  
munication.  
32  
33  
Page # Mismatch  
Check the actual document count.  
Polling Error  
Check polling options setup (securi-  
ty code, etc.), and check if the poll-  
ing document exists.  
229  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transmission Problems  
When transmissions are not performed normally, check the points in the table  
below. If the facsimile will not operate correctly after confirming these points or  
anything not listed here occurs, call your service representative.  
Problem  
Cause  
Solution  
When document pag-  
es are fed into the  
unit, two pages are  
drawn into the slot.  
Too many document pag- Set a maximum of 50 pages  
es are set.  
(Letter size) for one transmis-  
sion sequence.  
Problem  
Cause  
Solution  
When you place a doc- You have a machine er- Clear the error.  
ument in the document ror. Check the display for  
tray, nothing happens. an error message (see  
pages 226 and 227).  
The Scanner Cover is not Close the Scanner Cover until  
closed fully.  
it clicks at the two latching po-  
sitions.  
The document extension Extend it fully to support the  
Tray is not fully extended. document sufficiently.  
There is no power to the Make sure the power plug is  
facsimile.  
plugged into the AC outlet and  
the power switch is ON.  
Something is wrong with Check the document to see if  
the document paper itself. it satisfies machine require-  
ments (see page 87).  
When you press  
in Direct  
You returned the handset Send the document again be-  
before you pressed  
The ADF pad is dirty.  
Clean the ADF pad.  
ing sure to press  
(when using  
before returning the handset.  
the optional handset).  
The sending proce-  
dure was completed,  
but nothing was re-  
corded on the record-  
ing paper of the re-  
ceiving party or the  
image was elongated.  
The document was loaded Load the document face down.  
with a wrong side down.  
Document Transmis-  
sion Mode, the mes-  
sage “DIALING” or  
“COMMUNICATING”  
The Scanner Cover is not Close the Scanner Cover until  
closed fully.  
The modular cord (the Check the modular cord con-  
it clicks at the two latching po-  
sitions.  
does not appear on the telephone line cable) is nection between the wall  
LCD display. not correctly connected. socket and the facsimile.  
The Dial Type setting of Set the correct Dial Type in  
The sending proce-  
dure was completed  
correctly, but nothing  
happened.  
The remote party’s unit is Verify the remote party’s unit.  
not compatible with yours. This facsimile can communi-  
cate with G3 machines but not  
the facsimile is wrong.  
accordance with the line used  
for the facsimile (see page  
44).  
G4 machines.  
There is no dial tone or Try a voice call through the  
something else is wrong handset or the remote tele-  
Documents cannot be  
sent overseas.  
Poor telephone line condi- Retry sending the document  
tions.  
using to the “Quality Transmis-  
sion” procedure (see page  
184).  
with the phone line.  
phone set.  
The document is not set Align the document guides  
Documents are fed ob- correctly in the Document properly (but not too tightly).  
liquely (i.e. skewed).  
Tray.  
The Scanner Cover is not Close the Scanner Cover until  
closed fully.  
it clicks at the two latching po-  
sitions.  
230  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reception Problems  
When receptions are not performed normally, check the points in the table below.  
If the facsimile will not operate correctly after confirming these points or anything  
not listed here occurs, call your service representatives.  
Problem  
Cause  
Solution  
After the recording pa- The recording paper is not Check the paper installation,  
installed correctly.  
and make sure it is correct.  
per has been re-  
placed, a PAPER  
EMPTY error mes-  
sage remains on the  
LCD display.  
Problem  
Cause  
Solution  
The paper tray is not posi- Slide the paper tray into the  
tioned properly. slot firmly.  
When you are to re- A document is still in your  
ceive a document and facsimile.  
you press  
Press  
to remove the  
The original document on Ask the sending party if the  
the sending side is of poor document contents are clear  
The received docu-  
ment is difficult to  
read.  
Unnecessary lines are  
printed.  
document.  
quality.  
enough.  
Firmly connect the modular  
cord at both ends.  
The modular cord (tele-  
phone line cable) is dis-  
nothing  
The sending unit requires Ask the sending party to take  
connected.  
happens.  
adjustment.  
a copy of the same document  
using their facsimile. If the  
quality is poor, the problem is  
in the sending party’s unit.  
Check that the power plug is  
plugged into the AC outlet and  
the power switch is ON.  
There is no power to the  
unit.  
The recording unit re- If a copy is made on your fac-  
Load recording paper in the re-  
cording paper tray.  
There is no recording pa-  
per.  
quires cleaning.  
simile and the quality is poor,  
clean the recording unit.  
Press down the top cover until  
it clicks at the two latching po-  
sitions.  
The top cover is not  
closed fully.  
The remote party loaded Request the remote party to  
You receive a docu-  
ment that is complete-  
ly blank, even though  
you and the remote  
party followed the cor-  
rect procedures.  
the document face up.  
make sure that document is  
loaded correctly.  
(If the handset is installed  
and after talking with the  
remote party through the  
handset) the handset is  
returned before pressing  
Press  
first, then  
return the handset.  
The recording paper tray Check the tray.  
is not firmly closed.  
Recording paper jam  
occurs frequently.  
.
Something is wrong with Use the recording paper of de-  
the recording paper itself. sired specifications.  
Ask the sending party to re-  
transmit the document.  
Something is wrong with  
the sending machine.  
The right side cover is not Check the right side cover.  
firmly closed.  
Press down the top cover until  
it clicks at the two latching po-  
sitions.  
The recording paper The top cover is not  
does not come out.  
closed fully.  
231  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing a Document Jam  
If a document jam occurs dur-  
Open the Scanner  
Cover  
Close the Scanner  
Cover  
Remove Other  
Documents  
Remove the  
Jammed Document  
ing a transmission, the mes-  
sage “DOCUMENT JAM” is  
displayed in the LCD window.  
Follow this procedure to clear a  
document jam.  
2
4
1
3
Scanner Cover  
Release Button  
Document  
079  
076  
077  
078  
Leave the power of the fac- Press the Scanner Cover Re- Remove the jammed docu-  
Firmly close the Scanner  
Cover.  
simile ON. Remove other docu- lease Button to open the cover.  
ments from the Document Tray,  
if any (except the jammed por-  
tion).  
ment. Check for pieces of pa-  
per, clips, or staples which  
may have caused the failure.  
Confirm that the LCD display  
indicates that the facsimile is  
in the Standby Mode.  
NOTE:  
As for a document that has  
jammed in the facsimile,  
make a duplicate using a  
copier and do the transmis-  
sion over again with the new  
duplicate used as the send-  
ing document.  
232  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing a Recording Paper Jam  
If a recording paper jam occurs  
Remove the  
Remove the  
Documents  
Open the Right Side  
Cover  
Open the Top Cover  
during a reception or a copying  
operation, the message “PA-  
PER JAM XX” is displayed in  
the LCD window. Follow this  
procedure to clear the jam.  
1
2
3
4
Developer Assembly  
(with Drum Unit)  
Top Cover  
Release Lever  
Developer  
Assembly  
Document  
Right Side  
Cover  
037  
051  
076  
081  
Leave the power of the fac- Open the Right Side Cover,  
simile ON. and remove the jammed re-  
Grasp the Top Cover Release  
Lever to open the Top Cover.  
Remove the Developer Assem-  
bly with the Drum Unit.  
If a document is in the Docu- cording paper if any.  
ment Tray or Document Exit  
Upon completion, ensure both  
IMPORTANT:  
Tray, remove the document.  
sides of the cover are com-  
pletely closed.  
Never touch the photo-  
conductive drum (the  
green surface) of the  
Drum Unit. If the surface  
is scarred or scratched, it  
will cause print quality  
problems.  
While  
removing  
any  
jammed paper, do not ex-  
pose the photoconduc-  
tive drum of the Drum  
Unit to light for more than  
3 minutes. If the Drum  
Unit is to be left any-  
where outside the fac-  
simile, be certain to cover  
it with cloth, paper, etc.  
233  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing a Recording Paper Jam - continued  
If there is any received  
document stored in  
memory ...  
Pull Up on the  
Green Paper Feed  
Release Lever  
Return the Developer  
Assembly (with Drum Unit)  
and Close the Cover  
Remove the Jammed  
Recording Paper  
5
6
7
If a recording paper jam oc-  
curs during a reception, the  
received documents are au-  
tomatically stored in memo-  
ry. In that case, the facsimi-  
le will automatically print out  
the received contents stored  
in memory after clearing the  
paper jam.  
Paper Feed  
Release Lever  
094  
099  
098  
Pull up on the green paper feed If a recording paper is jammed  
release lever. If there is any at the Fuser Section, remove  
jammed paper, remove it in the the jammed paper.  
direction of the arrow, being  
Install the Developer Assembly  
(with the Drum Unit) and close  
the Right Side Cover. Then  
close the Top Cover firmly.  
careful not to tear the recording  
paper.  
CAUTIONS:  
As the Fuser Section is  
heated, pay special at-  
tention when handling it.  
If hot, allow the fuser to  
cool prior to touching.  
IMPORTANT:  
When closing the Right  
Side Cover, close it firmly  
until a “click” sound is  
heard on both sides.  
Do not pull the recording  
paper out to the exit side.  
When the Top Cover is  
closed, the unit automati-  
cally returns to the  
Standby Mode.  
234  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the Recorded Image is not Clear...  
If the Document Scanner Unit  
is dirty, your documents may  
not be transmitted clearly. If  
the Recording Unit is dirty, the  
document you receive may not  
be clear. In that case, clean the  
Document Scanner Cleaning Procedure  
Wipe the Glass  
Open the Scanner  
Wipe the ADF Pad  
and Rollers  
1
3
2
Surface and White  
Plate  
Cover  
Stained  
Document Scanner Unit or Re-  
If the problem occurs during  
Scanner Cover  
Release Button  
White Plate  
cording Unit using the following  
both a transmission and in copy  
ADF Pad  
procedures. You can check  
mode, check the Document  
Glass  
these problems by making a  
Scanner Unit.  
copy.  
If the problem occurs during  
both receptions and copy mode,  
Examples of print problem:  
check the Recording Unit.  
077  
096  
097-1  
Press the Scanner Cover Re- Wipe the Glass surface and Wipe the ADF Pad and Rollers  
lease Button to open the Scan- the White Plate with a soft dry with a dry cloth.  
Vertical black line(s)  
ner Cover.  
cloth.  
If it is very dirty, wipe it with  
a cloth soaked in water and  
wrung out, then wipe it with a  
dry cloth.  
If it is very dirty, wipe it with  
a cloth soaked in water and  
wrung out, then wipe it with a  
dry cloth.  
CAUTION:  
Be careful not to injure your  
Vertical white line(s)  
finger(s) on the ADF spring  
when you wipe the ADF pad.  
Horizontal black line(s)  
Horizontal white line(s)  
Faint or blurred print  
235  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the Recorded Image is not Clear... - continued  
Document Scanner Cleaning Procedure - continued  
Close the Scanner  
4
Cover  
079  
Close the Scanner Cover.  
Make sure that the hooks  
on both sides are firmly  
latched.  
236  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the Recorded Image is not Clear... - continued  
Recording Unit Cleaning Procedure  
Remove the  
Clean the Transfer  
Wire and Discharge  
Wire  
Wipe the Glass  
Open the Top Cover  
Clean the Paper  
Guide  
3
4
1
2
5
Developer Assembly  
(with Drum Unit)  
Surface of Laser Unit  
Top Cover  
Release Lever  
Developer  
Assembly  
Glass  
037  
105  
103-1  
051  
104  
Wipe the glass surface of the  
laser unit with a soft dry cloth  
(lens cleaner cloth).  
Grasp the Top Cover Release  
Lever to open the Top Cover.  
Wipe the Paper Guide with a  
dry cloth.  
Clean the Transfer Wire and  
Discharge Wire with a cotton  
swab.  
Remove the Developer Assem-  
bly (with the Drum Unit at-  
tached).  
NOTE:  
CAUTION:  
If a problem with the Record-  
ing Unit remains after this  
action, you may require a  
new developer assembly or  
drum unit.  
Check for dirt or paper un-  
der the developer assembly  
(with drum unit) first. Call  
your service representative  
for assistance.  
Do not touch the Transfer  
Wire and Discharge Wire  
with your hands. The oils  
from your hands could con-  
taminate the wire resulting  
in lower print quality.  
IMPORTANT:  
Never touch the photo-  
conductive drum (the  
green surface) of the  
Drum Unit. If the surface  
is scarred or scratched,  
it will cause print quality  
problems.  
Do not expose the pho-  
toconductive drum of  
the Drum Unit to light for  
more than 3 minutes. If  
the Drum Unit is to be  
left anywhere outside  
the facsimile, be certain  
to cover it with cloth, pa-  
per, etc.  
237  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the Recorded Image is not Clear... - continued  
Recording Unit Cleaning Procedure - continued  
Clean the Front  
Contacts  
Clean the Right  
Contacts  
Clean the Rear  
Contacts  
Separate the Drum  
Unit  
Clean the Charger  
10  
Wire  
6
7
8
9
Drum Unit  
Charger Cleaner  
Developer  
Assmbly  
Drum Unit  
Clean the Charger Wire in the  
087  
052  
086  
089  
085  
Using a cotton swab, clean the  
silver contacts found in the rear  
of the developer chassis.  
Separate the Drum Unit from  
the Developer Assembly.  
Clean the silver contacts found  
along the front of the developer  
chassis, using a cotton swab.  
Using a cotton swab, clean the  
silver contacts found along the  
right side of the developer chas-  
sis.  
Drum Unit with  
Cleaner.  
a
Charger  
Insert the Charger Cleaner per-  
pendicularly until it contacts  
the case. Then, move the  
Charger Cleaner in one direc-  
tion horizontally slowly.  
WARNING:  
Moving the Charger Cleaner  
quickly or at an incorrect  
angle may damage or break  
the Charger Wire.  
238  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the Recorded Image is not Clear... - continued  
Recording Unit Cleaning Procedure - continued  
Return the Charger  
Cleaner and Mylar  
Scraper  
Attach the Drum  
Unit to the  
Developer Assembly  
Return the Developer  
Assembly (with Drum Unit)  
and Close the Top Cover  
Clean the Metering  
Blade  
Clean the Mylar  
Sheet  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
Charger Cleaner  
Metering  
Blade  
Drum Unit  
Mylar  
Scraper  
Cotton  
Swab  
Mylar  
Scraper  
Developer  
Assembly  
Mylar Sheet  
Toner Roller  
028  
090  
092  
042  
045  
Attach the Drum Unit to the  
Developer Assembly.  
Position the Drum Unit with the  
green drum surface facing the  
black toner roller on the Devel-  
oper Assembly.  
Clean the mylar sheet of the  
Developer Assembly with a cot-  
ton swab.  
When a white line occurs on Return the Charger Cleaner and  
the black toner roller of Devel- Mylar Scraper to the storage lo-  
oper Assembly, scrape off the cation provided inside the fac-  
dust or toner between the me- simile.  
tering blade and black toner  
roller with a Mylar Scraper.  
Install the Developer Assem-  
bly (with the Drum Unit at-  
tached) and close the Top  
Cover.  
When the Top Cover is  
closed, the unit automati-  
cally returns to the Standby  
Mode.  
239  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
USER TEST MODE - AUTOMATIC TEST MODE  
AUTO TEST  
AUTO TEST mode, permits you to automatically perform a series  
of machine tests in one operation.  
Display the TEST  
MODE Menu  
Select the AUTO  
TEST Menu  
Completed the  
AUTO TEST  
1
2
3
The test items performed by the AUTO TEST are:  
Press:  
Press:  
When all the tests end, the  
word “OPERATION COM-  
PLETED” is displayed on the  
screen and the display returns  
to showing the standby mode  
screen.  
FLASH ROM TEST  
Checks the program data, function data, and language data.  
+
SRAM TEST  
Checks the SRAM Memory.  
The auto test starts, appears  
on the screen indicating that  
the test is under way.  
DRAM TEST  
Checks the DRAM Memory.  
The results of the auto test can  
be confirmed with the self test  
report. To print the self test re-  
MODEM TEST (Line 1, Line 2: Only when installed)  
Checks the modem and detects a line current.  
AUTO TEST  
1.AUTO TEST  
2.INDIVIDUALTEST  
3.TEST RESULT LIST  
port, refer to “PRINTING  
TEST RESULT” on page 252.  
A
SCANNER TEST  
Checks the image scanner.  
--------------------  
If the result of the auto test is  
judged to be NG, call your ser-  
vice representative.  
CODEC TEST  
Checks the CODEC IC.  
PRINTER TEST  
AUTO TEST  
Checks the printer components for proper operation and prints  
one test page.  
---------------  
PHONE BOOK DATA TEST  
Checks the phone book data.  
To suspend the auto test,  
NOTE:  
AUTO TEST cannot be performed if the data, such as re-  
ceived data, delayed transmission, or polling data, is stored in  
the memory.  
press  
.
240  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- INDIVIDUAL TEST MODE  
INDIVIDUAL TEST Summary  
In INDIVIDUAL TEST mode,  
you can perform specific tests  
on this facsimile.  
Select the Desired  
INDIVIDUAL TEST  
(01-07)  
Enter the INDIVIDUAL  
TEST Menu  
1
2
Press:  
Press  
or  
until  
the desired INDIVIDUAL TEST  
is displayed or enter the de-  
sired INDIVIDUAL TEST (01  
through 07) using the dial key-  
pad.  
+
+
01.ADF TEST  
02.KEY TEST  
03.LED TEST  
04.LCD TEST  
05.SPEAKERTEST  
06.SWITCH TEST  
07.TEST PRINT  
NOTE:  
Only 4 selections can be  
displayed at one time.  
241  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADF TEST  
The ADF test checks the op-  
eration of the ADF by trans-  
porting and unloading docu-  
ments. You can check that the  
ADF is normal if the number of  
documents loaded is consis-  
tent with the number of docu-  
ments transported and un-  
loaded.  
Select the ADF TEST  
Menu  
To Continue or Exit  
the Test  
Load the Document  
1
3
2
Press:  
If a document jam occurs dur-  
ing transport, the screen below  
is displayed.  
To continue the ADF test,  
press:  
Load the documents in the  
document tray and press:  
+
+
+
+
ADF TEST  
DOCUMENT JAM  
PAGES XXX  
Load the documents again,  
then press:  
The documents will be trans-  
ported one by one and the  
number of documents unloaded Remove the jammed docu-  
will be displayed at the lower ment. You can resume the test  
right on the screen.  
by pressing  
.
ADF TEST  
To end the test, press:  
PAGES 001  
After transporting  
all the documents  
ADF TEST  
LOAD DOCUMENT  
ADF TEST  
ADF TEST  
START TO RESTART OR  
STOP TO COMPLETED  
PAGES XXX  
PAGE NUMBER CORRECT?  
1.YES  
2.NO  
You can change the transport  
speed by pressing  
.
STD: Fast  
FINE (Same when HALF  
TONE is set): Medium  
U-FINE (Same when HALF  
TONE is set): Slow  
242  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADF TEST - continued  
Select the ADF Test  
Result  
Completed the  
ADF TEST  
4
5
The word “OPERATION COM-  
PLETED” is displayed on the  
screen and the unit returns to  
the individual test selection  
screen.  
If the number of documents  
loaded is consistent with the  
number of documents unload,  
press:  
The result of the ADF test can  
be confirmed with the self test  
report. To print the self test re-  
If a document is not fed prop-  
erly (even once), press:  
port, refer to “PRINTING  
TEST RESULT” on page 252.  
A
If the result of the ADF test is  
judged to be NG, call your ser-  
vice representative.  
243  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
KEY TEST  
The key test checks key  
switch operation on the Opera-  
tion Panel.  
Select the Key Test  
Menu  
Check the Keys  
Completed the  
4
KEY TEST  
Exit the Key Test  
Mode  
1
2
3
Press:  
Press all the key switches ex- Press:  
The result of the key test can  
be confirmed with the self test  
report. To print the self test re-  
port, refer to “PRINTING  
TEST RESULT” on page 252.  
A
cept  
.
+
+
+
+
If the result of the key test is  
judged to be NG, call your ser-  
vice representative.  
The result of the key test (“OK”  
or “NG”) is displayed on the  
screen, and the unit returns to  
the test item select screen of  
the individual test.  
If all the keys except  
have been detected, the screen  
below is displayed.  
KEY TEST  
OK  
KEY TEST  
PRESS STOP KEY  
NOTE:  
Unless  
is pressed  
KEY TEST  
PRESS ALL KEYS  
EXCEPT STOP KEY  
If you fail to press all of the  
keys on the operation panel  
within 10 seconds after the  
screen in Step 2 is displayed,  
the test result is judged to be  
NG.  
including  
before press-  
ing  
, the result will be  
NOTE:  
NG.  
If you press  
before  
you press every other key,  
the machine will reset to the  
Individual Test menu screen  
and no test result will be is-  
sued.  
244  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
LED TEST  
The LED test checks LED op-  
eration by lighting all the  
LEDs on the Operation Panel.  
Select the LED TEST  
Menu  
Check the LCDs  
Select the Test Result  
Option  
Completed the  
4
LED TEST  
1
2
3
Press:  
Visually check that all the If all the LEDs are turn on, The word “OPERATION COM-  
LEDs are on. After checking, press:  
PLETED” is displayed on the  
screen and the unit returns to  
the individual test selection  
screen.  
+
+
+
+
press  
.
If even one LED is not lit,  
press:  
The result of the LED test can  
be confirmed with the self test  
report. To print the self test re-  
LED TEST  
ENTER TEST RESULT  
1.OK  
2.NG  
port, refer to “PRINTING  
TEST RESULT” on page 252.  
A
If the result of the LED test is  
judged to be NG, call your ser-  
vice representative.  
LED TEST  
CHECK IF ALL LEDS  
ARE TURNED ON  
STOP TO COMPLETE  
245  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
LCD TEST  
The LCD test checks LCD op-  
eration by turning on and off  
all the elements of the LCD on  
the Operation Panel.  
Completed the  
LCD TEST  
Select the LCD TEST  
Menu  
Start the LCD Test  
Select the Test Result  
3
Option  
4
1
2
Press:  
If all elements of the LCD turn  
on and off normally, press:  
Press:  
The word “OPERATION COM-  
PLETED” is displayed on the  
screen and the unit returns to  
the individual test selection  
screen.  
+
+
+
+
The result of the LCD test can  
be confirmed with the self test  
report. To print the self test re-  
If even one elements fails to  
turn on and off, press:  
All of the elements of the LCD  
should turn on (as is the ex-  
ample below).  
port, refer to “PRINTING  
TEST RESULT” on page 252.  
A
Five seconds later, all the ele-  
ments should turn off. Visually  
check that all the elements  
have turned on and off nor-  
mally. The test result input  
screen is displayed five sec-  
onds after the elements turn  
off.  
If the result of the LCD test is  
judged to be NG, call your ser-  
vice representative.  
LCD TEST  
LCD WILL TURN BLACK  
AND THEN CLEAR  
PRESS START KEY  
LCD TEST  
ENTER TEST RESULT  
1.OK  
2.NG  
246  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SPEAKER TEST  
The speaker test checks  
speaker operation by changing  
the volume output from the  
speaker.  
Completed the  
SPEAKER TEST  
Select the SPEAKER  
TEST Menu  
Select the SPEAKER  
TEST Option  
Select the Test Result  
3
Option  
4
1
2
Press:  
If all volumes are output nor-  
mally, press:  
The word “OPERATION COM-  
PLETED” is displayed on the  
screen and the unit returns to  
the individual test selection  
screen.  
Select a speaker volume level  
by using or  
.
+
+
+
+
Level 0 produces no sound, and  
Level 7 the maximum volume.  
Speaker sound is output at the  
volume level selected. Check  
that all the volumes are output  
normally. After checking, press:  
The result of the speaker test  
can be confirmed with the self  
test report. To print the self  
test report, refer to “PRINTING  
A TEST RESULT” on page  
252.  
If even one of them is not out-  
put normally, press:  
If the result of the speaker test  
is judged to be NG, call your  
service representative.  
SPEAKER TEST  
ENTER TEST RESULT  
1.OK  
2.NG  
SPEAKER TEST  
STOP TO COMPLETED  
VOLUME= (0-7)  
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7  
247  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SWITCH TEST  
The switch test checks if the detection switches operate nor-  
mally.  
Select the SWITCH  
TEST Menu  
Check the Scanner  
Cover  
Check the Top Cover  
1
2
3
The test items in SWITCH TEST mode are as follows:  
Press:  
Open the Scanner Cover. Open the Top Cover. When its  
When its open state is de- open state is detected, the  
tected, the screen below ap- screen below appears. After  
pears. After checking that the checking that the screen is dis-  
screen is displayed, close the played, close the Top Cover.  
Scanner Cover.  
Detection of Scanner Cover open/closed status  
Detection of Top Cover open/closed status  
+
+
+
+
Detection of Process Unit (Drum Unit with Developer Assem-  
bly) presence/absence status  
Detection of Recording Paper and Recording Paper Tray pres-  
ence/absence status  
Detects the open state  
of the Scanner Cover.  
Detects the open state  
of the Top Cover.  
Detection of Bypass Tray presence/absence status  
Detection of Flip Panels on the Operation Panel  
SWITCH TEST  
SWITCH TEST  
CLOSE SCANNER COVER  
CLOSE THE TOP COVER  
NOTE:  
If no operation is performed within 10 seconds after an opera-  
Close the cover  
Close the cover  
tional instruction is displayed on the screen during the switch  
test, the test result will be judged to be NG.  
SWITCH TEST  
OPEN THE TOP COVER  
SWITCH TEST  
PULL OUT THE UPPER  
TRAY  
SWITCH TEST  
OPEN SCANNER COVER  
248  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SWITCH TEST - continued  
Check the Upper Tray  
Check the Process Unit  
(Drum Unit with Developer Assembly)  
Check the Bypass  
6
Tray (If Installed)  
4
5
Remove the Process Unit.  
When the absence of a Pro-  
cess Unit is detected, the  
screen below appears. After  
checking that the screen is dis-  
played, install the Process  
Unit.  
Pull out the Upper Recording  
Paper Tray. When the absence  
of a Recording Paper Tray is  
detected, the screen below ap-  
pears. After checking that the  
screen is displayed, install the  
Recording Paper Tray.  
If no Bypass Tray is installed Remove the recording paper  
or no recording paper is placed from the Bypass Tray. When  
in the Bypass Tray, the screen the absence of recording paper  
If no recording paper is placed  
in the Recording Paper Tray,  
the screen below is displayed.  
You can resume the test by  
loading the paper.  
below is displayed.  
is detected, the screen below  
appears. After checking that  
the screen is displayed, load  
the paper.  
DOES THIS MACHINE  
HAVE A BYPASS TRAY?  
1.YES  
SWITCH TEST  
LOAD PAPER IN THE  
UPPER TRAY  
Detects the absence of  
an Upper Recording Pa-  
per Tray.  
Detects the absence of  
recording paper in the  
Bypass Tray.  
2.NO  
Detects the absence of  
a Process Unit.  
If Bypass Tray is installed or  
no paper is placed in the By-  
pass Tray, press:  
SWITCH TEST  
PUT IN THE PROCESS  
UNIT  
SWITCH TEST  
INSERT THE UPPER  
TRAY  
SWITCH TEST  
LOAD PAPER IN THE  
BYPASS TRAY  
If an Optional Recording Paper  
Tray is installed, follow the  
same test procedure as above  
for the Middle and Lower Re-  
cording Paper Trays.  
Install the Process  
Unit  
Install the Recording  
Paper Tray  
Load the paper  
Go to Step 6.  
If no Bypass Tray is installed,  
press:  
SWITCH TEST  
UNLOAD PAPER IN THE  
BYPASS TRAY  
SWITCH TEST  
PULL OUT THE PROCESS  
UNIT  
SWITCH TEST  
FLIP BOOK PANEL ON  
THE LEFT-HAND SIDE  
Go to Step 7.  
If both Flip Panels are set on  
the left-hand side of the Opera-  
tion Panel, the screen below is  
displayed. In this case, reverse  
the left and right for the opera-  
tion in Step 7.  
SWITCH TEST  
FLIP BOOK PANEL ON  
THE RIGHT-HAND SIDE  
249  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SWITCH TEST - continued  
Check the Flip Panels  
Completed the  
SWITCH TEST  
7
8
Set both Flip Panels on the The result of the switch test  
left-hand side.  
can be confirmed with the self  
test report. To print the self  
test report, refer to “PRINTING  
A TEST RESULT” on page  
252.  
The result of the switch test  
(“OK” or “NG”) is displayed on  
the screen, and the unit returns  
to the individual test selection  
screen.  
If the result of the switch test  
is judged to be NG, call your  
service representative.  
SWITCH TEST  
OK  
If one Flip Panel is set on ei-  
ther side, move the Flip Panel  
on the right-hand side to the  
left-hand side and then move  
them to the right-hand side.  
250  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TEST PRINT  
The test print checks the print  
function by printing a test pat-  
tern.  
Select the TEST  
PRINT Menu  
1
Press:  
Print Sample  
+
+
+
+
MAY-17-00WED11:13  
RESULT MEMORY 100%  
PRINTING LIST  
The test pattern is printed and  
the unit returns to the standby  
mode screen.  
251  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- TEST RESULT  
PRINTING a TEST RESULT  
This test result list prints out  
the results of the individual  
tests as a self test report.  
Select the TEST  
1
RESULT Menu  
Press:  
Print Sample  
+
+
After completion of the list out-  
put, the display returns to the  
standby mode screen.  
252  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REMOTE SERVICE - RDC (Remote Diagnosis Configuration) Service  
This machine has a function to receive the following services remotely. (Consult your authorized TOSHIBA dealer for assistance in using this function.)  
RDC (Remote Diagnosis Configuration)  
This service enables the machine to be dialed from a service center to retrieve information and reports, set various machine settings, program data, and upgrading the  
firmware in the machine.  
A separate contract with the service center will be required to receive this RDC service.  
NOTES:  
This capability is currently under development and is not yet available. This RDC Service will be restricted to TOSHIBA trained technicians working for TOSHIBA  
authorized dealers and will not be available in all areas.  
This function is not available in the United States.  
253  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
- AUTOMATIC SUPPLIES ORDER  
Automatic Supplies Order Setting  
This machine can automatically send an order sheet to a designated fax machine informing your supplier that a replacement Drum Kit or Toner Kit is required.  
Contact your local authorized dealer for information on this setting.  
NOTE:  
This function is not available in the United States.  
254  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SPECIFICATIONS  
Document Size:  
Power Required:  
120 VAC, 60 Hz  
Width ..... 216 mm (8.5 inches) max.  
148 mm (5.8 inches) min.  
Power Consumed:  
Max. 550 W (operating), 2 W or less (standby  
in Super Power Saver mode)  
Length ... 1000 mm (39.4 inches) max.  
100 mm (3.9 inches) min.  
Unit Dimensions:  
Weight:  
Width ..... 590 mm (23.2 inches)  
Depth..... 596 mm (23.5 inches)  
Height .... 338 mm (13.3 inches)  
(All dimensions excluding protrusions)  
Recording Paper Size:  
Width ..... 216 mm (8.5 inches)  
Length ... 280 or 356 mm (11.0 or 14.0 inches)  
Recording Paper Tray Capacity: Up to 550 sheets per tray (with the recom-  
mended paper)  
About 24.5 kg (54.0 lbs.)  
Effective Scanning Width:  
Effective Printing Width:  
216 mm (8.5 inches)  
207 mm (8.1 inches)  
Outer appearance, specifications, etc. may be changed without prior notice.  
Compatibility Communication Modes:  
ECM, G3, Exclusive Modes: (EX)  
If any trouble is encountered, contact your authorized TOSHIBA facsimile  
dealer.  
Scanning Density:  
Horizontal ..... 8 dots/mm (203 dpi),  
16 dots/mm (406 dpi)  
Vertical ......... 3.85 lines/mm (97.8 lines/inch)  
7.7 lines/mm (196 lines/inch)  
The clock function and programming data of this device are preserved with a  
built-in battery. If the power supply is cut off over a long time, the battery may  
become discharged, causing the recorded data to be lost.  
Document image data received by this device is preserved with a built-in battery  
(for about 10 hours). If the power supply is cut off for a long time, the received  
data may be lost.  
15.4 lines/mm (391 lines/inch)  
Transmission Rate:  
Encoding Systems:  
V.17: 14400/12000/9600/7200/4800/2400 bps  
V.34: 33600/31200/28800/26400/24000/21600/  
19200/16800/14400/12000/9600/7200/  
4800/2400 bps  
JBIG/MMR/MR/MH  
Recording and Printing Method: Electrophotography and Laser Printing  
Laser:  
GaAIAs Laser Diode  
Max. 5 mW, wavelength 780 nm  
Memory Capacity:  
Standard..... 3MB for DP120F  
7MB for DP125F  
Optional Memory Card  
4 MB Board (DP120F only)  
Machine Type:  
Desktop type with both transmission and re-  
ception functions  
Applicable Networks:  
PSTN (Public Switched Telephone Network)  
255  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SUPPLIES  
HARDWARE OPTIONS  
Letter-size Recording Paper:  
Legal-size Recording Paper:  
Drum Kit:  
2nd NCU Board with V.34 Modem:  
(DP120F only)  
GD-1030-US  
GC-1030  
Memory Board (4MB):  
(DP120F only)  
DK-15  
TK-15  
DU-15  
Toner Kit:  
Recording Paper Tray:  
Bypass Tray (DP120F only):  
Handset:  
FU-15L  
BC-15  
Developer Unit:  
HD-15  
PCL Print Kit:  
GA-1020  
GF-1010  
GD-1040  
NIC Kit:  
Internet FAX Kit:  
256  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TOSHIBA Viewer  
OPERATOR’S MANUAL  
257  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
LICENSE AGREEMENT  
Wordcraft International Limited  
Unimessage Pro Software Licence Agreement  
CONDITIONS OF PURCHASE  
Software is licensed subject to the limitations on permitted use. No refund will be given after the purchaser has installed the software. This Licence shall continue for as long as the Product is in use. Failure to comply with the  
terms and conditions detailed below will result in termination of the licence. All copies of the software must be destroyed on termination of the licence.  
PERMITTED USES  
The original purchaser may use the software on a computer system owned or used by the original purchaser for the purpose of any business or profession. The original purchaser may store the software on a hard disk system for use  
only by the permitted number of users and connected only to the permitted number of communication devices as specified in the system configuration file contained within the software product at the time of purchase, plus the  
number of users and devices added by obtaining a valid licensed upgrade from Wordcraft International Limited or an authorised agent of Wordcraft International Limited.  
USES NOT PERMITTED  
a.  
Downloading of the software from a computer service or bulletin board or use in a multi-site arrangement except in respect of users licensed by Wordcraft International Limited to do so.  
b. Use of the software in a computer service business, network, time-sharing, interactive cable television or multiple CPU arrangement except in respect of users licensed by Wordcraft International Limited to do so.  
c.  
The use of a single user version on a second or subsequent computer or network workstation. Details of multi-user packs are available from authorised dealers or authorised distributors of Wordcraft International Limited or  
direct from Wordcraft International Limited.  
d. The use of a network version on a second or subsequent network.  
e.  
f.  
The making of alterations and modifications to the software, merging all or any part of the software with another program, reverse engineering, decompiling, or disassembling of the software.  
The right to rent, assign, lease, transfer or grant sub-licences or other rights to others.  
g. The making of copies of any documentation belonging to Wordcraft International Limited.  
h. The selling or transferring of software marked ‘Not for Resale’ or ‘Evaluation’ or ‘Demonstration’ or ‘Training’.  
i.  
Any other uses not included in “Permitted Uses” above, which would require a licence to use the copyright in the software.  
The license contained in this agreement will terminate automatically and without notice from Wordcraft International Limited if any provision in this agreement is not complied with.  
GOVERNING LAW  
This agreement shall be governed by the laws of the United Kingdom of Great Britain and Northern Ireland.  
LIMITED WARRANTY  
Wordcraft International Limited make no representations or warranties, express or implied, of any kind with respect to the contents of this package and specifically disclaim any express or implied warranty of merchantability or  
fitness for any particular purpose. Wordcraft International Limited’s liability shall be limited to replacing any faulty product with alternative product or a cash refund up to but not exceeding the value of the monies paid for the  
product when originally purchased. In no event shall Wordcraft International Limited or their suppliers be liable for any special, incidental, indirect or consequential damages whatsoever (including, without limitation, damages  
for loss of revenue or profits, business interruption, lost or damaged data, or any other loss arising out of the installation of, use of or inability to use this software product). Wordcraft International Limited shall not be responsible  
for any claims arising from the use of software marked ‘Not for Resale’ or ‘Evaluation’ or ‘Demonstration’ or ‘Training’.  
Wordcraft International Limited shall not be responsible for any claims arising from the use of software other than the use for which it was specifically sold.  
Wordcraft International Limited shall not be responsible for any claims by a third party.  
No oral or written information or advice given to Wordcraft International Limited, or given by Wordcraft International Limited , or an authorised representative shall create a warranty or in any way increase the scope of this  
warranty.  
COPYRIGHT  
Software and documentation produced by Wordcraft International Limited is protected by International Copyright Conventions.  
TRADEMARKS  
Wordcraft is a trademark of Wordcraft International Limited.  
All other trademarks are acknowledged.  
Following installation the package will be automatically registered.  
This is a legally binding agreement with Wordcraft International Limited.  
If you feel you cannot accept the conditions defined above please return the complete software package unopened to your supplier.  
1999 Wordcraft International Limited  
258  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTENTS  
LICENSE AGREEMENT ............................................................258  
CONTENTS ................................................................................259  
INTRODUCTION ........................................................................260  
INSTALLATION AND DEVICE CONFIGURATION ................... 261  
Computer Requirements................................................................. 261  
Configuration of the CD-ROM ........................................................ 261  
Installing the TOSHIBA Viewer .......................................................262  
Installation .........................................................................................262  
Device Setup .....................................................................................264  
Uninstalling the TOSHIBA Viewer ................................................... 268  
DESCRIPTION OF THE FUNCTIONS........................................269  
Description of the Main Welcome Menu ......................................... 269  
Browse Folders .............................................................................. 270  
Changing the Device Configuration ....................................................270  
Saving the Device Configuration ........................................................273  
Add/Edit Phonebook contacts on the DP120F/DP125F......................275  
Saving the Phonebook .......................................................................277  
Creating a Routing Rules ...................................................................279  
Finding items stored in TOSHIBA Viewer folders ................................280  
Creating Folder ..................................................................................281  
File Scan......................................................................................... 282  
Scanning with your DP120F/DP125F or otherTWAIN  
compatible scanner............................................................................282  
TOSHIBA Viewer GDI Printer.........................................................284  
Printing fromTOSHIBAViewer UniPad ...............................................284  
Printing from Other Application ..........................................................285  
259  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INTRODUCTION  
“TOSHIBA Viewer” has been specially designed for use with DP120F/DP125F’s [Multi-Function Peripherals] and TWAIN compatible scanning devices.  
Subject to the device with which you are using TOSHIBA Viewer and the configuration of your specific copy of TOSHIBA Viewer, available features of TOSHIBA Viewer  
include:  
Scanning hard copy documents using your TWAIN scanner.  
Using your DP120F/DP125F as a printer.  
Using your DP120F/DP125F as a scanner.  
Configuring your DP120F/DP125F from the PC.  
Create or edit the Phone/Fax numbers stored in your DP120F/DP125F from the PC.  
Creating contacts in your TOSHIBA Viewer Phonebooks for frequently used fax numbers and e-mail addresses.  
Creating graphics files in the Unimessage Pro Viewer.  
Storing properties of files in the Unimessage Pro folders to be used with TOSHIBA Viewer’s sophisticated search engine.  
Routing of scanned images using TOSHIBA Viewer’s simple wizard style Routing Rules.  
This manual gives instructions on how to install TOSHIBA Viewer and basic information about some of the other functions listed above.  
Upgrading Unimessage Pro for TOSHIBA Viewer  
Unimessage Pro for TOSHIBA Viewer can be upgraded to:  
Add features, for example e-mail functions are not included in all Unimessage Pro configurations.  
Support multiple users on a LAN.  
Support several devices at the same time.  
To update/upgrade your copy of Unimessage Pro for TOSHIBA Viewer, contact your TOSHIBA authorized dealer.  
260  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSTALLATION AND DEVICE CONFIGURATION  
NOTE:  
Computer Requirements  
The Requirements indicated  
here are minimums. As with  
most Windows applications,  
TOSHIBA Viewer will run  
faster when used on a PC  
with a faster processor or  
with more RAM. If you are  
using other applications on  
your PC at the same time  
as TOSHIBA Viewer, a fast-  
er processor and additional  
RAM are highly recommend-  
ed.  
The TOSHIBA Viewer system is compatible with Microsoft Windows 95/98, Microsoft Windows NT4.0 or later.  
Make sure that your computer meets the following criteria.  
For installation under Microsoft Windows 95/98 or Microsoft Windows NT 4.0  
PC:  
IBM PC or 100% compatible; Pentium 120 MHz or higher  
Microsoft Windows 95/98, Windows NT 4.0  
Operating system:  
PC memory:  
32M Bytes minimum (64M Bytes recommended) for Windows 95/98 First Edition (Microsoft Windows 95  
OSR1 Service Pack 1 is recommended.)  
32M Bytes minimum (64M Bytes recommended) for Windows 98 Second Edition and Windows NT 4.0  
(When using Windows NT4.0, please ensure that Microsoft NT4.0 Service Pack 4 or later is installed.)  
Display:  
A 24-bit color video card and driver is recommended  
Configuration of the CD-ROM  
The configuration of the CD-ROM and the purposes for each folder are as described below.  
\Toshiba Viewer  
Includes the Setup.exe to install the TOSHIBA Viewer, printer driver and TWAIN driver.  
\Drivers9x\Network Printer  
Includes the printer driver for the client computers of Windows 95/98.  
\Drivers9x\PnP Printer & TWAIN  
Includes the printer driver and TWAIN driver for Plug-and-Play installation.  
\DriversNT4\Local Printer & TWAIN  
Includes the printer driver and TWAIN driver for installing by Add Printer function in Windows NT4.0 that DP120F/DP125F is  
connected in local.  
\DriversNT4\Network Printer  
Includes the printer driver for Windows NT4.0 that is used as a client computer.  
261  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the TOSHIBA Viewer  
Before  
installing  
Installation  
TOSHIBA Viewer, your  
TOSHIBA  
DP120F/  
Prompts may vary de-  
pending on your PC con-  
figuration.  
DP125F must be con-  
nected to your PC via a  
parallel cable suitable for  
bi-directional communica-  
tions.  
Insert the CD-ROM  
Select Language  
1
3
The screens show exam-  
ples of Windows 95.  
NOTE:  
NOTE:  
Please make sure  
that following terms  
are satisfied.  
You can install the  
drivers by Plug-and-  
Play function or Add  
Printers function. You  
have to choose differ-  
ent sources in the CD-  
ROM when you install  
by those functions.  
Please see on page  
261 for the configura-  
tion of the CD-ROM  
and the descriptions  
for the sources in  
each folder.  
When using Windows  
NT 4.0, make sure  
you have Administra-  
tor access rights.  
Click Start and select Run.  
Click OK.  
Close all applications  
that are running to  
avoid any conflicts  
during installation.  
The  
TOSHIBA  
Type “D:\Toshiba Viewer\Setup.exe”  
Start the Installation  
DP120F/DP125F con-  
nected to your PC is  
powered on.  
2
4
Type “D:\Toshiba Viewer\Setup.exe” where D is your  
Click Next.  
CD-ROM drive.  
Click OK.  
262  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the TOSHIBA Viewer - continued  
Installation - continued  
Read the Software License Agreement  
Select the Program Folder  
Exit the Installation Window  
5
7
9
If you agree the License Agreement, click Yes.  
Click Next.  
Select Yes, I want to restart my computer now., and  
click Finish.  
If you click No, exit the Installation. The Installation is  
not completed.  
NOTE:  
You have to restart the computer before using the  
TOSHIBA Viewer.  
After restarting the computer, the Unimessage Pro de-  
vice wizard automatically runs.  
Choose the Destination Location  
Start the Copy  
6
8
Click Next.  
Wait until file copying files is completed.  
The Setup Complete screen automatically appears.  
263  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the TOSHIBA Viewer - continued  
After restarting the computer,  
DeviceSetup  
the Unimessage Pro device  
wizard automatically appears.  
Unimessage Pro device wizard appears  
Select the device driver installation type  
1
2
NOTE:  
This device setup wizard  
can be operated by running  
the Unimessage Pro  
Startup Wizard in Program  
Folder as well. When plural  
TOSHIBA Faxes are con-  
nected to your PC, you can  
operate the device setups  
for each device.  
Every time you operate the  
device  
setup,  
a
new  
TOSHIBA Viewer utility is  
created.  
Enter the details for each entry field.  
Select Yes, select a device connected to this computer from a  
list of supported devices, and click Next.  
NOTE:  
At least Name, Organization, Address, Country, Telephone  
number, and Fax number must be entered.  
The Address entry must be more than 20 letters.  
After all required entries are completed, click Next.  
264  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the TOSHIBA Viewer - continued  
Device Setup - continued  
Select the manufacturer of your fax and  
the device model  
Enter System Device Name and  
Descriptive Device Name  
Select Custom for the type of Setup  
3
4
5
Select Toshiba in the Manufacturers field and the  
model that is connected to your PC in the Models  
field.  
Default System Device Name and Descriptive Device Click Next.  
Name are already entered. Rename them if required.  
Click Next.  
265  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the TOSHIBA Viewer - continued  
Device Setup - continued  
Select the Port that your DP120F/  
DP125F is connected to  
Select Yes, install TWAIN components  
Select Yes, create a printer  
6
7
8
Click Next.  
If there is a TOSHIBA Viewer TWAIN resource avail- If the DP120F/DP125F prints using  
a
TOSHIBA  
able for the DP120F/DP125F you are using, TOSHIBA Viewer driver, TOSHIBA Viewer will ask if a printer  
Viewer will ask if the TWAIN resource should be in- driver for the DP120F/DP125F should be created or  
stalled as you configure the device.  
not. If you choose to create this printer, it will be  
named after the DP120F/DP125F but you can edit this  
name if you prefer.  
Click Next.  
Click Next.  
NOTE:  
If you choose not to create the “print” printer driver  
during the definition of the device or it is deleted, you  
can create the “print” printer driver for the DP120F/  
DP125F later. To do this, open the Devices folder,  
right click on the appropriate device and select Cre-  
ate printer. For further details, see the Help for  
Create printer.  
266  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the TOSHIBA Viewer - continued  
Device Setup - continued  
Select whether to creat a shortcut and  
the location  
Complete the device setup  
TOSHIBA Viewer starts  
9
10  
11  
Click Next.  
Click Finish.  
NOTE:  
If you want to install several TOSHIBA Viewers, it is  
required to change the name of the shortcut to avoid  
the name being overlapped.  
267  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Uninstalling the TOSHIBA Viewer  
Select Start, Settings, Control Panel  
Confirm File Deletion dialog appears  
Uninstallation starts  
1
3
5
Double click Add/Remove Programs.  
Click Yes.  
After removing files is completed, click OK.  
NOTE:  
During the uninstallation, the confirmation dialogs  
for removing the shared files appear. Click OK to  
delete all shared files in the TOSHIBA Viewer pro-  
gram folder.  
Select Unimessage Pro  
TOSHIBA Viewer alert dialog appears  
2
4
Click Add/Remove....  
Exit all applications running on your machine, and Restart your computer to complete the uninstallation.  
click OK.  
Some files are deleted after restarting the computer.  
268  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DESCRIPTION OF THE FUNCTIONS  
Descriptions and instruc-  
Description of the Main Welcome Menu  
tions for general func-  
tions are described in this  
section. For details and  
instructions other than  
those described in this  
manual, please refer to  
the TOSHIBA Viewer  
on-line Help.  
From this menu you can access the main TOSHIBA Viewer system. You can examine the lists of scanned and filed images by clicking the  
TOSHIBA Viewer logo.  
The round buttons provide quick access to some of the TOSHIBA Viewer functions and can include a combination of the following:  
Browse Folders: This takes you to the list of folders within TOSHIBA Viewer so that you can check on the progress of messages, examine  
the lists of received, transmitted, filed messages and print these lists or individual messages.  
Copy:  
This combines the functions of TWAIN scanning and printing and allows you to make multiple hardcopies of a document  
in the automatic document feeder of the TWAIN scanner.  
File Scan:  
This takes you to the TWAIN scanner driver or, for DP120F/DP125F, the TOSHIBA Viewer Scan setup dialog so that you  
can scan documents or images into your PC.  
Email Scan:  
Setup:  
This scans a document or image using any TWAIN scanner then automatically attach it to an email message.  
This takes you to a dialog where settings on your DP120F/DP125F can be configured from the PC; it may also allow you  
to exchange Phonebook contacts with your DP120F/DP125F’s One Touch or Speed Dial functions.  
Help:  
Exit:  
To access TOSHIBA Viewer on-line Help.  
To close TOSHIBA Viewer.  
269  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Browse Folders  
When you click Browse  
Folders button or the  
TOSHIBA Viewer logo on  
the Welcome menu, the  
TOSHIBA Viewer main  
display will appear.  
ChangingtheDeviceConfiguration  
During the Unimessage  
Device Wizard that con-  
Open the Device folder  
1
cluded the installation  
process, you will have  
configured  
TOSHIBA  
Viewer for use with your  
DP120F/DP125F. Should  
you want to, you can  
reconfigure how TOSHIBA  
Viewer works with your  
DP120F/DP125F via the  
Device folder.  
NOTE:  
When you close the  
main TOSHIBA View-  
er display, the Wel-  
come menu will reap-  
pear. If you prefer to  
Also you can remotely  
skip  
menu,  
the  
select  
Welcome  
Pro-  
configure  
the  
device  
At the top of the Main TOSHIBA Viewer Display is the  
menu list - File, Edit, View, Message, Setup, Window,  
and Help. Below the menu list is the main toolbar -  
Open, Print, Acquire and Find. For further descrip-  
tions of the each menu item, select Contents and  
Index in Help menu to view the Help.  
configuration using this  
program.  
gram from the Setup  
menu, click on the Ap-  
plication tab and un-  
check the Show “wel-  
come” screen option  
then click OK. The  
Welcome menu will  
not to be displayed be-  
ginning with the next  
Double click the appropriate entry in the list of devices  
that appears in the right hand pane.  
Device settings appears.  
The remainder of the screen is divided into two parts:  
On the left is the list of available folders.  
time  
you  
start  
To open a folder in the right pane, click its name in  
the folder tree. If a folder contains any unread items  
TOSHIBA Viewer will display the number of unread  
items within each folder after each folder’s name in  
this section of the screen.  
TOSHIBA Viewer.  
You can switch be-  
tween open folders in  
the main TOSHIBA  
Viewer display using  
Ctrl+TAB or Ctrl+F6.  
On the right is a display area for individual or multiple  
folder.  
You can select folders to be displayed by clicking  
on them in the folder list.  
You can close the cur-  
rent folder in the main  
TOSHIBA Viewer dis-  
play using Ctrl+F4.  
270  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Browse Folders - continued  
ChangingtheDeviceConfiguration-continued  
Change the TOSHIBA Viewer settings  
2
2a  
Change the device settings  
2b  
Change the port  
Click on Device tab.  
Click on Port tab.  
Check on Print and/or Scan if you want the DP120F/DP125F to  
be worked as a printer and/or scanner using the TOSHIBA Viewer.  
Select the port that your computer connects to your DP120F/  
DP125F.  
When you want to change the port, go to Step 2b.  
Click on OK to save changes.  
When you want to configure the device settings, click on Setup...  
and go to Step 3.  
When you want to save changes, click on OK.  
271  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Browse Folders - continued  
ChangingtheDeviceConfiguration-continued  
Change the Device settings  
3
You can remotely configure the  
device settings using the  
TOSHIBA Viewer.  
3a  
Edit the device configuration  
3b  
Load a set file on your hard disk  
After clicking Setup... on the  
Device  
TOSHIBA Viewer retrieves the  
device settings from the  
DP120F/DP125F.  
Tab  
screen,  
the  
When you want to change the  
device settings file directly, go  
to Step 3a.  
When you want to change the  
device settings file by copying  
the settings from a set file lo-  
cated on your hard disk, go to  
Step 3b.  
Select or enter the value for items that you want to change the  
configurations.  
Double-click on Add settings file.  
A “New settings” file is created.  
Click the ü button to download the new settings to your DP120F/  
DP125F. Back to Step 2a.  
When you want to change the  
device settings file by copying  
the settings from a user set-  
NOTE:  
Click the button to cancel adding/editing the device configu-  
ration. Back to Step 2a.  
tings  
file  
stored  
within  
TOSHIBA Viewer, go to Step  
3c.  
Right-click on the new settings file and select Load....  
For additional information on a  
specific item, refer to Help and  
the appropriate section of the  
NOTE:  
In order to create a user settings file to be saved on your hard  
disk, refer to the section “Saving the Device Configuration”.  
DP120F/DP125F  
Manual.  
Operator's  
The Load settings screen appears. Designate the hard disk  
location of the desired set file, select the file, then click on Open.  
The set file is loaded.  
Continue to Step 3c.  
272  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Browse Folders - continued  
ChangingtheDeviceConfiguration-continued  
SavingtheDeviceConfiguration  
The device setting file opened  
Open the Device folder  
1
by TOSHIBA Viewer (default  
name TOSHIBA) is  
Change the Device settings - continued  
3
a
temporary “working” file. Every  
time TOSHIBA Viewer is  
opened, the program accesses  
the attached facsimile and  
reads the current settings.  
You can store the settings  
within TOSHIBA Viewer or  
save them as a file on your  
hard disk.  
3c  
Copy the device configuration  
This is useful when performing  
a
full memory clear or  
upgrading the machine’s  
Double click the appropriate entry in the list of devices  
that appears in the right hand pane.  
firmware because you can  
easily re-configure the device  
by downloading the stored  
settings.  
Left-click and hold on the user settings file, then drag it to the  
device settings file, and release the left mouse button.  
Device settings appears.  
Click on Setup...  
2
NOTE:  
Initially, your mouse pointer will become a “circle with diagonal  
line”. Upon reaching the desired settings file, the pointer will  
take the form of an “address label”. Upon releasing the left  
mouse button, the contents of the user settings file are copied  
to the device settings file.  
Click the ü button to download the new settings to your DP120F/  
DP125F. Back to Step 2a.  
NOTE:  
Click the button to cancel adding/editing the device configu-  
ration. Back to Step 2a.  
Toshiba Setup appears.  
273  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Browse Folders - continued  
Saving the Device Configuration - continued  
Save new settings  
Create the new settings file  
3
4
4a  
Save within TOSHIBA Viewer  
4b  
Save as a file on your hard disk  
Double-click on Add settings file.  
A “New settings” file is created. Enter an appropriate  
name for the new settings file.  
To copy the device configuration to the new settings  
file, left-click and hold on the device settings file (e.g.  
“TOSHIBA”) then drag it to the new settings file (e.g.  
“DP125F LA Office”) and release the left mouse  
button.  
Right-click on the new settings file and select Save.  
Right-click on the new settings file and select Save  
as....  
NOTE:  
When you click the ü button or button to close The Save settings screen appears. Designate the  
the screen, TOSHIBA Viewer will prompt you to location on your hard disk and enter an appropriate file  
NOTE:  
save the file.  
name, then click on OK.  
Initially, your mouse pointer will become a “circle  
with diagonal line”. Upon reaching the desired set-  
tings file, the pointer will take the form of an “ad-  
dress label”. Upon releasing the left mouse button,  
the contents of the device settings file are copied  
to the new settings file.  
NOTE:  
The settings file is saved as a set file on your hard  
disk. The file extension is “set”. This file can be  
retrieved by TOSHIBA Viewer.  
To save the new settings within the TOSHIBA Viewer,  
go to Step 4a.  
To save the new settings as a file on your local hard  
disk, go to Step 4b.  
274  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Browse Folders - continued  
Add/EditPhonebookcontactsontheDP120F/DP125F  
TOSHIBA Viewer permits  
you to remotely add/edit  
Open the Devices folder  
Change the settings  
1
2
One  
Abbreviated  
contacts  
Touch  
and/or  
Number  
your  
When  
you  
want  
to  
on  
Setup device  
phonebook  
change the current de-  
vice phonebook, go to  
Step 2a.  
2a  
Edit the phonebook  
DP120F/DP125F.  
When  
you  
want  
to  
change the phonebook by  
copying the settings from  
a set file located on your  
hard disk, go to Step 2b.  
Select the device and click Setup device phonebook  
button.  
When  
you  
want  
to  
“Reading data from device” appears as Viewer  
interrogates the attached facsimile.  
change the phonebook by  
copying the settings from  
a user settings file stored  
within TOSHIBA Viewer,  
go to Step 2c.  
To add new phonebook contacts, click on Abb.  
Numbers, Group Numbers, or One Touch Keys in the  
left pane. Then double click on Add... (e.g. “Add Abb.  
Number”) in the right pane. Tel List Entry appears at  
the end of the existing list. Double click on the  
desired items and enter the appropriate values.  
For further details on  
phonebook setup, refer to  
Help.  
Toshiba Phonebook Setup appears.  
To edit phonebook contacts, double click on the item  
you want to edit then enter the new data.  
Click the ü button to download the new settings to  
your DP120F/DP125F.  
Click the button to cancel adding/editing the  
phonebook contacts.  
275  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Browse Folders - continued  
Add/Edit Phonebook contacts on the DP120F/DP125F - continued  
Change the settings - continued  
2
2b  
Load a set file from your hard disk  
2c  
Copy the phonebook settings  
Double-click on Add settings file.  
A “New settings” file is created.  
Left-click and hold on the user phonebook file, then drag it to the  
device phonebook file, and release the left mouse button.  
NOTE:  
Initially, your mouse pointer will become a “circle with diagonal  
line”. Upon reaching the desired phonebook file, the pointer will  
take the form of an “address label”. Upon releasing the left  
mouse button, the contents of the user phonebook file are  
copied to the device phonebook file.  
Click the ü button to download the new settings to your DP120F/  
DP125F.  
Right-click on the new settings file and select Load....  
NOTE:  
NOTE:  
In order to create a user phonebook file to be saved on your  
hard disk, refer to the section “Saving the Phonebook”.  
Click the button to cancel adding/editing the phonebook con-  
tacts.  
The Load settings screen appears. Designate the hard disk  
location of the desired set file, select the file, then click on Open.  
The set file is loaded.  
Continue to Step 2c.  
276  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Browse Folders - continued  
Saving the Phonebook  
The device phonebook opened  
by TOSHIBA Viewer (default  
Open the Device folder  
Create the new phonebook file  
1
2
name  
TOSHIBA)  
is  
a
temporary “working” file. Every  
time TOSHIBA Viewer is  
opened, the program accesses  
the attached facsimile and  
reads the current phonebook  
settings.  
Setup device  
phonebook  
You can store the phonebook  
settings  
within  
TOSHIBA  
Viewer or save as a set file on  
your hard disk.  
Select the device and click the Setup device phonebook button.  
This is useful when performing  
“Reading data from device” appears as Viewer interrogates the  
attached facsimile.  
a
full memory clear or  
upgrading the machine  
firmware because you can  
Double-click on Add settings file.  
A “New settings” file is created. Enter an appropriate name for the  
new settings file.  
easily  
machine’s  
downloading  
re-program  
phonebook  
the  
the  
by  
stored  
To copy the current device phonebook settings to the new  
settings file, left-click and hold on the device phonebook file (e.g.  
“TOSHIBA”) then drag it to the new settings file (e.g. “LA Office  
Phonebook) and release the left mouse button.  
phonebook file.  
Toshiba Phonebook Setup appears.  
NOTE:  
Initially, your mouse pointer will become a “circle with diagonal  
line”. Upon reaching the desired phonebook file, the pointer will  
take the form of an “address label”. Upon releasing the left  
mouse button, the contents of the device phonebook file are  
copied to the new phonebook file.  
To save the new settings within TOSHIBA Viewer, go to Step 3a.  
To save the new phonebook as a file on your local hard disk. go to  
Step 3b.  
277  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Browse Folders - continued  
Saving the Phonebook - continued  
Save new phonebook  
3
3a  
Save within TOSHIBA Viewer  
3b  
Save as a file on your hard disk  
Right-click on the new phonebook file and select Save.  
Right-click on the new phonebook file and select Save as....  
NOTE:  
The Save settings screen appears. Designate the location on  
When you click the ü button or button to close the screen, your hard disk and enter an appropriate file name, then click on  
TOSHIBA Viewer will prompt you to save the file.  
OK.  
NOTE:  
The phonebook file is saved as a set file on your hard disk.  
The file extension is “set”. This file can be retrieved by  
TOSHIBA Viewer.  
278  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Browse Folders - continued  
Creating a Routing Rules  
When an image is scanned, it  
is normally stored in the  
Scanned images folder.  
You can change the action by  
defining one or more Routing  
rules.  
Select Setup, Routing Rules... from the menu  
Enter the name of the rule  
1
3
User Routing Rules are:  
Created and maintained by  
any TOSHIBA Viewer user.  
Specific to the user.  
Processed by the TOSHIBA  
Viewer user in the order  
they are shown, from top to  
bottom.  
Click New... to create a new rule.  
Click Finish.  
Routing Rules Wizard appears.  
Some sample rules are sup-  
plied with TOSHIBA Viewer.  
To activate them, go to the  
Routing Rules dialog, select a  
suitable sample to base your  
own rule on, click Copy, click  
Modify, enter the incomplete  
information and click Finish to  
store the completed rule.  
Check on the terms for a rule  
Click Move up to change the apply  
order  
2
4
For further details of Routing  
Rules, click Help on the  
Routing Rules dialog to view  
related help topic.  
Click Next. Follow the prompts to create a rule.  
Click OK.  
For further details of creating and modifying the Routing Rules,  
refer to Help.  
279  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Browse Folders - continued  
Finding items stored in TOSHIBA Viewer folders  
Once files are stored in  
Define a new search  
Click Find icon  
2
1
TOSHIBA Viewer folders, you  
can ask TOSHIBA Viewer to  
find items for you based on  
their properties.  
NOTE:  
You can also search folders  
by selecting the Search  
history.  
Find icon  
In order to search in the  
specific folder, right click on  
the specific folder and  
select Find.  
Check on Include subfolders when you want to search folders in  
subfolders as well.  
Click OK.  
Searching starts.  
For further details of searching, click Help on the Search dialog to  
view a related help topic.  
280  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Browse Folders - continued  
CreatingFolder  
TOSHIBA Viewer uses folders  
to store messages that you  
NOTE:  
Select a folder where you want to create a  
folder in  
1
When you drag from a Windows Explorer to a TOSHIBA  
Viewer folder, TOSHIBA Viewer only stores a reference to the  
file and document properties for the file.  
have scanned, and details  
about files you have on your  
computer. You can then search  
all or some of these folders to  
find messages or files at a later  
date.  
i.e.The file itself is not copied into the TOSHIBA Viewer folder  
and will be opened from its original location when you open  
the reference to it within TOSHIBA Viewer.  
If you drag from a TOSHIBA Viewer folder to another TOSHIBA  
Viewer folder, TOSHIBA Viewer will normally copy the file to the  
target TOSHIBA Viewer folder. However if the source references  
a file outside of the TOSHIBA Viewer folder structure (i.e. was  
dragged in from a Windows Explorer folder) only the reference to  
the external file is moved or copied.  
You can create your own fold-  
ers, and each folder can  
contain sub-folders.  
If you open an image file (.bmp, .jpg, .tif, .pcx, .fax or .fcs) in the  
TOSHIBA Viewer and then select Save in Unimessage Pro  
folder fro the File menu, the image file will always be stored in  
the TOSHIBA Viewer folder.  
Select File - New - Folder.  
With TOSHIBA DP120F/DP125F it is possible to download to  
and upload from mailboxes within a DP120F/DP125F using  
drag and drop of items. If your TOSHIBA DP120F/DP125F  
supports these functions you will see folders within the  
Devices folder on the left side of the main TOSHIBA Viewer  
display. Open these folders to review the contents of the  
DP120F/DP125F’s mailboxes and drop items into these folders  
to download items to the mailboxes.  
Type a name for the new folder  
2
Click OK.  
Type a brief comment describing, for example, the folder’s  
intended use, if required.  
281  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
File Scan  
You  
can  
use  
your  
Scanning with your DP120F/DP125F or other TWAIN compatible scanner  
DP120F/DP125F to scan  
hard copy documents into  
any TWAIN compatible  
application you are run-  
ning (e.g. PaintShop Pro,  
Corel Photo Paint, etc.).  
Set the hard copies to be  
scanned in the document  
tray before scanning.  
Click File Scan on Main Welcome Menu  
Click Scan  
1
3
NOTE:  
Before scanning, you  
can preview the scan-  
ning document by  
clicking Preview.  
File Scan also provides a  
function that allows you to  
build a multi-page docu-  
ment from several sepa-  
rate TWAIN scans. This  
is useful if you want to When you use the other  
scan different pages with TWAIN compatible appli-  
different settings, or if you cations to scan, the  
want scan both sides of a scanner settings dialog  
document.  
appears.  
Click Select source....  
Select Source dialog appears.  
The scanner setting dialog appears.  
NOTE:  
You can also operate  
the scan from the Main  
TOSHIBA Viewer Dis-  
play. However, it is  
not allowed you to re-  
Select the TWAIN Scanner  
Set the scanner settings  
2
4
build  
a
multi-page  
document.  
Click Select.  
For further details of scanner settings, click Help to  
Back to Scan multiple pages dialog.  
view a related help topic.  
Click Scan.  
Back to Scan multiple pages dialog.  
282  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
File Scan - continued  
Scanning with your DP120F/DP125F or other TWAIN compatible scanner - continued  
Select the Scanned pages  
Select what you do with the  
scanned images  
5
6
Click Add.  
Click OK.  
Repeat all scanned pages are added into a document.  
For further details of the New message received dialog,  
click Help to view a related help topic.  
If you want to continue scanning, repeat from step 3 to  
4.  
NOTE:  
You can add the scanned pages in desired order to  
create a multi-page document.  
For further details of the Scan multiple pages dialog,  
click Help to view a related help topic.  
Click OK.  
283  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TOSHIBA Viewer GDI Printer  
You can print a document  
using TOSHIBA Viewer  
GDI Printer, if you have  
Printing from TOSHIBA Viewer UniPad  
The TOSHIBA Viewer  
UniPad is the viewer in-  
corporated into TOSHIBA  
Viewer. The UniPad can  
view the scanned image.  
UniPad is opened.  
Double click a scanned image  
Select the DP120F/DP125F Printer for  
Name  
selected to create  
printer during the installa-  
tion. You can print  
a
1
2
a
document from TOSHIBA  
Viewer UniPad and other  
applications.  
NOTE:  
TOSHIBA Viewer GDI  
Printer is created as  
same as the Windows  
printer  
drivers  
in  
Printers folder. If you  
have not created, you  
can also create  
a
TOSHIBA Viewer GDI  
Printer from the Main  
TOSHIBA Viewer Dis-  
play. To create a GDI  
Select Print from File menu.  
Continue general operation for printer properties and The print job is sent to DP120F/DP125F.  
print settings.  
Click OK.  
The scanned image is printed.  
Printer,  
refer  
to  
Changing the Device  
Configuration  
on  
page 270.  
284  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TOSHIBA Viewer GDI Printer - continued  
Printing from Other Application  
You can also print a document  
Select Page Setup... in File menu  
Select DP120F/DP125F Printer for Name  
1
3
from other applications using  
the TOSHIBA Viewer GDI  
Printer.  
The procedure is the example  
with Windows NotePad. The  
procedure may vary depending  
on the application.  
Page Setup dialog appears.  
Ckick Properties for general operation for printer properties.  
Printer properties dialog appears.  
Click Printer...  
2
Page Setup for Printer dialog appears.  
Click OK.  
Click OK on Page Setup for Printer dialog.  
Back to Page Setup dialog.  
285  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TOSHIBA Viewer GDI Printer - continued  
Printing from Other Application - continued  
Set print settings  
Select Print in File menu  
4
5
Click OK.  
Page Setup dialog is closed.  
The print job is sent to DP120F/DP125F.  
The document is printed.  
286  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
CharacterEntry ...........................................................................................36  
Delete ...............................................................................................37  
Insertion............................................................................................37  
Replacing ..........................................................................................37  
Cleaning  
DocumentScannerCleaning .............................................................235  
RecordingUnitCleaning ....................................................................237  
CommunicationJournal...............................................................................205  
Settings ............................................................................................195  
CommunicationStatus  
Display and Print Transmission Report .............................................120  
Displaying Current Job Status...........................................................120  
ConfidentialBox..........................................................................................149  
ConfigurationSummary...............................................................................45  
ContinuousPolling ......................................................................................145  
ContrastSetting ..........................................................................................90  
CopyReduction ..........................................................................................95  
Copying.......................................................................................................94  
PageCollatingFunction ....................................................................94  
Page Collating Function Default Setting ............................................65  
Paper Size For Copying ....................................................................94  
Reduction .........................................................................................96  
Tray Selection...................................................................................96  
CoverSheet  
A
AbbreviatedNumber  
Abbreviated Dial Number List ............................................................220  
Cancel ..............................................................................................71  
CommunicationsOptions ..................................................................73  
Dialing...............................................................................................98  
Modify...............................................................................................71  
Registration.......................................................................................70  
Access Codes, see also Passwords, and Security Codes  
DepartmentCodeSetting ..................................................................55  
Account Codes  
Account Code Entry..........................................................................164  
Setup ................................................................................................58  
AlphabetDialing ..........................................................................................99  
Alphabetical Sort List ..................................................................................219  
Auto Receive Mode.....................................................................................68  
Autodialer  
AbbreviatedDialerDialing .................................................................98  
AbbreviatedDialerRegistration .........................................................70  
AlphabetDialing ................................................................................99  
GroupNumberRegistration ...............................................................83  
OneTouchDialerRegistration ..........................................................77  
One Touch Key Dialing .....................................................................97  
Quick Start .......................................................................................34  
Automatic Supplies Order ...........................................................................254  
Attaching a Cover Sheet ...................................................................187  
Printing a Cover Sheet ......................................................................187  
Registration.......................................................................................165  
B
Bulletin Board Box ......................................................................................149  
Bypass Tray  
D
Date and Time ............................................................................................40  
Default Setting ............................................................................................64  
DocumentMode................................................................................64  
ContrastLevel ........................................................................64  
Installation ........................................................................................23  
C
Resolution...............................................................................64  
Canceling  
MemoryTransmission ......................................................................91  
Security Transmission ......................................................................93  
DelayedCommunications ...........................................................................181  
UsewithAbbreviatedNumberregistration .........................................73  
Use with One Touch key registration ................................................80  
DelayedPollingReception ..........................................................................181  
DirectTransmission ..........................................................................121  
MemoryJobReservation ..................................................................121  
Open Mailbox Documents (Local Hub) ..............................................161  
Reception .........................................................................................122  
ChainDial ...................................................................................................166  
287  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DepartmentCode  
Access .............................................................................................163  
Function Keys.............................................................................................15  
Discard, see Reception Settings  
Control List .......................................................................................217  
Initialization.......................................................................................55  
Maintenance .....................................................................................57  
DepartmentControlList ..............................................................................217  
Developer Assembly and Drum Unit Installation ..........................................25  
Dial Type ....................................................................................................44  
DialingMethods ..........................................................................................97  
AbbreviatedDialing ...........................................................................98  
AlphabetDialing ................................................................................99  
KeypadDialing..................................................................................100  
On-hookDialing ................................................................................117  
One Touch Key Dialing .....................................................................97  
DirectDocumentTransmission ...................................................................103  
Default Setting ..................................................................................103  
External Off-hook Transmission ........................................................109  
Of-hookTransmission(OptionalHandsetDialing) .............................107  
On-hookTransmission(MonitorSpeakerDialing) ..............................106  
Redialing ...........................................................................................110  
ReportSetting ...................................................................................197  
TemporaryDirectDocumentTransmission .......................................105  
Documents  
Function List ...............................................................................................223  
FuserCleaner  
Installation ........................................................................................27  
Replacement.....................................................................................30  
G
Group  
GroupBroadcastTransmission .........................................................123  
GroupNumberList ............................................................................221  
GroupNumberRegistration ...............................................................83  
Multi-Key Quick Broadcast Transmission .........................................124  
RelayTransmission ..........................................................................126  
H
HardwareOptions........................................................................................254  
Hub Station, see Relay Transmission or Mailbox  
I
Initial Setting  
Date and Time ..................................................................................40  
Dial Type ..........................................................................................44  
Language ..........................................................................................39  
TerminalID .......................................................................................42  
ITU-TCompatible ........................................................................................149  
Acceptable Document Sizes .............................................................87  
Document Exit Tray ..........................................................................19  
DocumentLengthSetting..................................................................60  
Loading .............................................................................................88  
DrumUnitReplacement ..............................................................................31  
J
E
Job Status ..................................................................................................119  
Journals, seeCommunicationJournals  
ECM(ErrorCorrectionMode)  
Default ECM Setting .........................................................................63  
DisablingECMTemporarily ...............................................................172  
ErrorCodesPrintedonReport.....................................................................229  
ErrorMessages ..........................................................................................226  
K
KeypadDialing ............................................................................................100  
F
L
File Number and Residual Memory..............................................................101  
FrontView...................................................................................................10  
LanguageSelection.....................................................................................39  
Letter Head Paper Setting ...........................................................................66  
288  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
LineMonitor  
Always ..............................................................................................61  
Cancelling a Document in a Mailbox (Local Hub)...............................161  
Deleting a Mailbox ............................................................................151  
DeletingDocuments..........................................................................161  
Mailbox List ......................................................................................216  
Overview...........................................................................................136  
Printing a Document from a Mailbox (Local Hub)...............................159  
Reserving a Document to a Mailbox (Local Hub) ...............................155  
Retrieving (Polling) a Document from a Mailbox (Remote Hub) .........157  
Sending a Document to a Mailbox (Remote Hub) ..............................153  
Setting Up a Mailbox.........................................................................149  
MemoryReceptionSetting ..........................................................................175  
MemoryTransmission.................................................................................101  
MemoryTransmissionReport .....................................................................208  
Memory Transmission Report Setting .........................................................198  
Menu List ....................................................................................................224  
MenuOperation ..........................................................................................35  
Multi-AddressPolling ..................................................................................143  
Multi-AddressTransmission(Broadcasting) ................................................123  
GroupBroadcastTransmission .........................................................123  
Multi-Key Quick Broadcast Transmission .........................................124  
Report ...............................................................................................210  
ReportSetting ...................................................................................199  
Multi-Copy, Reception Settings ...................................................................116  
Multi-Key ....................................................................................................124  
Multi-PollingReport .....................................................................................211  
Multi-PollingReportSetting .........................................................................200  
TransmissionOptions .......................................................................193  
UsewithAbbreviatedNumberregistration .........................................73  
Use with One Touch key registration ................................................79  
LineSelection .............................................................................................189  
Line-2Operation ..........................................................................................69  
Lists, see List and Reports  
List And Reports, Print Format And Printing Procedure ...............................195  
DepartmentControlList ....................................................................217  
Function List .....................................................................................223  
MemoryTransmissionReport ...........................................................208  
Menu List ..........................................................................................224  
Multi-AddressTransmissionReport ..................................................210  
Multi-PollingReport ...........................................................................211  
OpenMailbox(ITU-TF-CodeCommunication)List ...........................216  
Power Failure List .............................................................................225  
Preset Dial Number List ....................................................................218  
Abbreviated Dial Number List..................................................220  
All of Lists ..............................................................................218  
GroupNumberList ..................................................................221  
One Touch Number List ..........................................................222  
Relay Box List ..................................................................................216  
Relay Reception List .........................................................................215  
Relay Transmission End Terminal Report .........................................214  
RelayTransmissionOriginatorReport ...............................................212  
Relay Transmission Relay Station Report .........................................213  
ReservationList ................................................................................209  
TransmissionReport .........................................................................207  
Transmission/ReceptionJournal(CommunicationJournal)................205  
Lists and Reports, Settings .........................................................................195  
CommunicationJournalSettings.......................................................195  
CommunicationReportSettings ........................................................195  
MailboxCommunications  
N
Notice to Users ...........................................................................................1  
O
One Touch Key  
Cancel ..............................................................................................78  
CommunicationOptions ....................................................................79  
Dialing...............................................................................................97  
Modify...............................................................................................78  
One Touch Number List ....................................................................222  
Registration.......................................................................................77  
OperationPanel ..........................................................................................13  
Function Keys...................................................................................15  
OpenMailbox....................................................................................137  
Overview...........................................................................................136  
Reception List Settings .....................................................................205  
M
Mailbox(ITU-TCompatible).........................................................................149  
289  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OzoneFilter  
Replacement.....................................................................................32  
R
RearView ...................................................................................................11  
Receiving ....................................................................................................112  
Automatic Receiving Mode ...............................................................112  
ManualReceivingMode ....................................................................112  
Selecting Quick Start ........................................................................34  
TheReceivingMode .........................................................................112  
Receiving Interval Setting ...........................................................................62  
ReceptionJournal .......................................................................................205  
Automatic Output..............................................................................196  
ManualOutput ..................................................................................196  
Settings ............................................................................................195  
Reception List Settings, see Lists And Reports, Settings  
P
PageCount .................................................................................................192  
Paper Jam Codes .......................................................................................228  
Passwords, see also Access Code, and Security Code  
ITUSub-address ...............................................................................185  
System Password.............................................................................186  
PIN Mask....................................................................................................171  
Polling  
Overview...........................................................................................136  
PollingReception ..............................................................................136  
ContinuousPollingReception .................................................145  
DelayedPollingReception ......................................................181  
Multi-AddressPollingReception .............................................143  
SecurePollingReception ........................................................141  
Simple Polling Reception ........................................................141  
TurnaroundPollingReception .................................................147  
PollingReservation ...........................................................................136  
Public Polling Reservation ......................................................140  
Security Polling Reservation ...................................................138  
SimplePollingReservation .....................................................138  
Power Failure List .......................................................................................225  
PowerSaverOperation  
ReceptionSettings  
Discard .............................................................................................114  
Multi-CopySetting ............................................................................116  
Reduction .........................................................................................113  
ReverseOrderPrintingSetting..........................................................115  
RecordingPaper  
Installation ........................................................................................20  
Paper Size Adjustment .....................................................................22  
Paper Size, Recording Area ..............................................................113  
Trays(Option) ...................................................................................12  
RecoveryTransmission  
Setting ..............................................................................................168  
Transmitting(Sending) ......................................................................169  
Redialing .....................................................................................................110  
AutomaticRedialing ..........................................................................110  
ManualRedialingDirectTransmissions ............................................110  
Manual Redialing Jobs in Memory.....................................................111  
Redial(IntervalandCounter)Setting .................................................67  
TelephoneHandsetOperation(Optional) ...........................................117  
Reduction, see Reception Settings  
PrinterPowerSaver ..........................................................................51  
SuperPowerSaver ...........................................................................51  
Preset Dial Number Lists, see Lists & Reports  
Print  
Print Density Setting .........................................................................59  
PrintingSuppliesReplacement .........................................................28  
ReverseOrderPrintingSetting..........................................................115  
PrivilegedReception ...................................................................................173  
Public Mailbox Reservation .........................................................................140  
RelayTransmission  
Deleting a Relay Box ........................................................................132  
Overview...........................................................................................126  
Relay Box List ..................................................................................216  
Relay Destination Report Setting ......................................................203  
Relay Reception List .........................................................................215  
Relay Reception List Setting .............................................................204  
Relay Station Transmission Report Setting .......................................202  
Q
Quality TX...................................................................................................73, 79  
Quick Start .................................................................................................34  
290  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Relay Transmission End Terminal Report .........................................214  
RelayTransmissionOriginatorReport ...............................................212  
RelayTransmissionOriginatorReportSetting ...................................201  
Relay Transmission Relay Station Report .........................................213  
Relay Transmission to a Remote Hub ...............................................134  
Setting Up a Relay Box.....................................................................127  
RemoteService ..........................................................................................253  
Remote Terminal ID (RTI) Print ...................................................................174  
Replacement  
DrumUnit .........................................................................................31  
FuserCleaner ...................................................................................30  
OzoneFilter ......................................................................................32  
PrintingSupplies ...............................................................................20  
TonerCartridge .................................................................................28  
Reports, see Lists And Reports  
FacsimileSeparatorPage .................................................................53  
PC Print Separator Page...................................................................53  
Setup  
Document Exit Tray ..........................................................................19  
Facsimile Machine Installation ..........................................................18  
Printing Supplies Installation .............................................................20  
Quick Start .......................................................................................34  
Receiving ..........................................................................................34  
Unpacking .........................................................................................16  
UserInterfaceOperation ...................................................................35  
Simple Polling .............................................................................................141  
SimplePollingReservation .........................................................................138  
SpecialCharacterTable ..............................................................................36  
Specifications .............................................................................................253  
SpeedDial, seeAbbreviatedNumber  
ReservationList ..........................................................................................209  
Residual Memory & File Number.......................................................101  
Resolution, Scan Setting Adjustment ..........................................................89  
ReverseOrderPrintingSetting ....................................................................115  
Ring Volume Adjustment.............................................................................47  
RTI (Remote Terminal ID) Print ...................................................................174  
Sub-AddressCommunication  
DialingwithSub-addresses ...............................................................185  
UsingwithAbbreviatedNumberRegistration.....................................73  
Using with One Touch Key Registration ............................................79  
Supplies  
Automatic Supplies Order .................................................................254  
Installation ........................................................................................25  
Replacement.....................................................................................28  
S
ScanResolution..........................................................................................89  
SecurePolling.............................................................................................138  
SecureReception........................................................................................176  
Access Code Setting ........................................................................176  
Activation Period ..............................................................................177  
Manual Activation .............................................................................179  
Manual RX Print................................................................................180  
Security Code, see also Passwords, and Access Codes  
Polling Security Code........................................................................139  
SecureReception .............................................................................176  
Security Polling Reservation .......................................................................138  
Security Transmission ................................................................................194  
Send After Scan  
T
TelephoneHandsetOperation(Optional) .....................................................117  
On-HookDialing ................................................................................117  
Redialing ...........................................................................................118  
ToneOutput ......................................................................................118  
TerminalID .................................................................................................34  
Terminal ID Setting ...........................................................................42  
Terminal ID, Quick Start ...................................................................34  
Test Mode...................................................................................................240  
Time and Date ............................................................................................40  
TonerCartridgeReplacement ......................................................................28  
TOSHIBAViewer  
Default Setting ..................................................................................92  
Temporarily .......................................................................................190  
SeparatorPageSetting  
BrowseFolders  
Add/Edit Phoonebook contacts on the DP120F/DP125F.........275  
ChangingtheDeviceConfiguration .........................................270  
CreatingaRoutingRules ........................................................279  
CopySeparatorPage ........................................................................53  
291  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CreatingFolder .......................................................................281  
Finding items stored in TOSHIBA Viewer folders ....................280  
Saving the Device Configuration .............................................273  
SavingthePhonebook ............................................................277  
ComputerRequirements....................................................................261  
ConfigurationOftheCD-ROM ...........................................................261  
Description of the Main Welcome Menu ............................................269  
DeviceConfiguration .........................................................................261  
File Scan ..........................................................................................282  
Installation ........................................................................................262  
Installing the TOSHIBA Viewer  
Device Setup ..........................................................................264  
Installation ..............................................................................262  
Introduction .......................................................................................260  
LicenseAgreement ...........................................................................258  
TOSHIBA Viewer GDI Printer  
When the recorded image is not clear ...............................................235  
TTI (Transmit Terminal ID) Print..................................................................167  
TurnaroundPollingReception......................................................................147  
TXReport ...................................................................................................74, 80  
U
UserInterfaceOperation .............................................................................35  
User Test Mode  
Automatic Test .................................................................................240  
Individual Test ..................................................................................241  
ADF Test ................................................................................242  
Key Test.................................................................................244  
LCD Test ................................................................................246  
LED Test ................................................................................245  
Speaker Test ..........................................................................247  
Switch Test ............................................................................248  
Test Print................................................................................251  
Printing a Test Result .......................................................................252  
Printing from TOSHIBA Viewer UniPad...................................284  
PrintingOtherApplication .......................................................285  
Uninstalling the TOSHIBA Viewer .....................................................268  
TransmissionJournal ..................................................................................205  
Setting ..............................................................................................195  
TransmissionOptions .................................................................................181  
Attaching a Cover Sheet ...................................................................187  
CommunicationReportPrint .............................................................182  
DelayedCommunication(TimeDesignation) .....................................181  
DialingwithSub-Address ..................................................................185  
LineMonitor ......................................................................................193  
LineSelection ...................................................................................189  
LowSpeedTransmission ..................................................................184  
Priority Transmission ........................................................................183  
Security Transmission ......................................................................194  
Send After Scan Temporarily ............................................................190  
Setting the Page Count .....................................................................192  
TransmissionReport ...................................................................................207  
Troubleshooting ..........................................................................................226  
Clearing a Document Jam .................................................................232  
ClearingaRecordingPaperJam .......................................................233  
Error Codes Printed on Reports.........................................................229  
ErrorMessages ................................................................................226  
ReceptionProblems..........................................................................231  
TransmissionProblems ....................................................................230  
V
VolumeAdjustment  
AlarmTone .......................................................................................48  
BellRinger ........................................................................................47  
Key Touch Tone ...............................................................................49  
Monitor .............................................................................................50  
292  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
© Copyright TOSHIBA TEC CORPORATION 2000  
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED  
DP120F/DP125F  
Printed in Japan  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Tech Craft TV Video Accessories XLN48 User Manual
Tecumseh Automobile Parts LH318XA User Manual
Toro Sprinkler INF34 User Manual
Toshiba Printer B 670 QQ User Manual
Turbosound Portable Speaker TQ 440SP User Manual
Turbosound Speaker TCS 122 XXDP User Manual
ViewSonic Computer Monitor VS14691 User Manual
ViewSonic Flat Panel Television LCDTV User Manual
Vizio Universal Remote VUR5 User Manual
VTech Baby Toy 91 002584 000 User Manual